Contents

Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual PDF

1 of 354
1 of 354

Summary of Content for Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual PDF

G-Class Operator's Manual

Order no. 6515 4159 13 Part no. 463 584 43 00 Edition A 2014

4635844300, 4635844300

G-C las

sO pe rat

or' sM

an ua l

Publication details Internet

Further information about Mercedes-Benz vehicles and about Daimler AG can be found on the following websites: http://www.mbusa.com (USA only) http://www.mercedes-benz.ca (Canada only)

Editorial office

Daimler AG: Not to be reprinted, translated or otherwise reproduced, in whole or in part, without written permission from Daimler AG.

Vehicle manufacturer

Daimler AG Mercedesstrae 137 70327 Stuttgart Germany

Symbols Registered trademarks: RBluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG Inc. RDTS is a registered trademark of DTS, Inc. RDolby and MLP are registered trademarks of DOLBY Laboratories. RBabySmart, ESP and PRE-SAFE are registered trademarks of Daimler AG. RHomeLink is a registered trademark of Prince. RiPod and iTunes are registered trademarks of Apple Inc. RLogic7 is a registered trademark of Harman International Industries. RMicrosoft and Windows media are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. RSIRIUS is a registered trademark of Sirius XM Radio Inc. RHD Radio is a registered trademark of iBiquity Digital Corporation. RGracenote is a registered trademark of Gracenote, Inc. RZAGATSurvey and related brands are registered trademarks of ZagatSurvey, LLC.

In this Operator's Manual you will find the following symbols:

G WARNING Warning notes draw your attention to hazards that endanger your health or life, or the health or life of others.

H Environmental note Environmental notes provide you with information on environmentally aware actions or disposal.

! Notes on material damage alert you to dangers that could lead to damage to your vehicle.

i Practical tips or further information that could be helpful to you.

X This symbol indicates an instruction that must be followed.

X Several of these symbols in succession indicate an instruction with several steps.

(Y page) This symbol tells you where you can find more information about a topic.

YY This symbol indicates a warning or an instruction that is continued on the next page.

Display This font indicates a display in the multifunction display/COMAND display.

~ This symbol tells you that you can find further information in the Digital Operator's Manual.

Parts of the software in the vehicle are protected by copyright 2005 The FreeType Project http://www.freetype.org. All rights reserved.

As at 11.02.2013

Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz We urge you to read this Operator's Manual carefully and familiarize yourself with the vehicle before driving. For your own safety and a longer vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Ignoring them could result in damage to the vehicle or personal injury to you or others. Vehicle damage caused by failure to follow instructions is not covered by the Mercedes- Benz Limited Warranty. The equipment or product designation of your vehicle may vary depending on: RModel Rorder Rcountry specification Ravailability Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right to introduce changes in the following areas: Rdesign REquipment Rtechnical features The equipment in your vehicle may therefore differ from that shown in the descriptions and illustrations. The following are integral components of the vehicle: ROperator's Manual RMaintenance Booklet REquipment-dependent supplements Keep printed copies of the documents in the vehicle at all times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass the documents on to the new owner. The technical documentation team at Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant motoring. Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc. A Daimler Company

4635844300 4635844300,

Index ....................................................... 4

Introduction ......................................... 20

At a glance ........................................... 27

Safety ................................................... 37

Opening and closing ........................... 67

Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 83

Lights and windshield wipers ............ 97

Climate control ................................. 117

Driving and parking .......................... 137

On-board computer and displays .... 203

Stowage and features ...................... 255

Maintenance and care ...................... 281

Breakdown assistance ..................... 295

Wheels and tires ............................... 311

Technical data ................................... 341

Contents 3

1, 2, 3 ... 115 V socket ...................................... 265 12 V socket ........................................ 265 4ETS (Electronic Traction System)

Function/notes ................................ 62 4MATIC (permanent four-wheel drive) .................................................. 189

A ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)

Display message ............................ 221 Function/notes ................................ 61 Important safety notes .................... 61 Warning lamp ................................. 245

Active Blind Spot Assist Activating/deactivating (on- board computer) ............................ 213 Display message ............................ 235

ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 64 Adaptive brake lamps ......................... 62 Additives (engine oil) ........................ 347 Air bags

Display message ............................ 226 Front air bag (driver, front passenger) ....................................... 42 Important safety notes .................... 40 PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF- indicator lamp .......................... 44 Safety guidelines ............................. 39 Window curtain air bag .................... 43

Air-conditioning system see Climate control

Air vents Important safety notes .................. 134 Rear ............................................... 136 Setting ........................................... 134 Setting the center air vents ........... 135 Setting the side air vents ............... 135

Alarm system see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)

All-wheel drive Transfer case ................................. 193

AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 217 Anti-lock braking system

see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)

Anti-theft alarm system see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)

Approach/departure angle .............. 167 Ashtray ............................................... 263 Assistance menu (on-board computer) .......................................... 213 ASSYST service interval display

Service messages .......................... 286 ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)

Activating/deactivating ................... 65 Function ........................................... 65 Switching off the alarm .................... 65

Audio system see separate operating instructions

Authorized Mercedes-Benz Center see Qualified specialist workshop

AUTO lights Display message ............................ 229 see Lights

Automatic car wash .......................... 288 Automatic engine start (ECOstart/ stop function) .................................... 143 Automatic engine switch-off (ECO start/stop function) .......................... 142 Automatic headlamp mode .............. 100 Automatic transmission

Automatic drive program ............... 150 Display message ............................ 240 Drive position (ECO start/stop function) ........................................ 147 Driving tips .................................... 149 Emergency running mode .............. 153 Engaging drive position .................. 147 Engaging neutral ............................ 147 Engaging reverse gear ................... 146 Engaging the park position ............ 146 Important safety notes .................. 145 Kickdown ....................................... 149 Manual drive program .................... 151 Neutral (ECO start/stop function) . 147 Overview ........................................ 145 Problem (malfunction) ................... 153 Program selector button ................ 149 Pulling away ................................... 140 Selector lever ................................ 145 Shift ranges ................................... 150 Steering wheel paddle shifters ...... 150

4 Index

Trailer towing ................................. 149 Transmission position display ........ 146

Automatic transmission emergency mode ............................... 153 Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ............................................... 352

B Backup lamp

Changing bulbs .............................. 113 BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 61 Battery

Checking (SmartKey) ....................... 70 Important safety guidelines (SmartKey) ....................................... 70 Replacing (SmartKey) ...................... 71

Battery (vehicle) Charging ........................................ 301 Display message ............................ 231 Important safety notes .................. 299 Jump starting ................................. 303 Overview ........................................ 299

Blind Spot Assist Activating/deactivating ................. 213 Display message ............................ 235 Notes/function .............................. 186

Brake fluid Display message ............................ 224 Notes ............................................. 347

Brake fluid level ................................ 286 Brake lamps

Adaptive ........................................... 62 Display message ............................ 227

Brakes ABS .................................................. 61 BAS .................................................. 61 Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 347 Display message ............................ 221 High-performance brake system .... 161 Important safety notes .................. 159 Maintenance .................................. 160 Parking brake ................................ 157 Riding tips ...................................... 159 Warning lamp ................................. 244

Breakdown see Flat tire see Towing away

Brush guard ....................................... 274 Bulbs

Backup lamp .................................. 113 Brake lamp .................................... 113 Cornering light function ................. 110 Fog lamps ...................................... 110 Rear fog lamp ................................ 113 Tail lamp ........................................ 113 see Replacing bulbs

C California

Important notice for retail customers and lessees .................... 22

Calling up a malfunction see Display messages

Care Carpets .......................................... 294 Car wash ........................................ 288 Chrome parts ................................. 292 Display ........................................... 292 Gear or selector lever .................... 292 Headlamps ..................................... 291 Interior ........................................... 292 Matte finish ................................... 290 Notes ............................................. 288 Paint .............................................. 289 Plastic trim .................................... 292 Power washer ................................ 289 Rear view camera .......................... 291 Roof lining ...................................... 294 Seat belt ........................................ 294 Seat covers .................................... 293 Sensors ......................................... 291 Steering wheel ............................... 292 Tail pipes ....................................... 292 Trim strips ..................................... 293 Washing by hand ........................... 289 Wheels ........................................... 289 Windows ........................................ 290 Wiper blades .................................. 291 Wooden trim .................................. 293

Cargo compartment cover Installing/removing ....................... 261 Notes/how to use ......................... 261 Opening and closing ...................... 261 Overview ........................................ 261

Index 5

Cargo compartment enlargement Important safety notes .................. 258

Cargo tie down rings ......................... 261 CD player/CD changer (on-board computer) .......................................... 211 Center console

Overview .......................................... 32 Upper section .................................. 32

Central locking Automatic locking (on-board computer) ...................................... 216 Locking/unlocking (SmartKey) ........ 68

Changing bulbs Reversing lamps ............................ 113 Side marker lamps ......................... 112 Turn signals (front) ......................... 111

Changing gears .................................. 148 Checklist

After driving off-road ...................... 166 Before driving off-road ................... 165

Child-proof locks Important safety notes .................... 59 Rear doors ....................................... 59

Children In the vehicle ................................... 54 Restraint systems ............................ 54

Child seat Automatic recognition ..................... 44 Automatic recognition/air bag deactivation, self-test ...................... 45 LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors ............................................ 57 Special seat belt retractor ............... 56 Top Tether ....................................... 58 Troubleshooting ............................... 47

Chrome parts (cleaning instructions) ...................................... 292 Cigarette lighter ................................ 264 Climate control

Controlling automatically ............... 130 Cooling with air dehumidification . . 124 Defrosting the windows ................. 132 Defrosting the windshield .............. 131 Dual-zone automatic climate control ........................................... 119 Important safety notes .................. 118 Indicator lamp ................................ 129 Maximum cooling .......................... 132

Notes on using dual-zone automatic climate control .............. 120 Overview of systems ...................... 118 Problems with "cooling with air dehumidification" ........................... 129 Problem with the rear window defroster ........................................ 133 Refrigerant ..................................... 347 Setting the air distribution ............. 131 Setting the airflow ......................... 131 Setting the air vents ...................... 134 Setting the temperature ................ 131 Switching air-recirculation mode on/off ............................................ 134 Switching on/off ........................... 121 Switching residual heat on/off ...... 134 Switching the rear window defroster on/off ............................ 133 Switching the ZONE function on/ off .................................................. 131 Windshield defroster ...................... 133

Cockpit Overview .......................................... 28 see Instrument cluster

COMAND see separate operating instructions

Combination switch .......................... 103 Consumption statistics (on-board computer) .......................................... 208 Convenience opening feature

see Side windows Coolant (engine)

Checking the level ......................... 285 Display message ............................ 229 Filling capacity ............................... 349 Notes ............................................. 348 Temperature (on-board computer) . 217 Temperature gauge ........................ 205 Warning lamp ................................. 251

Cooling see Climate control

Cornering light function Function/notes ............................. 104

Cruise control Cruise control lever ....................... 169 Display message ............................ 237 Driving system ............................... 168

6 Index

Function/notes ............................. 168 Selecting ........................................ 170

Cup holder Center console .............................. 262 Important safety notes .................. 262 Rear compartment ......................... 262

Customer Assistance Center (CAC) ... 24 Customer Relations Department ....... 24

D Data

see Technical data Daytime running lamps

Display message ............................ 229 Switching on/off (on-board computer) ...................................... 215 Switching on/off (switch) ................ 99

Declarations of conformity ................. 24 Delayed switch-off

Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ...................................... 215 Interior lighting .............................. 216

Differential lock Disengaging ................................... 198 Front axle ...................................... 197 Rear axle ........................................ 197 Transfer case ................................. 197

Differential locks Engaging ........................................ 196 General notes ................................ 195 Terrain ........................................... 195

Digital speedometer ......................... 209 Display (cleaning instructions) ........ 292 Display messages

Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 220 Driving systems ............................. 233 Engine ............................................ 229 General notes ................................ 220 Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 220 Lights ............................................. 226 Safety systems .............................. 221 Service interval display .................. 286 SmartKey ....................................... 242 Tires ............................................... 237 Vehicle ........................................... 240

Distance display (on-board computer) .......................................... 213

Distance recorder see Odometer see Trip odometer

Distance warning (warning lamp) .... 253 DISTRONIC PLUS

Activating ....................................... 179 Activation conditions ..................... 179 Cruise control lever ....................... 178 Deactivating ................................... 183 Display message ............................ 235 Displays in the multifunction display ........................................... 182 Driving tips .................................... 184 Function/notes ............................. 176 Important safety notes .................. 176 Selecting ........................................ 178 Setting the specified minimum distance ......................................... 183 Warning lamp ................................. 253

Door control panel Overview .......................................... 35

Doors Automatic locking (on-board computer) ...................................... 216 Automatic locking (switch) ............... 75 Central locking/unlocking (SmartKey) ....................................... 68 Display message ............................ 241 Emergency locking ........................... 75 Emergency unlocking ....................... 75 Important safety notes .................... 73 Opening (from inside) ...................... 73 Overview .......................................... 73

Drinking and driving ......................... 159 Drive program

Automatic ...................................... 150 Display ........................................... 146 Manual ........................................... 151 SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 218

Driving abroad Symmetrical low beam .................... 98

Driving in mountainous terrain Approach/departure angle ............ 167 Driving downhill ............................. 168 Gradient-climbing capability (maximum) ..................................... 168

Driving lamps see Daytime running lamps

Index 7

Driving off-road see Off-road driving

Driving on flooded roads .................. 162 Driving safety systems

4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ... 62 ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 61 ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 64 Adaptive brake lamps ...................... 62 BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 61 Electronic brake force distribution ... 64 ESP (Electronic Stability Program) . 62 Important safety information ........... 60 Overview .......................................... 60

Driving system Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 174

Driving systems Blind Spot Assist ............................ 185 Cruise control ................................ 168 Display message ............................ 233 DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 176 HOLD function ............................... 188 PARKTRONIC ................................. 189 Rear view camera .......................... 192 SPEEDTRONIC ............................... 174

Driving tips Automatic transmission ................. 149 Brakes ........................................... 159 DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 184 Downhill gradient ........................... 160 Driving abroad ................................. 98 Driving in winter ............................. 163 Driving on flooded roads ................ 162 Driving on sand .............................. 166 Driving over obstacles ................... 167 General .......................................... 158 Gravel roads .................................. 166 Hydroplaning ................................. 162 Icy road surfaces ........................... 163 Off-road driving .............................. 164 Off-road fording ............................. 162 Snow chains .................................. 315 Symmetrical low beam .................... 98 Tire ruts ......................................... 166 Towing a trailer .............................. 198 Traveling uphill ............................... 167 Wet road surface ........................... 160

DVD audio Operating (on-board computer) ..... 211

DVD video Operating (on-board computer) ..... 212

E EASY-ENTRY feature

Activating/deactivating ................. 216 Function/notes ................................ 92

EASY-EXIT feature Function/notes ................................ 92 Switching on/off ........................... 216

EBD (electronic brake force distribution)

Display message ............................ 223 Function/notes ................................ 64

ECO start/stop function Deactivating/activating ................. 142 General information ....................... 141

Electrical fuses Fuse box in the cargo compartment ................................. 310

Electronic Stability Program see ESP (Electronic Stability Program)

Electronic Traction System see 4ETS (Electronic Traction System)

Emergency call see mbrace

Emergency locking Vehicle ............................................. 75

Emergency release Vehicle ............................................. 75

Emergency Tensioning Devices Function ........................................... 53 Safety guidelines ............................. 39

Engine Check Engine warning lamp ........... 251 Display message ............................ 229 ECO start/stop function ................ 141 Engine number ............................... 343 Irregular running ............................ 144 Jump-starting ................................. 303 Starting problems .......................... 144 Starting the engine with the SmartKey ....................................... 140 Switching off .................................. 157 Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 308

Engine electronics Problem (malfunction) ................... 144

8 Index

Engine oil Adding ........................................... 284 Additives ........................................ 347 Checking the oil level ..................... 283 Display message ............................ 231 Filling capacity ............................... 347 Notes about oil grades ................... 346 Temperature (on-board computer) . 217 Viscosity ........................................ 347

Environmental protection Note ................................................. 20

ESP (Electronic Stability Program)

AMG menu (on-board computer) . . . 218 Deactivating/activating ................... 63 Display message ............................ 221 Function/notes ................................ 62 Important safety information ........... 62 Trailer stabilization ........................... 64 Warning lamp ................................. 247

Exhaust check ................................... 159 Exhaust tail pipe (cleaning instructions) ...................................... 292 Exterior lighting

see Lights Exterior mirrors

Adjusting ......................................... 93 Dipping (automatic) ......................... 94 Folding in/out (automatically) ......... 94 Folding in/out (electrically) ............. 93 Folding in when locking (on-board computer) ...................................... 217 Out of position (troubleshooting) ..... 94 Setting ............................................. 93 Storing settings (memory function) .. 95 Storing the parking position ............. 94

F Filler cap

see Fuel filler flap First-aid kit ......................................... 296 Flat tire

Preparing the vehicle ..................... 298 Floormats ........................................... 278 Fog lamps

Switching on/off ........................... 101

Folding the seat backrest (rear) forwards/back .................................. 259 Front fog lamp (display message) . . . 228 Front fog lamps

Switching on/off ........................... 101 Fuel

Additives ........................................ 346 Consumption statistics .................. 208 Displaying the current consumption .................................. 209 Displaying the range ...................... 209 Fuel gauge ..................................... 205 Grade (gasoline) ............................ 344 Important safety notes .................. 344 Notes about consumption ............. 346 Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 345 Premium-grade unleaded gasoline . 344 Problem (malfunction) ................... 156 Refueling ........................................ 153 Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 344

Fuel/water separator Service ........................................... 287

Fuel consumption Notes ............................................. 159

Fuel filler flap Emergency release ........................ 155 Opening/closing ............................ 154

Fuel level Calling up the range (on-board computer) ...................................... 209

Fuel tank Capacity ........................................ 344 Problem (malfunction) ................... 156

Fuse allocation chart ........................ 309 Fuse box

Battery case ................................... 310 Dashboard ..................................... 309 Front-passenger footwell ............... 309 Transmission tunnel ....................... 310

Fuse extractor ................................... 309 Fuses

Allocation chart ............................. 309 Before changing ............................. 309 Dashboard fuse box ....................... 309 Fuse allocation chart ..................... 309 Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell .......................................... 309

Index 9

Fuse box in the transmission tunnel ............................................ 310 Important safety notes .................. 308 In the battery case ......................... 310

G Garage door opener

Clearing the memory ..................... 278 Important safety notes .................. 274 Opening/closing the garage door .. 278 Programming the remote control ... 275

Gasoline ............................................. 344 Gear indicator (on-board computer) 217 Gear or selector lever (cleaning guidelines) ......................................... 292 Genuine parts ...................................... 20 Genuine wood trim and trim strips (cleaning instructions) ...................... 293 Glove box ........................................... 257 Gradient-climbing capability (maximum) ......................................... 168 GTW (Gross Trailer Weight) (definition) ......................................... 332

H Hazard warning lamps ...................... 104 Headlamps

Adding fluid to cleaning system ..... 286 Cleaning ......................................... 291 Cleaning system (capacity) ............ 349 Cleaning system (function) ............ 103 Cleaning system (notes) ................ 349 Fogging up ..................................... 105 Protective grille .............................. 112 see Automatic headlamp mode

Head restraints Adjusting ......................................... 86 Adjusting (rear) ................................ 87 Installing/removing (rear) ................ 88 Luxury .............................................. 87 Resetting (front) ............................... 87

Heating see Climate control

High-beam headlamps Display message ............................ 227 Switching on/off ........................... 103

Hill start assist .................................. 141 HOLD function

Function/notes ............................. 188 Hood

Closing ........................................... 283 Display message ............................ 241 Important safety notes .................. 282 Opening ......................................... 283

Hydroplaning ..................................... 162

I Immobilizer .......................................... 64 Instrument cluster

Overview ........................................ 205 Warning and indicator lamps ......... 242

Instrument cluster lighting .............. 205 Interior lighting ................................. 105

Automatic control .......................... 106 Cargo compartment lamp .............. 107 Delayed switch-off (on-board computer) ...................................... 216 Manual control ............................... 106 Overview ........................................ 105 Reading lamp ................................. 107 Rear interior lighting ...................... 108

J Jack

Pump lever ..................................... 337 Storage location ............................ 296 Using ............................................. 336

Jump starting (engine) ...................... 303

K Key positions

SmartKey ....................................... 139 Kickdown

Manual drive program .................... 152

L Lap time (RACETIMER) ...................... 218 LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors ................................................ 57 License plate lamp (display message) ............................................ 228

10 Index

Lighting Light switch ..................................... 98

Lights Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off . 216 Automatic headlamp mode ............ 100 Cornering light function ................. 104 Driving abroad ................................. 98 Fog lamps ...................................... 101 Hazard warning lamps ................... 104 High beam flasher .......................... 104 High-beam headlamps ................... 103 Low-beam headlamps ...................... 99 Parking lamps ................................ 102 Rear fog lamp ................................ 101 Standing lamps .............................. 102 Switching the daytime running lamps on/off (on-board computer) 215 Switching the daytime running lamps on/off (switch) ...................... 99 Switching the exterior lighting delayed switch-off on/off (on- board computer) ............................ 215 Switching the surround lighting on/off (on-board computer) .......... 215 Turn signals ................................... 103 see Interior lighting see Replacing bulbs

Light sensor (display message) ....... 229 LIM indicator lamp

Cruise control ................................ 169 DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 178 Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 175

Limit speed Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 174

Load anchorage ................................. 260 Loading guidelines ............................ 256 Locking

Emergency locking ........................... 75 From inside the vehicle (central locking button) ................................. 74 see Central locking

Locking (doors) Automatic ........................................ 75

Locking centrally see Central locking

Locking verification signal (on- board computer) ............................... 216

Low-beam headlamps Display message ............................ 226 Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ................................... 98 Switching on/off .............................. 99

LOW RANGE off-road gear ................ 194 Luggage compartment enlargement

Overview ........................................ 258 Lumbar support

Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ............................................ 89

Luxury head restraints ....................... 87

M M+S tires ............................................ 314 Malfunction message

see Display messages Matte finish (cleaning instructions) 290 mbrace

Call priority .................................... 270 Display message ............................ 224 Downloading destinations (COMAND) ..................................... 271 Downloading routes ....................... 273 Emergency call .............................. 268 Geo fencing ................................... 274 Important safety notes .................. 266 Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 272 MB info call button ........................ 270 Remote vehicle locking .................. 271 Roadside Assistance button .......... 269 Self-test ......................................... 267 Speed alert .................................... 273 System .......................................... 267 Triggering the vehicle alarm ........... 274 Vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis ....................................... 272 Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 271

Mechanical key Function/notes ................................ 70 General notes .................................. 70 Removing ......................................... 70

Memory card (audio) ......................... 211 Memory function ................................. 95 Message memory (on-board computer) .......................................... 220

Index 11

Messages see Display messages

Mirrors Sun visor ........................................ 263 see Exterior mirrors see Rear-view mirror

Mobile phone Menu (on-board computer) ............ 212

Mounting wheels Mounting a new wheel ................... 337 Raising the vehicle ......................... 336 Removing a wheel .......................... 337 Securing the vehicle against rolling away ................................... 336

MP3 Operation ....................................... 211 see separate operating instructions

Multifunction display Function/notes ............................. 207 Permanent display ......................... 215

Multifunction steering wheel Back button ................................... 207 Operating the on-board computer . 206 Overview .......................................... 31

N Navigation

Menu (on-board computer) ............ 209 see separate operating instructions

NECK-PRO head restraints Operation ......................................... 47 Resetting after being triggered ........ 48

Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle 138

O Occupant safety

Children in the vehicle ..................... 54 Important safety notes .................... 38

Off-road Differential locks ............................ 195 Off-road ABS .................................... 61

Off-road driving Checklist ........................................ 165 Driving on sand .............................. 166 Important safety notes .................. 164 Traveling uphill ............................... 167

Off-road fording ................................. 162 Off-road system

4MATIC .......................................... 189 Oil

see Engine oil On-board computer

AMG menu ..................................... 217 Assistance menu ........................... 213 Audio menu ................................... 211 Convenience submenu .................. 216 Display messages .......................... 220 DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 182 Factory settings submenu ............. 217 Important safety notes .................. 204 Instrument cluster submenu .......... 214 Lighting submenu .......................... 215 Menu overview .............................. 208 Message memory .......................... 220 Navigation menu ............................ 209 Operation ....................................... 206 RACETIMER ................................... 218 Service menu ................................. 214 Settings menu ............................... 214 Standard display ............................ 208 Telephone menu ............................ 212 Trip menu ...................................... 208 Vehicle submenu ........................... 216 Video DVD operation ..................... 212

Operating safety Declaration of conformity ................ 24

Operating system see On-board computer

Outside temperature display ........... 206 Overhead control panel ...................... 34 Override feature

Rear side windows ........................... 60

P Paint code number ............................ 342 Paintwork (cleaning instructions) . . . 289 Panic alarm .......................................... 38 Parcel net ........................................... 258 Parking ............................................... 156

Engaging park position .................. 146

12 Index

Important safety notes .................. 156 Position of exterior mirror, front- passenger side ................................. 94 see PARKTRONIC

Parking aid see Exterior mirrors see PARKTRONIC

Parking brake Applying ......................................... 157 Display message ............................ 223 Warning lamp ................................. 250

Parking lamps Switching on/off ........................... 102

PARKTRONIC Deactivating/activating ................. 191 Driving system ............................... 189 Function/notes ............................. 189 Important safety notes .................. 189 Problem (malfunction) ................... 192 Range of the sensors ..................... 190 Trailer towing ................................. 191 Warning display ............................. 191

Pedals ................................................. 159 Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) . 292 Power supply (trailer) ....................... 200 Power washers .................................. 289 Programming

SmartKey ......................................... 69 Program selector button .................. 149 Pulling away

Automatic transmission ................. 140

Q Qualified specialist workshop ........... 24

R RACETIMER

Deleting all laps ............................. 219 Displaying and starting .................. 218 Displaying the intermediate time ... 218 Resetting the current lap ............... 219 Starting a new lap .......................... 218 Stopping ........................................ 219

RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 218

Radio Selecting a station ......................... 211 see separate operating instructions

Radio-wave reception/ transmission in the vehicle

Declaration of conformity ................ 24 Reading lamp ..................................... 105 Rear bench seat

Folding forward .............................. 260 Rear compartment

Setting the air vents ...................... 136 Rear door

Closing ............................................. 77 Display message ............................ 241 Important safety notes .................... 76 Opening ........................................... 77 Opening/closing .............................. 76

Rear fog lamp Display message ............................ 228 Switching on/off ........................... 101

Rear lamps see Lights

Rear seat bench Folding into an upright position ..... 260

Rear view camera Function/notes ............................. 192

Rear view camera (cleaning instructions) ...................................... 291 Rear-view mirror

Dipping (automatic) ......................... 94 Rear window defroster

Problem (malfunction) ................... 133 Switching on/off ........................... 133

Rear window wiper Switching on/off ........................... 115

Refueling Fuel gauge ..................................... 205 Important safety notes .................. 153 Refueling process .......................... 154 see Fuel

Remote control Programming (garage door opener) 275

Replacing bulbs Important safety notes .................. 108 Overview of bulb types .................. 109

Reporting safety defects .................... 25

Index 13

Reserve (fuel tank) see Fuel

Reserve fuel Display message ............................ 232 Warning lamp ................................. 251 see Fuel

Residual heat Switching on/off ........................... 134

Restraint systems see SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)

Reversing lamps (display message) 228 Roadside Assistance (breakdown) . . . . 22 Roof lining and carpets (cleaning guidelines) ......................................... 294 Route (navigation)

see Route guidance (navigation) Route guidance (navigation) ............ 209

S Safety

Children in the vehicle ..................... 54 Child restraint systems .................... 54

Safety system see Driving safety systems

Seat backrest Folding back .................................. 259

Seat belts Adjusting the height ......................... 52 Belt force limiters ............................ 53 Cleaning ......................................... 294 Correct usage .................................. 49 Emergency Tensioning Devices ........ 53 Fastening ......................................... 50 Fastening, front ............................... 50 Fastening in the rear, center ............ 51 Important safety guidelines ............. 48 Releasing ......................................... 52 Safety guidelines ............................. 39 Special seat belt retractor ............... 56 Warning lamp ................................. 243 Warning lamp (function) ................... 53

Seat heating Indicator lamp (malfunction) ............ 90

Seats Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 86 Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ............................................ 89 Adjusting the head restraint ............ 86 Cleaning the cover ......................... 293 Correct driver's seat position ........... 84 Important safety notes .................... 85 Overview .......................................... 85 Storing settings (memory function) .. 95 Switching seat heating on/off ......... 89 Switching seat ventilation on/off . . . . 90

Seat ventilation Indicator lamp (malfunction) ............ 90

Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 291 Service interval display

Displaying a service message (on- board computer) ............................ 287

Service menu (on-board computer) . 214 Service products

Brake fluid ..................................... 347 Coolant (engine) ............................ 348 Engine oil ....................................... 346 Fuel ................................................ 343 Important safety notes .................. 343 Notes ............................................. 343 Refrigerant (air-conditioning system) .......................................... 347 Washer fluid ................................... 349

Setting a speed limit see SPEEDTRONIC

Settings Calling up a stored setting ............... 96 Factory (on-board computer) ......... 217 On-board computer ....................... 214

Setting the air distribution ............... 131 SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 218 Shift ranges ....................................... 150 Side marker lamp (display message) ............................................ 228 Side marker lamps (changing bulbs) 112 Side windows

Convenience opening feature .......... 78 Important safety information ........... 77 Opening/closing .............................. 77 Overview .......................................... 77 Troubleshooting ............................... 78

14 Index

Ski rack .............................................. 261 Sliding sunroof

Important safety notes .................... 79 Opening/closing .............................. 79 Operating manually .......................... 79 Problem (malfunction) ..................... 80

SmartKey Changing the battery ....................... 71 Changing the programming ............. 69 Checking the battery ....................... 70 Convenience opening feature .......... 78 Display message ............................ 242 Door central locking/unlocking ....... 68 Important safety notes .................... 68 Loss ................................................. 72 Malfunction ...................................... 72 Mechanical key ................................ 70 Overview .......................................... 68 Problem (malfunction) ..................... 72 Starting the engine ........................ 140

Snow chains ...................................... 315 Sockets

Front-passenger footwell ............... 265 Luggage compartment ................... 265 Rear compartment ......................... 265

SOS see mbrace

Spare fuses ........................................ 309 Spare wheel

Mounting ....................................... 334 Notes/data .................................... 340 Spare wheel bracket at the rear .... 297 Stainless-steel spare hub cap ........ 297

Specialist workshop ............................ 24 Special seat belt retractor .................. 52 Speed, controlling

see Cruise control Speedometer

Digital ............................................ 209 In the Instrument cluster ............... 205 Segments ...................................... 206 Selecting the unit of measurement 214 see Instrument cluster

SPEEDTRONIC Display message ............................ 236 Selecting ........................................ 175 Variable ......................................... 174

SRS see SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)

SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)

Display message ............................ 224 Introduction ..................................... 39 Warning lamp ................................. 250 Warning lamp (function) ................... 39

Standing lamps Display message ............................ 228 Switching on/off ........................... 102

Starting the engine Important safety notes .................. 140

Steering (display message) .............. 241 Steering wheel

Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 91 Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 206 Cleaning ......................................... 292 Important safety notes .................... 90 Paddle shifters ............................... 150 Steering wheel heating .................... 91 Storing settings (memory function) .. 95

Steering wheel heating Indicator lamp (malfunction) ............ 91

Steering wheel paddle shifters ........ 150 Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 218 Stowage areas ................................... 257 Stowage compartments

Armrest (under) ............................. 258 Cup holders ................................... 262 Glove box ....................................... 257 Important safety information ......... 257 Stowage pockets ........................... 258

Summer tires ..................................... 314 Sun visor ............................................ 262 Supplemental Restraint System

see SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)

Surround lighting (on-board computer) .......................................... 215 Suspension tuning

SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 218 SUV

(Sport Utility Vehicle) ....................... 23 Switching air-recirculation mode on/off ................................................. 134

Index 15

Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 65

T Tachometer ........................................ 206 Tailgate

Opening dimensions ...................... 350 Tail lamps

Display message ............................ 228 see Lights

Tank content Fuel gauge ..................................... 205

Technical data Capacities ...................................... 343 Tires ............................................... 338 Tires/wheels ................................. 338 Trailer loads ................................... 352 Vehicle data ................................... 350 Wheels ........................................... 338

TELEAID Call priority .................................... 270 Downloading destinations (COMAND) ..................................... 271 Downloading routes ....................... 273 Emergency call .............................. 268 Geo fencing ................................... 274 Important safety notes .................. 266 Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 272 MB info call button ........................ 270 Remote vehicle locking .................. 271 Roadside Assistance button .......... 269 Self-test ......................................... 267 Speed alert .................................... 273 System .......................................... 267 Triggering the vehicle alarm ........... 274 Vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis ....................................... 272 Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 271

Telephone Accepting a call ............................. 212 Display message ............................ 241 Menu (on-board computer) ............ 212 Number from the phone book ........ 213 Redialing ........................................ 213 Rejecting/ending a call ................. 212

Telephone compartment .................. 258

Temperature Coolant .......................................... 205 Coolant (on-board computer) ......... 217 Engine oil (on-board computer) ...... 217 Outside temperature ...................... 206 Setting (climate control) ................ 131

Theft deterrent systems ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 65 Immobilizer ...................................... 64

Tilt/sliding sunroof see Sliding sunroof

Time see separate operating instructions

Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 218 Tire pressure

Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 319 Checking manually ........................ 319 Display message ............................ 237 Maximum ....................................... 318 Notes ............................................. 317 Recommended ............................... 316 Table (single tires) ......................... 316

Tire pressure monitoring system Checking the tire pressure electronically ................................. 321 Function/notes ............................. 319 Restarting ...................................... 321 Warning lamp ................................. 254 Warning message .......................... 321

Tires Aspect ratio (definition) ................. 333 Average weight of the vehicle occupants (definition) .................... 332 Bar (definition) ............................... 332 Changing a wheel .......................... 334 Characteristics .............................. 331 Checking ........................................ 313 Definition of terms ......................... 332 Direction of rotation ...................... 335 Display message ............................ 237 Distribution of the vehicle occupants (definition) .................... 334 DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) ............................................... 331 DOT (Department of Transportation) (definition) ............ 332 GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) (definition) ..................................... 332

16 Index

GTW (Gross Trailer Weight) (definition) ..................................... 332 GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) (definition) ..................................... 332 GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) (definition) ......................... 333 Important safety notes .................. 312 Increased vehicle weight due to optional equipment (definition) ...... 332 Kilopascal (kPa) (definition) ........... 333 Labeling (overview) ........................ 328 Load bearing index (definition) ...... 334 Load index ..................................... 330 Load index (definition) ................... 333 Maximum loaded vehicle weight (definition) ..................................... 333 Maximum load on a tire (definition) 333 Maximum permissible tire pressure (definition) ....................... 333 Maximum tire load ......................... 331 Maximum tire load (definition) ....... 333 Optional equipment weight (definition) ..................................... 334 PSI (pounds per square inch) (definition) ..................................... 333 Replacing ....................................... 334 Service life ..................................... 314 Sidewall (definition) ....................... 334 Speed rating (definition) ................ 332 Storing ........................................... 335 Structure and characteristics (definition) ..................................... 332 Technical data ............................... 338 Temperature .................................. 327 TIN (Tire Identification Number) (definition) ..................................... 334 Tire bead (definition) ...................... 334 Tire pressure (definition) ................ 333 Tire pressures (recommended) ...... 332 Tire size (data) ............................... 338 Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity, speed rating .................... 328 Tire tread ....................................... 313 Tire tread (definition) ..................... 333 Total load limit (definition) ............. 334 Traction ......................................... 327 Traction (definition) ....................... 334 Tread wear ..................................... 327

TWR (permissible trailer drawbar noseweight) (definition) ................. 334 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards ...................................... 326 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards (definition) .................... 332 Unladen weight (definition) ............ 333 Wear indicator (definition) ............. 334 Wheel rim (definition) .................... 332 see Flat tire

Top Tether ............................................ 58 Towing

Important safety guidelines ........... 305 In the event of malfunctions .......... 308

Towing a trailer Axle load, permissible .................... 352 Driving tips .................................... 198 Lights display message .................. 226 Mounting dimensions .................... 351 Shift range ..................................... 149 Trailer loads ................................... 352 Trailer tow hitch ............................. 351

Towing away With both axles on the ground ....... 307

Towing eye Front .............................................. 306 Rear ............................................... 306

Tow-starting Emergency engine starting ............ 308 Important safety notes .................. 305

Trailer 7-pin connector ............................. 201 Power supply ................................. 200

Trailer loads Technical data ............................... 352

Trailer tow hitch Ball position ................................... 352

Trailer towing ESP ................................................ 64 PARKTRONIC ................................. 191

Transfer case General notes ................................ 193 Shifting .......................................... 194 Shifting (general notes) .................. 194 Shifting (important safety notes) . . . 194 Shifting to neutral .......................... 195 Shift range ..................................... 193

Index 17

Switching off the off-road gear ratio ............................................... 194 Switching on the off-road gear ratio ............................................... 194

Transmission see Automatic transmission

Transmission positions .................... 148 Transporting the vehicle .................. 307 Traveling uphill

Brow of hill ..................................... 168 Trip computer (on-board computer) 208 Trip odometer

Calling up ....................................... 208 Resetting (on-board computer) ...... 209

Turn signals Changing bulbs (front) ................... 111 Display message ............................ 227 Switching on/off ........................... 103

TWR (Tongue Weight Rating) (definition) ......................................... 334 Type identification plate

see Vehicle identification plate

U Unlocking

Emergency unlocking ....................... 75 From inside the vehicle (central unlocking button) ............................. 74

V Vanity mirror

Sun visor ........................................ 263 Variable SPEEDTRONIC

Function/notes ............................. 174 Vehicle

Correct use ...................................... 24 Data acquisition ............................... 25 Display message ............................ 240 Emergency locking ........................... 75 Emergency unlocking ....................... 75 Equipment ....................................... 21 Individual settings .......................... 214 Limited Warranty ............................. 25 Loading .......................................... 322 Locking (SmartKey) .......................... 68 Lowering ........................................ 338

Maintenance .................................... 22 Parking for a long period ................ 158 Pulling away ................................... 140 Raising ........................................... 336 Reporting problems ......................... 24 Securing from rolling away ............ 336 Towing away .................................. 305 Tow-starting ................................... 305 Transporting .................................. 307 Unlocking (SmartKey) ...................... 68 Vehicle data ................................... 350

Vehicle data ....................................... 350 Vehicle data (off-road driving)

Approach/departure angle ............ 351 Fording depth ................................ 350 Maximum gradient climbing ability 351

Vehicle dimensions ........................... 350 Vehicle identification number

see VIN Vehicle identification plate .............. 342 Vehicle tool kit .................................. 296 Ventilation

Setting the airflow ......................... 131 Video

Operating the DVD ......................... 212 VIN ...................................................... 342

W Warning and indicator lamps

ABS ................................................ 245 Brakes ........................................... 244 Check Engine ................................. 251 Coolant .......................................... 251 Cruise control ................................ 169 Distance warning ........................... 253 DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 253 ESP .............................................. 247 ESP OFF ....................................... 248 Fuel tank ........................................ 251 LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 178 LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 175 Overview .................................. 30, 242 Parking brake ................................ 250 PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF ............... 44 Reserve fuel ................................... 251 Seat belt ........................................ 243

18 Index

SRS ................................................ 250 Tire pressure monitor .................... 254

Warning triangle ................................ 296 Warranty .............................................. 21 Washer fluid

Display message ............................ 241 Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 338 Wheels

Changing a wheel .......................... 334 Checking ........................................ 313 Cleaning ......................................... 289 Cleaning (warning) ......................... 335 Important safety notes .................. 312 Interchanging/changing ................ 334 Mounting a new wheel ................... 337 Mounting a wheel .......................... 335 Overview ........................................ 312 Removing a wheel .......................... 337 Storing ........................................... 335 Technical data ............................... 338 Tightening torque ........................... 338 Wheel size/tire size ....................... 338

Window curtain air bag Display message ............................ 225 Operation ......................................... 43

Windows see Side windows

Windows (cleaning instructions) ..... 290 Windshield

Defrosting ...................................... 131 Windshield heating ........................... 133 Windshield washer fluid

see Windshield washer system Windshield washer system

Adding washer fluid ....................... 286 Filling capacity ............................... 349 Notes ............................................. 349

Windshield wipers Problem (malfunction) ................... 116 Rear window wiper ........................ 115 Replacing the wiper blades ............ 115 Switching on/off ........................... 114

Winter Driving in winter ............................. 163 Winter operation ............................ 314

Winter driving Snow chains .................................. 315

Winter operation Overview ........................................ 314

Winter tires M+S tires ....................................... 314

Wiper blades Cleaning ......................................... 291 Important safety notes .................. 115 Replacing ....................................... 115

Index 19

Protection of the environment

General notes

H Environmental note Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection. The objectives are for the natural resources that form the basis of our existence on this planet to be used sparingly and in a manner that takes the requirements of both nature and humanity into account. You too can help to protect the environment by operating your vehicle in an environmentally responsible manner. Fuel consumption and the rate of engine, transmission, brake and tire wear are affected by these factors: Roperating conditions of your vehicle Ryour personal driving style You can influence both factors. You should bear the following in mind: Operating conditions: Ravoid short trips as these increase fuel consumption. Ralways make sure that the tire pressures are correct. Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight. Rremove roof racks once you no longer need them. Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute to environmental protection. You should therefore adhere to the service intervals. Ralways have service work carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

Personal driving style: Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when starting the engine. Rdo notwarmup the enginewhen the vehicle is stationary. Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front. Ravoid frequent, sudden acceleration and braking.

Rchange gear in good time and use each gear only up to of its maximum engine speed. Rswitch off the engine in stationary traffic. Rkeep an eye on the vehicle's fuel consumption.

Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts

H Environmental note Daimler AG also supplies reconditionedmajor assemblies and parts which are of the same quality as new parts. They are covered by the same Limited Warranty entitlements as new parts.

! Air bags and Emergency Tensioning Devices, as well as control units and sensors for these restraint systems,may be installed in the following areas of your vehicle: Rdoors Rdoor pillars Rdoor sills Rseats Rcockpit Rinstrument cluster Rcenter console Do not install accessories such as audio systems in these areas. Do not carry out repairs or welding. You could impair the operating efficiency of the restraint systems. Have aftermarket accessories installed at a qualified specialist workshop.

You could jeopardize the operating safety of your vehicle if you use parts, tires and wheels as well as accessories relevant to safety which have not been approved by Mercedes. This could lead to malfunctions in safety- relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Use only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of equal quality. Only use tires, wheels and

20 Introduction

accessories that have been specifically approved for your vehicle. Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts are subject to strict quality control. Every part has been specifically developed, manufactured or selected for and adapted to Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts should therefore be used. More than 300,000 different genuine Mercedes-Benz parts are available for Mercedes-Benz models. All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a supply of genuine Mercedes-Benz parts for necessary service and repair work. In addition, strategically located parts delivery centers provide quick and reliable parts service. Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) when ordering genuine Mercedes-Benz parts (Y page 342).

Operator's Manual

General notes The printed Operator's Manual (including any supplements) must be observed. There is no electronic update to the Digital Operator's Manual. Amendments are only made to the printed Operator's Manual.

Vehicle equipment This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of going to print. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety-related systems and functions. The equipment in your vehicle may therefore differ from some of the descriptions or illustrations. The original purchase agreement lists all systems installed in your vehicle.

Contact an authorizedMercedes-BenzCenter if you have any questions about equipment or operation. The Operator's Manual and the Maintenance Booklet are important documents and should be kept in the vehicle.

Service and vehicle operation

Warranty Your vehicle is covered under the terms of the warranties printed in the Service and Warranty Information booklet. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will replace and repair all factory-installed parts in accordance with the following warranty terms and conditions: RNew Vehicle Limited Warranty REmission Systems Warranty REmission Performance Warranty RCalifornia, Connecticut, Maine, Massachusetts, New York, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island and Vermont Emission Control System Warranty RState warranty enforcement laws (Lemon Laws)

Replacement parts and accessories are covered by the Mercedes-Benz Parts and Accessories warranties. These are available at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

i If you lose the Service and Warranty Information booklet, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to arrange a replacement. It will be mailed to you.

Introduction 21

Z

Information for customers in California In California, you have the right to exchange a vehicle or receive a refund of the purchase or leasing price if Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC and/or an authorized workshop or maintenance facility cannot, after several authorized repairs, rectify considerable damage to or malfunctions of the vehicle that are covered by the contractual warranty. During the period of 18 months from original delivery of the vehicle or the accumulation of 18,000 miles (approximately 29,000 km) on the odometer of the vehicle, whichever occurs first, a reasonable number of repair attempts is presumed for a retail buyer or lessee if one or more of the following occurs: (1) the serious defect or damage can result

in deadly or serious injury to the vehicle occupants while driving AND this defect has already been repaired at least twice AND Mercedes-Benz, LLC has been informed in writing of the necessity of a repair.

(2) the defect or damage, though less serious than (1) above, has already been repaired at least four times AND Mercedes-Benz has been informed in writing of the necessity of a repair.

(3) the vehicle cannot be used for longer than 30 calendar days because of repair work resulting from this or other serious defects or damage.

Please send your written notice to: Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC Customer Assistance Center One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350

Maintenance The Service and Warranty Booklet describes all the necessary maintenance work which should be done at regular intervals.

Always have the Service and Warranty Booklet with you when you bring the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The service advisor will record every service for you in the Service and Warranty Booklet.

Roadside Assistance The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program offers technical help in the event of a breakdown. Calls to the toll-free Roadside Assistance Hotline are answered by our agents 24 hours a day, 365 days a year. 1-800-FOR-MERCedes(1-800-367-6372) (USA) 1-800-387-0100 (Canada) For additional information, refer to the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program brochure (USA) or the "Roadside Assistance" section in the Service and Warranty booklet (Canada). You will find both in your vehicle literature portfolio.

Change of address or change of ownership In the event of a change of address, please send us the "Notification of Address Change" in the Service and Guarantee booklet or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center (USA) at the hotline number 1-800-FOR-MERCedes(1-800-367-6372) or Customer Service Center (Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. This will assist us in contacting you in a timely manner should the need arise. If you sell your Mercedes, please leave the entire literature in the vehicle so that it is available to the next owner. If you have purchased a used car, please send us the "Notification of Used Car Purchase" in the Service and Guarantee booklet or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center (USA) at the hotline number 1-800-FOR-MERCedes(1-800-367-6372) or

22 Introduction

Customer Service (Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.

Vehicle operation outside the USA and Canada If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign countries, please be aware that: Rservice facilities or replacement parts may not be readily available. Runleaded fuel for vehicles with a catalytic convertermay not be available. Leaded fuel may cause damage to the catalytic converter. Rthe fuel may have a considerably lower octane rating. Unsuitable fuel can cause engine damage.

Some Mercedes-Benz models are available for delivery in Europe through our European Delivery Program. For details, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to one of the following addresses. In the USA Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC European Delivery Department One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 In Canada Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc. European Delivery Department 98 Vanderhoof Avenue Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9

Sports Utility Vehicle

G WARNING This Sport Utility Vehicle is designed for both on-road and off-road use. It can go places and perform tasks for which conventional 2-wheel drive passenger cars are not intended. This vehicle will handle and maneuver differently from conventional passenger cars in driving

conditions which may occur on streets, highways and off-road use. This vehicle has a higher ground clearance and a higher center of gravity than many passenger cars. As with other vehicles of this type, if you make sharp turns at excessive speeds or abrupt maneuvers, the vehicle may roll over or may go out of control and crash. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. Failure to operate this vehicle safely may result in an accident, rollover of the vehicle, and severe or fatal injury. Before you start to drive this vehicle, read the Operator's Manual. Take time to become familiar with the driving characteristics of this vehicle. Be sure you are familiar with all vehicle controls. Learn how your vehicle handles on different road surfaces. Do not attempt sharp turns at excessive speeds or abrupt maneuvers or other unsafe driving actions that can cause loss of vehicle control. When driving off-road or working the vehicle hard, do not overload it. And, always wear your seat belts at all times. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.

Operating safety

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you do not have the prescribed service/ maintenance work or any required repairs carried out, this can result in malfunctions or system failures. There is a risk of an accident. Always have the prescribed service/ maintenance work as well as any required repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

G WARNING Modifications to electronic components, their software as well as wiring can impair their function and/or the function of other

Introduction 23

Z

networked components. In particular, systems relevant to safety could also be affected. As a result, these may no longer function as intended and/or jeopardize the operating safety of the vehicle. There is an increased risk of an accident and injury. Never tamper with the wiring as well as electronic components or their software. You should have all work to electrical and electronic equipment carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

Tampering with the electronic components, their software or wiring can render the operating permit invalid.

Declarations of conformity

Vehicle components which receive and/or transmit radio waves USA: "The wireless devices of this vehicle comply with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1) These devices may not cause harmful interference, and 2) These devices must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment." Canada: "The wireless devices of this vehicle comply with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) These devices may not cause interference, and (2) These devices must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device."

Qualified specialist workshop An authorized Mercedes-Benz Center is a qualified specialist workshop. It has the necessary specialist knowledge, tools and

qualifications to correctly carry out the work required on your vehicle. This is especially the case for work relevant to safety. Observe the notes in the Maintenance Booklet. Always have the following work carried out at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center: Rwork relevant to safety Rservice and maintenance work Rrepair work Ralterations, installation work and modifications Rwork on electronic components

Correct use Observe the following information when driving your vehicle: Rthe safety notes in this manual Rthe Technical Data section in this manual Rtraffic rules and regulations Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to motor vehicles

If you remove any warning stickers, you or others could fail to recognize certain dangers. Leave warning stickers in position.

Problems with your vehicle If you should experience a problem with your vehicle, particularly one that you believe may affect its safe operation, we urge you to contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the problem diagnosed and rectified. If the problem is not resolved to your satisfaction, please discuss the problem again with a Mercedes-Benz Center or contact us at one of the following addresses. In the USA Customer Assistance Center Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350

24 Introduction

In Canada Customer Relations Department Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc. 98 Vanderhoof Avenue Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9

Reporting safety defects USA only: The following text is reproduced as required of all manufacturers according to Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966. If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC. If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA Headquarters, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE, West Building, Washington, DC 20590. You can obtain additional information about vehicle safety from: http://www.safercar.gov

Limited Warranty ! Follow the instructions in this manual about the proper operation of your vehicle as well as about possible vehicle damage. Damage to your vehicle that arises from culpable contraventions against these

instructions is not covered either by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty or by the New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.

Data stored in the vehicle

Information about electronic data acquisition in the vehicle (Including notice pursuant to California Code 9951) Please note that your vehicle is equippedwith devices that can record vehicle systems data. If your vehicle is equipped with mbrace (Canada: TELE AID), data is transmitted in the event of an accident. This information helps, for example, to test vehicle systems after an accident and to continually improve vehicle safety. Daimler AG can access these data and submit them: Rfor safety research or vehicle diagnosis purposes Rwith the consent of the vehicle owner Ron the instruction of prosecuting authorities Rfor use in arbitration of disputes that involve Daimler AG, its subsidiaries or its sales and service organizations Ras otherwise required or permitted by law Please check your mbrace (Canada: TELE AID) purchase agreement to find out more about data that can be recorded and transmitted by this system.

Information on copyright

Registered trademarks Registered trademarks: RBluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG Inc. RDTS is a registered trademark of DTS, Inc. RDolby and MLP are registered trademarks of DOLBY Laboratories.

Introduction 25

Z

RBabySmart, ESP and PRE-SAFE are registered trademarks of Daimler AG. RHomeLink is a registered trademark of Prince. RiPod and iTunes are registered trademarks of Apple Inc. RLogic7 is a registered trademark of Harman International Industries. RMicrosoft and Windows media are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. RSIRIUS is a registered trademark of Sirius XM radio Inc. RHD Radio is a registered trademark of iBiquity Digital Corporation. RGracenote is a registered trademark of Gracenote, Inc. RZAGATSurvey and related brands are registered trademarks of ZagatSurvey, LLC.

FreeType Portions of this software are copyright2005 The FreeType Project (www.freetype.org). All rights reserved. 1996-2000 by David Turner, RobertWilhelm, andWerner Lemberg.

Gnu compiler Copyright 1982, 1986 Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. The Berkeley software License Agreement specifies the terms and conditions for redistribution. Redistributions and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistribution of source code must retain

the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.

2. Redistribution in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following

disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.

3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: This product includes software developed by the University of California, Berkeley and its contributors.

4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANYDIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSEDANDONANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

26 Introduction

Dashboard ........................................... 28 Instrument cluster .............................. 29 Multifunction steering wheel ............. 31 Center console .................................... 32 Overhead control panel ...................... 34 Door control panel .............................. 35

27

At a gl an ce

Dashboard

Function Page : Combination switch 103

; Steering wheel paddle shifters

= Instrument cluster 205

? Horn

A Overhead control panel 34

B PARKTRONIC warning display 189

C Climate control systems 118

D Ignition lock 139

E Adjusts the steering wheel 90

F Cruise control lever 169

G Light switch 98

H Opens the hood 283

28 Dashboard At

a gl an ce

Instrument cluster

Displays and controls

Function Page : Speedometer with segments 206

; Multifunction display 207

= Tachometer 206

? Coolant temperature display 205

A Fuel gauge

B Instrument cluster lighting control 205

Instrument cluster 29

At a gl an ce

Warning and indicator lamps

Function Page : L Low-beam

headlamps 99

; ESP 247

= K High-beam headlamps 103

? J Brakes (yellow) 244

A Distance warning 253

B #! Turn signals 103

C h Tire pressure monitor 254

D 6 SRS 250

E Seat belt 243

Function Page F ? Coolant 251

G R Rear fog lamp 101

H O Front fog lamps 101

I ; Check Engine 251

J 8 Reserve fuel 251

K ESP OFF 247

L ! ABS 245

M Brakes (red) $ (USA only) J (Canada only) 244

30 Instrument cluster At

a gl an ce

Multifunction steering wheel

Function Page : Multifunction display ~

; COMAND display ~

= ?

Switches on the Voice Control System; see the separate operating instructions

? ~ ~

Rejects or ends a call Exits phone book/redial memory 6

Makes or accepts a call Switches to the redial memory WX

Adjusts the volume 8

Mute

Function Page A =; ~

Selects a menu 9:

Selects a submenu or scrolls through lists a

Confirms selections and hides messages

B %

Back Switches off the Voice Control System; see the separate operating instructions

Multifunction steering wheel 31

At a gl an ce

Center console

Center console, upper section

Function Page : Audio system; see the

separate operating instructions COMAND ~

; Seat heating 89

= s Seat ventilation 90

? c PARKTRONIC 189

Function Page A ECO start/stop

function 141

B Hazard warning lamps 104

C 45 Indicator lamp

D ESP 62

32 Center console At

a gl an ce

Center console, lower section

Function Page F Stowage compartment/

ashtray 263

G Automatic transmission selector lever 145

H Selects park position 146

I + Selects/deselects LOW RANGE off-road gear 194

J Stowage compartment ~

K Opens/closes the stowage compartment 257

L Cigarette lighter 264

M Audio controller, see the separate operating instructions COMAND controller ~

N Switches the windshield heating on/off 133

O Selects the drive program 149

P Parking brake 157

Center console 33

At a gl an ce

Overhead control panel

Function Page : p Switches the left-

hand reading lamp on/off 105

; c Switches the front interior lighting on 106

= u Switches the rear interior lighting on/off 106

? | Switches the front interior lighting/automatic interior lighting control off 106

A p Switches the right- hand reading lamp on/off 105

B Opens/closes the sliding sunroof 79

C F Roadside Assistance call button (mbrace system) 269

Function Page D G SOS button (mbrace

system) 268

E MB Info call button (mbrace system) 270

F Rear-view mirror 93

G Buttons for the garage door opener 278

H Microphone for mbrace (emergency call system), telephone and the Voice Control System

34 Overhead control panel At

a gl an ce

Door control panel

Function Page : n Activates/

deactivates the override feature for the side windows in the rear compartment 60

; W Opens/closes the side windows 77

= 7Z\ Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically 93

Function Page ? r45=

Stores settings for the seat, exterior mirrors and steering wheel (memory function) 95

A Adjusts the seats 86

B %& Unlocks/locks the vehicle 74

C Opens the door 73

Door control panel 35

At a gl an ce

36

Useful information .............................. 38 Panic alarm .......................................... 38 Occupant safety .................................. 38 Children in the vehicle ........................ 54 Driving safety systems ....................... 60 Theft deterrent locking system ......... 64

37

Sa fe ty

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Panic alarm

X To activate: press! button: for at least one second. An alarm sounds and the indicator lamp flashes.

X To deactivate: press! button: again.

or X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.

i USA only: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. The Product label with FCC ID and IC certification number can be found in the battery case of the SmartKey.

i Canada only: This device complies with the RSS-210 Rules of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. The Product label with FCC ID and IC certification number can be found in the battery case of the SmartKey.

Occupant safety

Important safety notes

G WARNING Modifications to the restraint system, may cause it to no longer work as intended. The restraint system may then not perform its intended protective function by failing in an accident or triggering unexpectedly, for example. There is an increased risk of injury. Never modify parts of the restraint system. Never tamper with the wiring as well as electronic components or their software.

In this section, you will learn the most important facts about the restraint system components of the vehicle. The restraint system consists of: RSeat belts RChild restraint systems RLATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat securing system

38 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

Additional protection is provided by: RSRS (Supplemental Restraint System) RNECK-PRO head restraints RAir bag system components with:

- The 4 5 indicator lamp - Front-passenger seat with BabySmart air bag deactivation system

Although the systems are independent, their protective functions work in conjunction with each other. Not all air bags are always deployed in an accident.

i Observe the additional information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle and restraint systems for infants and children (Y page 54).

SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)

Introduction SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming into contact with the vehicle's interior in the event of an accident. It can also reduce the effect of the forces to which occupants are subjected during an accident. SRS consists of: RSRS warning lamps 6 RAir bags RAir bag control unit (with crash sensors) REmergency Tensioning Device (ETD) for seat belts RSeat belt force limiter

SRS warning lamp SRS functions are checked regularly when you switch on the ignition and when the engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions can be detected in good time. The6 SRSwarning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out no later than a few seconds after the engine is started.

The SRS components are in operational readiness when the 6 SRS indicator lamp goes out while the engine is running.

Safety guidelines for seat belts, Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) and air bags

G WARNING RDamaged seat belts or seat belts that have been subjected to stress in an accident must be replaced. Their anchoring points must also be checked. Only use seat belts installed or supplied by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RAir bags and pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) contain perchlorate material, which may require special handling and regard for the environment. Check your national disposal guidelines. California residents, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/HazardousWaste/ Perchlorate/index.cfm. RAir bags and ETDs are designed to function on a one-time-only basis. An air bag or ETD that has deployed must be replaced. RDo not pass seat belts over sharp edges. They could tear. RDo not make any modification that could change the effectiveness of the seat belts. RDo not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash they may not be able to provide adequate protection. RNo modifications of any kind may be made to any components or wiring of the SRS. RDo not change or remove any component or part of the SRS. RDo not install additional trim material, seat covers, badges, etc. over the steering wheel hub, front-passenger front air bag cover, outer sides of the seat backrests, door trim panels, or door frame trims. RDo not install additional electrical/ electronic equipment on or near SRS components and wiring.

Occupant safety 39

Sa fe ty

Z

RKeep area between air bags and occupants free of objects (e.g. packages, purses, umbrellas, etc.). RDo not hang items such as coat hangers from the coat hooks or handles over the door. These items may be thrown around in the vehicle and cause head and other injuries when the window curtain air bag is deployed. RAir bag systemcomponentswill be hot after an air bag has inflated. Do not touch them. RNever place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard, or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the floor in front of the seat. RImproper repair work on the SRS creates a risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or causing unintended air bag deployment. Work on the SRS must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RFor your protection and the protection of others, when scrapping the air bag unit or ETD, our safety instructions must be followed. These instructions are available from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RGiven the considerable deployment speed, required inflation volume, and the material of the air bags, there is the possibility of abrasions or other, potentiallymore serious injuries resulting from air bag deployment.

If you sell your vehicle, Mercedes-Benz strongly recommends that you inform the subsequent owner that the vehicle is equipped with SRS. Also, refer them to the applicable section in the Operator's Manual.

Air bags

Important safety notes

G WARNING Air bags are designed to reduce the potential of injury and fatality in certain Rfrontal impacts (front air bags) Rside impacts (window curtain air bags) However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities. Deployment of the air bags temporarily releases a small amount of dust from the air bags. This dust, however, is neither harmful to your health, nor does it indicate a fire in the vehicle. The dust might cause some temporary breathing difficulty for people with asthma or other breathing trouble. To avoid this, you may wish to get out of the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. If you have any breathing difficulty but cannot get out of the vehicle after the air bag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a window or door.

G WARNING To reduce the risk of injury when the front air bags inflate, it is very important for the driver and front passenger to always be in a properly seated position and to wear their respective seat belt. For maximum protection in the event of a collision always be in normal seated position with your back against the seat backrest. Fasten your seat belt and make sure it is properly positioned on your body.

40 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

Since the air bag inflates with considerable speed and force, a proper seating position and correct positioning of the hands on the steering wheel will help to keep you at a safe distance from the air bag. Occupants who are not wearing their seat belt, are not seated properly or are too close to the air bag can be seriously injured or killed by an air bag as it inflates with great force instantaneously: RSit with the seat belt properly fastened in a position that is as upright as possible with your back against the seat backrest. RMove the driver's seat as far back as possible, still permitting proper operation of vehicle controls. The distance from the center of the driver's chest to the center of the air bag cover on the steering wheel must be at least 10 inches (25 cm) or more. You should be able to accomplish this by adjusting the seat and steering wheel. If you have any difficulties, please contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RDo not lean your head or chest close to the steering wheel or dashboard. RKeep hands on the outside of the steering wheel rim. Placing hands and arms inside the rim can increase the risk and potential severity of hand/arm injury when the driver front air bag inflates. RAdjust the front passenger seat as far as possible rearward from the dashboard when the seat is occupied. ROccupants, especially children, should never place their bodies or lean their heads in the area of the door where the window curtain air bag inflates. This could result in serious injuries or death should the window curtain air bag be deployed. Always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. RChildren 12 years old and undermust never ride in the front seat, except in a Mercedes- Benz authorized BabySmart compatible

child seat, which operates with the BabySmart air bag deactivation system installed in the vehicle to deactivate the front passenger front air bag when it is installed properly. Otherwise they will be struck by the air bag when it inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal injury will result.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injuries to you or other occupants. If you sell your vehicle, it is important that you make the buyer aware of this safety information. Be sure to give the buyer this Operator's Manual.

G WARNING Accident research shows that the safest place for children in an automobile is in a rear seat. Should you choose to place a child 12 years old or under in the front passenger seat of your vehicle, you must properly use a BabySmartTM child restraint which will turn off the front passenger front air bag. To help avoid the possibility of injury, please follow these guidelines:

(1) Always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly, and for children 12 years old and under, use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child.

(2) Always wear seat belts properly.

G WARNING The service life of the air bag is limited to 15 years. After a maximum of 15 years, have the air bag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop that has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose.

Occupant safety 41

Sa fe ty

Z

In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

The air bags are deployed if the air bag control unit detects the need for deployment. Only in the event of such a situation will the air bags provide their supplemental protection. If the driver and front passenger do not wear their seat belts, it is not possible for the air bags to provide their supplemental protection. In the event of other types of impacts and impacts below air bag deployment thresholds, the air bags will not deploy. The driver and passenger will then be protected to the extent possible by a properly fastened seat belt. A properly fastened seat belt is also needed to provide the best possible protection if the vehicle rolls over. Air bags provide additional protection; they are not, however, a substitute for seat belts. All vehicle occupants must fasten their seat belts regardless of whether your vehicle is equipped with air bags or not. It is important for your safety and that of your passenger to have deployed air bags replaced and to have any malfunctioning air bags repaired. This will help to make sure the air bags continue to provide supplemental crash protection for occupants.

Front air bags

G WARNING Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 40).

G WARNING Your vehicle is equipped with air bag technology which disables the front- passenger air bag if the system recognizes that the front-passenger seat is empty . If the front-passenger seat is occupied by an adult or young person and the 4/ indicator lamp is lit up, the front-passenger air

bag is disabled. If the front-passenger seat is recognized as empty, the air bag control unit will not deploy the front-passenger air bag in the event of a collision. Ask your passenger to sit correctly on the front-passenger seat in an upright position until the 4/ indicator lamp goes out. If the 4/ indicator lamp does not go out, please consult an authorized Mercedes- Benz Center.

Driver's air bag: deploys in front of the steering wheel; front-passenger front air bag; deploys in front of and above the glove box. The front air bags increase protection for the driver's and front-passenger's head, neck and chest. They are deployed: Rin the event of certain frontal impacts Rif the system determines that air bag deployment can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat belt Rindependently of other air bags in the vehicle Rdepending onwhether the seat belt is being used

If the vehicle rolls over, the front air bags are generally not deployed. If the system detects high vehicle deceleration in a longitudinal direction, the front air bags are deployed. Your vehicle is equipped with a dual-stage driver's air bag and a single-stage front- passenger front air bag. In the event of a collision, the air bag control unit evaluates the

42 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

vehicle deceleration. In the first deployment stage, the driver's air bag is filled with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries. The front-passenger front air bag, however, is immediately filled with the maximum amount of propellant gas. The driver's air bag is fully deployed if a second deployment threshold is exceeded within a few milliseconds. The lighter the front passenger, the higher the vehicle deceleration rate required (predicted at the start of the impact) for triggering the front-passenger front air bag. The front air bags will not deploy in impacts with vehicle deceleration or acceleration rates which do not exceed the systems preset deployment thresholds for vehicle deceleration or acceleration. You will then be protected by the fastened seat belt. Front-passenger front air bag; will only deploy if: Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied Rthe 45 indicator lamp on the center console is not lit (Y page 44) Rthe impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold

The front-passenger air bag is automatically activated and deactivated. Both driver and passenger should always check whether the front-passenger air bag is activated or deactivated. The deployment of the driver's air bag does not mean that the front-passenger air bag will also deploy. If the system recognizes that the front-passenger seat is empty, the front- passenger air bag does not deploy even if the impact fulfills the criteria and the driver's air bag has deployed. If the systemdetects that the front-passenger seat is occupied, the 4 5 indicator lamp lights up for approximately six seconds if: Ryou turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock. Rthe engine is running and then you switch it off.

This indicates the operational readiness of the front-passenger air bag. Note that objects placed on the front- passenger seat may cause the system to recognize the seat as occupied. This can result in the deployment of the front- passenger air bag if the impact fulfills the specified criteria. If the 4 5 indicator lamp lights up, the front-passenger front air bag is disabled and will not be deployed in certain situations. If the 4 5 indicator lamp does not light up, the front-passenger front air bag is enabled and can be deployed.

Window curtain air bags

G WARNING Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 40).

Window curtain air bags: enhance the level of protection for the head, but not chest or arms, of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the impact occurs. Window curtain air bags: are integrated into the side of the roof frame and deploy in the area extending from the front door (A- pillar) to the rear door (C-pillar). Window curtain air bags: are deployed: Ron the side on which an impact occurs Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact Rregardless of whether the front-passenger seat is occupied

Occupant safety 43

Sa fe ty

Z

Rindependently of seat belt use Rif the vehicle rolls over and the system determines that window curtain air bag deployment can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat belt Rindependently of the front air bags Window curtain air bags will not deploy in impacts which do not exceed the system's preset deployment thresholds for lateral acceleration/deceleration. You will then be protected by the fastened seat belt.

BabySmart air bag deactivation system

How the air bag deactivation system works

G WARNING According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in the front seating position. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be placed in the rear seats whenever possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint must be properly secured with the vehicle's seat belt, the seat belt and top tether strap, or lower anchors and top tether strap, fully in accordance with the child seat manufacturer's instructions. Occupants, especially children, should always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child.

Children can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating air bag. Note the following important information when circumstances require you to place a child in the front passenger seat: RChildren 12 years old and undermust never ride in the front seat, except in a Mercedes- Benz authorized BabySmart compatible child seat, which operates with the BabySmart system installed in the vehicle to deactivate the front passenger front air bag when it is installed properly. Otherwise they will be struck by the air bag when it inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal injury will result. RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. The only means to completely eliminate this risk is to never place a child in a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat. We therefore strongly recommend that you always place a child in a rear-facing child restraint in a backseat. RIf you must install a BabySmart compatible rear-facing child restraint on the front passenger seat because circumstances require you to do so, make sure the 4 / indicator lamp is illuminated, indicating that the front passenger front air bag is deactivated. Should the 4 / indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. Periodically check the 4 / indicator lamp while driving to make sure the 4 / indicator lamp is illuminated. If the 4 / indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do not transport a child on the front passenger seat until the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front passenger seat will be seriously

44 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

injured or even killed if the front passenger front air bag inflates. RIf you have to place a child in a forward- facing child restraint on the front passenger seat, move the seat as far back as possible, use the proper child restraint recommended for the age, size and weight of the child, and secure child restraint with the vehicle's seat belt according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions.

G WARNING When using a BabySmart compatible child seat on the front passenger seat, the front passenger front air bag will not deploy only if the 4 / indicator lamp remains illuminated. Please be sure to check the 4 / indicator lamp every time you use a BabySmart compatible child seat on the front passenger seat. Should the 4 / indicator lamp go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. If the 4 / indicator lamp remains out, do not use the BabySmart restraint to transport a child on the front passenger seat until the system has been repaired.

G WARNING The BabySmart air bag disabling system ONLY works with specially adapted child restraint systems. It does not work with child restraint systems that are not compatiblewith BabySmart. Never place anything between the seat cushion and the child restraint system (e.g. a cushion), as this reduces the effectiveness of the BabySmart air bag deactivation system. The underside of the child restraint system must lie against the seat cushion of the front- passenger seat. In the event of an accident, an incorrectly installed child restraint system could injure the child instead of offering protection.

Observe the manufacturer's instructions when installing special child restraint systems.

Your vehicle is equipped with a BabySmart system. Special child restraint systems which are compatible with BabySmart are necessary for deactivating the front-passenger air bag. When the special BabySmart-compatible child restraint system is installed correctly and is recognized by the sensor system in the front-passenger seat, the front-passenger air bag is deactivated. In this case, 45 indicator lamp: lights up. If you have any questions regarding the special BabySmart- compatible child restraint systems, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition lock or is in position 0, 45 indicator lamp: does not light up. The system does not disable: Rthe window curtain air bag Rthe Emergency Tensioning Device

System self-test

G WARNING Do not leave any switched on notebooks, mobile phones, electronic tags (e.g. a ski pass) or similar electronic devices on the front-passenger seat. Signals emitted from such devices can interfere with the BabySmart air bag deactivation system. Such interference can lead to the 45

Occupant safety 45

Sa fe ty

Z

indicator lamp not lighting up during the self- test. If the + SRS warning lamp and the 4/ indicator lamp light up simultaneously in the instrument cluster, the system is malfunctioning. The front- passenger air bag could deploywithout cause, or may fail to deploy in the event of an accident. Have the system checked as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

The 45 indicator lamp lights up when the SmartKey is turned to position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock. The 45 indicator lamp goes out after approximately six seconds. If the 45 indicator lamp does not light up or is always lit, then the system is malfunctioning. Have the BabySmart system checked at an authorized Mercedes- Benz Center before transporting a child on the front-passenger seat. For further information, see "Problems with air bag deactivation system" (Y page 47).

46 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

Problems with the air bag deactivation system

G WARNING If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated when the weight of a typical adult or someone larger than a small individual has been detected on the passenger seat, do not allow any occupant to use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired.

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

The 45 indicator lamp is continuously lit.

A special BabySmart-compatible child restraint system is mounted on the front-passenger seat. The front-passenger air bag is therefore disabled.

There is no BabySmart-compatible child restraint system mounted on the front-passenger seat. The BabySmart system is malfunctioning. X Have the BabySmart system checked as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

The 45 indicator lamp does not light up and/or remain lit when a BabySmart- compatible child restraint system is installed on the front- passenger seat.

The BabySmart system is malfunctioning. X Make sure there is nothing between the seat cushion and the child restraint system.

X Check that the child restraint system is installed correctly. X If the 45 indicator lamp does not light up, have the BabySmart system checked as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the air bag deactivation system has been repaired.

NECK-PRO head restraints

Important safety notes

G WARNING Do not secure any objects (e.g. coat hangers) on the NECK-PRO head restraints. Otherwise, the NECK-PRO head restraints may not function properly, or in the event of a rear-end collision may not be able offer the level of protection they are designed to provide.

G WARNING Head restraint covers prevent the NECK-PRO head restraints from triggering correctly. Consequently, the NECK-PRO head restraints

cannot provide the intended level of protection. Do not use head restraint covers.

G WARNING For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation.

The NECK-PRO head restraints increase protection to the driver's and the front passenger's head and neck. The NECK-PRO head restraints on the driver's and front-

Occupant safety 47

Sa fe ty

Z

passenger seats are moved forwards and upwards in the event of a rear-end collision of a certain severity. This provides better head support. If the NECK-PRO head restraints have been triggered in an accident, reset the NECK-PRO head restraints on the drivers and front- passenger seat (Y page 48). Otherwise, the additional protection will not be available in the event of another rear-end collision. You can recognize if NECK-PRO head restraints have been triggered by the fact that they have moved forwards and can no longer be adjusted.

Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head restraints

G WARNING For safety reasons, have the NECK-PRO head restraints checked at a qualified specialist workshop after a rear-end collision.

G WARNING When pushing back the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion, make sure your fingers do not become caught between the head restraint cushion and the cover. Failure to observe this could result in injuries.

X Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion forwards in the direction of arrow:.

X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion down in the direction of arrow; as far as it will go.

X Firmly push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion back in the direction of arrow= until the cushion engages.

X Repeat this procedure for the second NECK-PRO head restraint.

i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints, have this work carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

Seat belts

Important safety notes Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat belts which have been approved specifically for your vehicle by Mercedes- Benz.

G WARNING Always fasten your seat belt before driving off. Always make sure all of your passengers are properly restrained. You and your passengers should always wear seat belts. Failure to wear and properly fasten and position your seat belt greatly increases your risk of injuries and their likely severity in an accident. If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can be considerably more severe without your seat belt properly buckled. Without your seat belt buckled, you are much more likely to hit the interior of the vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, the possibility of injury or death is lessened if you are properly wearing your seat belt. The air bags can only protect as intended if the occupants are properly wearing their seat belts.

G WARNING Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under

48 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and the seat belt is properly positioned on the body.

G WARNING Never let more people ride in the vehicle than there are seat belts available. Make sure everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly restrained with a separate seat belt. Never use a seat belt for more than one person at a time.

G WARNING Always have damaged seat belts or seat belts that have been subjected to a load in an accident replaced and the anchorages checked. Only use seat belts that have been approved by Mercedes-Benz. Never tamper with seat belts. This can result in the unintended deployment of the Emergency Tensioning Devices or the failure to deploy when necessary. Do not bleach or dye seat belts, as this may severely weaken them. In the event of a collision, they may be unable to provide adequate protection. Have all work carried out only by qualified technicians. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

The use of infant or child restraints is required by law in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, all U.S. territories and all Canadian provinces. Even where this is not the case, all vehicle occupants should have their seat belts fastened when the vehicle is in motion.

i See "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 54) for further information on infants and children traveling in the vehicle, as well as on child restraint systems.

Correct use of the seat belts

G WARNING CORRECT USE OF SEAT BELTS RSeat belts only work properly if they are fastened correctly. Never wear seat belts in any other way than as described in this section, as that could result in serious injuries in the event of an accident. RAll occupants should wear their seat belt at all times, because seat belts help reduce the likelihood of and potential severity of injuries in accidents, even if the vehicle overturns. The restraint system installed is equipped with SRS (driver's air bag, front- passenger air bag, window curtain air bags), belt tensioners and belt force limiters. The system is designed to enhance the protection offered to occupants who are wearing their seat belts correctly, in certain frontal impacts (front air bags and belt tensioners) and side impacts (window curtain air bags and belt tensioners) which exceed preset deployment thresholds. RNever route the shoulder section of the seat belt under your arm, across your neck or anywhere other than across your shoulder. In the event of a frontal impact, your body would be moved too far forward. This would increase the risk of head and neck injuries. The seat belt would then apply excessive force to the ribs or abdomen which could cause severe internal injuries to organs such as the liver or spleen. Adjust the seat belt so that the upper part of the belt is as close as possible to the center of the shoulder. It should not touch the neck. Never route the belt under the shoulder. The height of the belt outlet can be altered to ensure correct usage. RThe lap belt should be routed as low as possible across the hips, not across the abdomen. If the lap belt is routed across the

Occupant safety 49

Sa fe ty

Z

abdomen, it could cause serious injuries in the event of an impact. RNever route the seat belt over rigid or fragile objects in or on your clothing, such as eyeglasses, pens, keys etc, as this could cause injuries. RAlways ensure that the seat belt is routed correctly. This is particularly important if you are wearing loose clothing. ROnly one person should use each seat belt at any one time. Never use a seat belt to restrain more than one person or route the belt around additional objects. RNever wear seat belts when they are twisted. Otherwise, in the event of an impact, the full width of the seat belt is unavailable to distribute the force of the impact. The twisted seat belt routed across your body could cause injuries. RPregnant women should also wear a three- point seat belt. The lap belt must always pass across your lap as low down as possible, i.e. across your hips; not across your abdomen. RThe seat backrest should be set as close to vertical as possible. RCheck the seat belt during the journey in order to make sure that it is correctly positioned. RNever rest your feet on the dashboard or the seat. Always keep both feet on the floor in front of the seat. RWhen using a seat belt to secure an infant restraint system, child restraint system or a child on a booster seat, always follow the child seat manufacturer's instructions.

Fastening seat belts

Important safety notes G WARNING According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained on the rear seats than on the front-passenger seat. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be

placed in the rear seat whenever possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriately sized child restraint system or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. For additional information, see the "Children in the vehicle" section. A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/ or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint.

G WARNING Children 12 years old and under must never ride in the front seat, except in a Mercedes- Benz authorized BabySmart compatible child seat, which operates with the BabySmart system installed in the vehicle to deactivate the front passenger front air bag when it is installed properly. Otherwise they will be struck by the air bag when it inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal injury will result.

Three-point seat belt, front

50 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

X Adjust the seat and move the backrest to an almost vertical position (Y page 84).

X Pull the seat belt smoothly through belt sash guide:.

X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of your shoulder and the lap section across your hips.

X Engage belt tongue; in buckle=. X If necessary, adjust the seat belt to the appropriate height (Y page 52).

X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder section of the seat belt to tighten the belt across your body.

Further information on releasing the seat belts with release button?(Y page 52).

Three-point seat belt in the rear, center

: Bracket for seat belt tongues ; Belt buckle for fixed belt tongue = Release button for fixed belt tongue ? Fixed belt tongue A Belt buckle for moveable belt tongue B Release button for moveable belt tongue C Moveable belt tongue

X Pull both seat belt tongues? andC from bracket:.

X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the seat belt retractor.

X Engage fixed seat belt tongue? in buckle;.

Occupant safety 51

Sa fe ty

Z

X Pull movable seat belt tongueC and route the seat belt across your body. Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across themiddle of your shoulder and the lap section across your hips.

X Engage movable seat belt tongueC in buckleA.

X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder section of the seat belt to tighten the belt across your body.

Further information on releasing the seat belts with release buttonsB and =(Y page 52).

Special seat belt retractor All seat belts in the vehicle with the exception of the driver's are equipped with a special seat belt retractor, to which a child restraint system can be secured. For further information on the "special seat belt retractor" (Y page 56).

Belt height adjustment You can adjust the belt height on the driver's and front-passenger seat, as well as on the outer rear seats.

Adjust the height so that the upper part of the seat belt is routed across the center of your shoulder. X To raise: slide the belt sash guide upwards. The belt sash guide engages in various positions.

X To lower: draw belt sash guide release: forwards and hold it.

X Slide the belt sash guide downwards. X Let go of belt sash guide release: and make sure that the belt sash guide has engaged.

Releasing seat belts ! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue will be trapped in the door or in the seat mechanism. This could damage the door, the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfill their protective function and must be replaced. Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

52 Occupant safety Sa fe ty

X Press release button? of buckle= and guide belt tongue; back towards belt sash guide:.

Belt warning for the driver and front passenger The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all occupants to fasten their seat belts. Regardless of whether the driver's and front- passenger seat belts have already been fastened, the 7 seat belt warning lamp lights up for six seconds each time the engine is started. It then goes out once the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts. If the driver and/or front passenger have not fastened their seat belts after the engine has been started, an additional warning tone sounds. This warning tone switches off after approximately six seconds or once the driver's seat belt is fastened.

If after six seconds, the driver or front passenger have not fastened their seat belts and the doors are closed: Rthe 7 seat belt warning lamp remains illuminated as long as either the driver's or front-passenger seat belt is not fastened Rand if vehicle speed once exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h), the 7 seat belt warning lamp lights up. A warning tone also sounds with increasing intensity for a maximum of 60 seconds or until the driver or front-passenger seat belt has been fastened.

If the driver or front-passenger seat belt is unfastened while the vehicle is in motion, the 7 seat belt warning lamps light up and a warning tone sounds again. The warning tone ceases even if the driver or front-passenger seat belt has still not been fastened after 60 seconds. The7 seat belt warning lamp stops flashing but remains illuminated. After the vehicle comes to a standstill, the warning tone is reactivated and the7 seat belt warning lamp flashes again if the vehicle speed again exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h). The 7 seat belt warning lamp only goes out if: Rboth the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts.

or Rthe vehicle is stationary and a door is open.

i Further information about the 7 seat belt warning lamp (Y page 243).

Emergency Tensioning Devices, seat belt force limiters

G WARNING Pyrotechnic ETDs that were activatedmust be replaced. For your safety, when disposing of the pyrotechnic ETDs always follow our safety instructions. These are available at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Occupant safety 53

Sa fe ty

Z

! If the co-driver's seat is unoccupied, do not insert the belt tongue into the buckle of the co-driver's seat. This may otherwise lead to the triggering of the Emergency Tensioning Device in the event of an accident, which will then need to be replaced.

X In order to ensure that the pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices have not been triggered, always have the seat belts checked after an accident. If the Emergency Tensioning Devices have been triggered, they must be replaced.

The seat belts for the front seats and rear outer seats are equipped with Emergency Tensioning Devices and seat belt force limiters. The ETDs on the driver's and front-passenger seat consist of pyrotechnic belt buckle tensioners and belt anchor installation tensioners that are triggered together. The belt buckle tensioner is mounted on the B- pillar and the belt anchor installation is mounted on the side of the seat. After deploying, both tensioners must always be replaced. The ETDs tighten the seat belts in an accident, pulling them close against the body. The ETDs do not correct incorrect seat positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts. The ETDs do not pull vehicle occupants back towards the backrest. Seat belt force limiters, when activated, are employed to help reduce the peak force exerted by the seat belts on occupants during a crash. The front seat belt force limiters are synchronized with the front air bags, which take on a part of the deceleration force. Thus, the force exerted on the occupant is distributed over a greater area.

The ETDs can only be activated when: Rthe SmartKey is in position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock. Rthe restraint systems are operational; see "SRS warning lamp" (Y page 39). Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on each of the lap-shoulder belts in the front Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied and the belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on the front-passenger side

The Emergency Tensioning Devices are triggered depending on the type and severity of an accident, if: Rin the event of a head-on or rear-end collision, the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact Rin the event of a side impact, on the side opposite the impact the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction Rin certain situations where the vehicle rolls over, the system determines that it can provide additional protection

If the ETDs are deployed, you will hear a bang, and a small amount of powder may also be released. Only in rare cases will the bang affect your hearing. The powder that is released generally does not constitute a health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp lights up.

Children in the vehicle

Child restraint systems

Important safety notes

G WARNING According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in the front seating position. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be placed in the rear seats whenever

54 Children in the vehicle Sa fe ty

possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint must be properly secured with the vehicle's seat belt, the seat belt and top tether strap, or lower anchors and top tether strap, fully in accordance with the child seat manufacturer's instructions. Occupants, especially children, should always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Children can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating air bag. Note the following important information when circumstances require you to place a child in the front passenger seat: RChildren 12 years old and undermust never ride in the front seat, except in a Mercedes- Benz authorized BabySmart compatible child seat, which operates with the BabySmart system installed in the vehicle to deactivate the front passenger front air bag when it is installed properly. Otherwise they will be struck by the air bag when it inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal injury will result. RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. The only means to completely eliminate this risk is to never place a child in a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat. We therefore strongly recommend that you always place a child in a rear-facing child restraint in a backseat. RIf you must install a rear-facing child restraint on the front passenger seat

because circumstances require you to do so, make sure the 4 / indicator lamp is illuminated, indicating that the front passenger front air bag is deactivated. Should the 4 / indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. Periodically check the 4 / indicator lamp while driving to make sure the 4 / indicator lamp is illuminated. If the 4 / indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do not transport a child on the front passenger seat until the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front passenger front air bag inflates. RIf you have to place a child in a forward- facing child restraint on the front passenger seat, move the seat as far back as possible, use the proper child restraint recommended for the age, size and weight of the child, and secure child restraint with the vehicle's seat belt according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions.

G WARNING Infants and small children should never share a seat belt with another occupant. In the event of an accident, they could be crushed between the occupant and seat belt. A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/ or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. Children that are too large for a child restraint must travel in seats using normal seat belts. Position the shoulder belt across the chest and shoulder, not the face or neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve proper seat belt positioning for children over 41 lbs (18 kg) until they reach a height where a lap/ shoulder belt fits properly without a booster seat.

Children in the vehicle 55

Sa fe ty

Z

When the child restraint is not in use, remove it from the vehicle or secure it with the seat belt to prevent the child restraint from becoming a projectile in the event of an accident.

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could: Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle Rbe seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accidentwith vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function

If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned on these parts.

G WARNING Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers Rsudden changes of direction Ran accident

We recommend that all infants and children be properly restrained using the infant or child restraint systems at all times while the vehicle is in motion. Always use a child restraint system that is compatible with BabySmart on the front- passenger seat. The use of infant or child restraints is required by law in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, all U.S. territories and all Canadian provinces. Infants and small children must be seated in an appropriate infant or child restraint system recommended for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint system must be properly secured in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. All infant or child restraint systems must comply with the U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 225 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 210.2. Confirmation that the child restraint system corresponds to the standards can be found on an instruction label on the child restraint system. This confirmation can also be found in the installation instructions that are included with the child restraint system. Always read and follow the manufacturer's instructions when using an infant or child restraint system or booster seat. Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior or on the infant or child restraint. If an infant or child is traveling in the vehicle: X Secure the child with a child or infant seat restraint system appropriate to the age and weight of the child.

X Make sure that the infant or child is properly secured at all times while the vehicle is in motion.

Special seat belt retractor

G WARNING Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 54).

56 Children in the vehicle Sa fe ty

G WARNING Never release the seat belt buckle while the vehicle is inmotion, since the special seat belt retractor will be deactivated.

All seat belts except the driver's seat belt are equipped with a special seat belt retractor. When activated, the special seat belt retractor ensures that the seat belt will not slacken once the child restraint system has been secured. Installing a child restraint system: X Always comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions.

X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the seat belt retractor.

X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt buckle.

Activating the special seat belt retractor: X Pull the seat belt out fully and let the seat belt retractor retract it again. While the seat belt is retracting, you should hear a ratcheting sound. The special seat belt retractor is activated.

X Push down on the child restraint system to take up any slack.

Removing a child restraint system/ deactivating the special seat belt retractor: X Always comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions.

X Press the release button on the seat belt buckle.

X Guide the seat belt tongue into the belt outlet. The special seat belt retractor is deactivated.

LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors in the rear

G WARNING Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 54).

G WARNING Children that are too large for a child restraint must travel in seats using normal seat belts. Position shoulder belt across the chest and shoulder, not face or neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve proper seat belt positioning for children over 41 lb (18 kg) until they reach a height where a lap/shoulder belt fits properly without a booster. Install the child restraint system in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Attach the child restraint system to both securing rings. An incorrectly installed child restraint system could come loose during an accident and seriously or even fatally injure the child. Child restraint systems or child seat securing rings that are malfunctioning or damaged as the result of a collision must be replaced.

! When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the seat belt for the middle seat does not get trapped. The seat belt could otherwise be damaged.

LATCH-type (ISOFIX) is a standardized securing system for specially designed child restraint systems on the rear seats. Securing rings for two LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint systems are installed on the left and right of the rear seats. Before every trip, make sure that the LATCH- type (ISOFIX) child restraint system is engaged correctly in both securing rings Secure non-LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint systems using the vehicle's seat belt system. Install the child seat according to the manufacturer's instructions.

Children in the vehicle 57

Sa fe ty

Z

: Securing ring X Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system. Comply with the manufacturer's instructions when installing the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system.

X When an LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system is installed, make sure that the center seat belt in the rear compartment is fully functional and can move freely.

Top Tether

G WARNING Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 54).

G WARNING Always engage the rear seat backrests in an upright position before installing the Top Tether belt. Push and pull the rear seat backrests to check whether they are engaged correctly. If the seat backrest is not locked properly, the seat backrest could fold. The child seat would no longer be supported properly or positioned to provide its intended benefit. That could cause serious or even fatal injuries.

G WARNING Only use the described top tether anchorage rings for the respective child seat. Other lashing eyelets could tear in case of an accident. Make sure the top tether straps are

not crossed or twisted and the hook is attached and closed properly.

Top Tether provides an additional connection between a child restraint system, secured with a LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat mount, and the rear seat. This helps reduce the risk of injury even further.

X Remove cargo compartment cover (Y page 261).

X Move the head restraint upwards. X Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system with Top Tether. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.

X Route Top Tether belt= under the head restraint between the two head restraint bars.

X Attach Top Tether hook: to Top Tether anchorage; on the cargo compartment floor.

X Hook Top Tether hook: of Top Tether belt = into Top Tether anchorage;.

58 Children in the vehicle Sa fe ty

Make sure that: RTop Tether hook: is hooked into Top Tether anchorage; as shown. RTop Tether belt= is not twisted.

X Make sure that Top Tether belt= is not twisted.

X Tension Top Tether belt=. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.

X Move head restraint back down again slightly if necessary (Y page 86). Make sure that you do not interfere with the correct routing of Top Tether belt=.

Child-proof locks

Important safety notes

G WARNING When children ride on the vehicle's rear seats, activate the override switch. Otherwise, the children could be injured, e.g. by trapping themselves in the rear side window.

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could: Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle Rbe seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accidentwith vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function

If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned on these parts.

Child-proof locks for the rear doors

G WARNING Children could open a rear door from inside the vehicle. This could result in serious injuries or an accident. Therefore, when children ride in the rear always secure the rear doors with the child-proof locks.

You secure each door individually with the child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door secured with a child-proof lock cannot be opened from inside the vehicle. When the vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened from the outside.

X To activate: press the child-proof lock lever down in the direction of arrow;.

X Make sure that the child-proof locks are working properly.

X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock lever up in the direction of arrow:.

Children in the vehicle 59

Sa fe ty

Z

Override feature for the rear side windows

G WARNING When children ride on the vehicle's rear seats, activate the override switch. Otherwise, the children could be injured, e.g. by trapping themselves in the rear side window.

X To activate/deactivate: press button:. If indicator lamp; is lit, operation of the rear side windows is disabled. Operation is only possible using the switches in the driver's door. If indicator lamp; is off, operation is possible using the switches in the rear compartment.

Driving safety systems

Overview of driving safety systems In this section, you will find information about the following driving safety systems: RABS (Anti-lock Braking System) (Y page 61) RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 61) RAdaptive brake lights (Y page 62) RESP (Electronic Stability Program) (Y page 62) REBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution) (Y page 64) RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 64) RTrailer stabilization

Important safety notes

G WARNING The ABS, the BAS, and the ESP switch off when the differential locks are switched on. When the ABS, the BAS, and the ESP are switched off Rwheels may lock during hard braking Rsteering capabilities are reduced Rbraking distance is increased Rvehicle stability in standard driving maneuvers is increased

Make sure the differential locks are switched on at all times except when driving off-road for example. Switch on the differential locks immediately when returning from off-road driving.

If you fail to adapt your driving style or become distracted, the driving safety systems can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. Driving safety systems are merely aids designed to assist driving. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and for braking in good time. Always adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions and maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.

i Please note that the driving safety systems described only work as effectively as possible if there is adequate contact between the tires and the road surface. Pay particular attention to the information regarding tires, recommended minimum tire tread depths etc. in the "Wheels and tires" section (Y page 312). In wintry driving conditions, always use winter tires (M+S tires) and if necessary, snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section work as effectively as possible.

60 Driving safety systems Sa fe ty

ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)

Important safety notes i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 60).

G WARNING If the ABSmalfunctions, other driving systems such as the BAS or the ESP are also switched off. Observe indicator and warning lamps that may come on as well as messages in the multifunction display that may appear. If the ABS malfunctions, the wheels may lock during hard braking, reducing the steering capability and extending the braking distance.

G WARNING If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents. Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.

ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way that the wheels do not lock when you brake. This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking. Provided that the differential locks are not active, ABS works from a speed of about 5 mph (8 km/h) upwards, regardless of road- surface conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces, even if you only brake gently. The yellow ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out when the engine is running.

Braking If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a pulsing in the brake pedal.

X If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the brake pedal vigorously until the braking situation is over.

X To make a full brake application: depress the brake pedal with full force.

The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions, and functions as a reminder to take extra care while driving.

Off-road ABS If the LOW RANGE shift range is selected by the transfer case, (Y page 194), an ABS system specifically suited to off-road terrain is automatically activated. At speeds below 37mph (60 km/h), the front wheels lock cyclically during braking. The digging-in effect achieved in the process reduces the stopping distance on off-road terrain. This limits steering capability.

BAS (Brake Assist System) i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 60).

G WARNING If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance in an emergency braking situation is increased. There is a risk of an accident. In an emergency braking situation, depress the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents the wheels from locking.

BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly, BAS automatically boosts the braking force, thus shortening the stopping distance. X Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until the emergency braking situation is over. ABS prevents the wheels from locking.

The brakes will function as usual once you release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.

Driving safety systems 61

Sa fe ty

Z

Adaptive brake lights If you brake sharply from a speed of more than 30 mph (50 km/h) or if braking is assisted by BAS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In this way, traffic traveling behind you is warned in an even more noticeable manner. If you brake sharply from a speed of more than 45 mph (70 km/h) to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the brakes are applied again, the brake lamps light up continuously. If you drive faster than 6mph (10 km/h), the hazard warning lamps are deactivated automatically. You can also switch off the hazard warning lamps using the hazard warning button (Y page 104).

ESP (Electronic Stability Program)

Important safety notes i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 60).

G WARNING If ESP is malfunctioning, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident. Drive on carefully. Have ESP checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

! Only operate the vehicle for a maximum of ten seconds on a brake test dynamometer. Switch off the ignition. Application of the brakes by ESP may otherwise destroy the brake system.

! A function or performance test should only be carried out on a two-axle dynamometer. Before you operate the vehicle on such a dynamometer, please consult a qualified workshop. You could otherwise damage the drive train or the brake system.

ESP monitors driving stability and traction. Traction is the power transmission between the tires and the road surface. ESP is deactivated if the warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running. If the warning lamp and the warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP is not available due to a malfunction. Observe the information on warning lamps (Y page 247) and any display messages that appear in the instrument cluster (Y page 221). If ESP detects that the vehicle is deviating from the direction desired by the driver, one or more wheels are braked to stabilize the vehicle. If necessary, the engine output is also modified to keep the vehicle on the desired course within physical limits. ESP assists the driver when pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP can also stabilize the vehicle during braking. If ESP intervenes, the warning lamp flashes in the instrument cluster. If ESP intervenes: X Do not deactivate ESP under any circumstances.

X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away.

X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.

i Only use wheels with the recommended tire sizes. Only then will ESP function properly.

i If differential locks are switched on, ABS, BAS and ESP switch themselves off automatically.

4ETS (Electronic Traction System) Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP.

62 Driving safety systems Sa fe ty

X If appropriate for the driving conditions, engage the LOW RANGE off-road gear (Y page 194).

Traction control is part of ESP. Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for example if the road surface is slippery on one side. In addition, more drive torque is transferred to the wheel or wheels with traction. Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP. At speeds above approximately 37 mph (60 km/h), traction control is no longer active. Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for example if the road surface is slippery on one side. In addition, more drive torque is transferred to the wheel or wheels with traction.

Deactivating/activating ESP

G WARNING If you deactivate ESP, ESP no longer stabilizes the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. Only deactivate ESP in the situations described in the following.

! Avoid spinning the driven wheels for an extended period with ESP deactivated. You could otherwise damage the drivetrain.

X To deactivate: press button: until the warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster.

X To activate: press button: until the warning lamp goes out in the instrument cluster.

ESP is activated automatically when the engine is started.

i Vehicles with the ECO start/stop function: the ECO start/stop function automatically switches the engine off when the vehicle comes to a stop. The engine starts automatically when the driver wants to pull away again. ESP remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP was deactivated before the engine was switched off, ESP remains deactivatedwhen the engine is switched on again.

It may be best to deactivate ESP in the following situations: Rwhen using snow chains Rin deep snow Ron sand or gravel If you deactivate ESP: RESP no longer improves driving stability. Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and the drive wheels can spin. The spinning of thewheels results in a cutting action, which provides better grip. Rtraction control is still activated.

Driving safety systems 63

Sa fe ty

Z

RESP still provides support when you brake. Rand are driving above 37 mph (60 km/h) (on AMG vehicles above 62 mph (100 km/h)), ESP still intervenes when one wheel reaches its grip limit even though it is switched off.

i If ESP is deactivated and one or more wheels start to spin, thewarning lamp in the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP will not stabilize the vehicle.

i If you have switched off ESP, it switches on again automatically at speeds above 37mph (60 km/h) (on AMG vehicles above 62 mph (100 km/h)) or if you have exceeded a certain lateral acceleration.

Trailer stabilization

G WARNING If road and weather conditions are poor, trailer stabilization will not be able to prevent the vehicle/trailer combination from swerving. Trailers with a high center of gravity can tip over before ESP can detect this. There is a risk of an accident. Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.

Trailer stabilization does not work if ESP is deactivated because of a malfunction. If your vehicle with trailer (vehicle/trailer combination) begins to lurch, you can only stabilize the vehicle/trailer combination by depressing the brake firmly. In this situation, ESP assists you and can detect if the vehicle/trailer combination begins to lurch. ESP slows the vehicle down by braking and limiting the engine output until the vehicle/trailer combination has stabilized. Trailer stabilization is active above speeds of about 37 mph (60 km/h).

EBD (electronic brake force distribution) i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 60).

G WARNING If EBD hasmalfunctioned, the rear wheels can still lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident. You should therefore adapt your driving style to the different handling characteristics. Have the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

Observe information regarding indicator and warning lamps (Y page 245) as well as display messages (Y page 223). EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving stability while braking.

ADAPTIVE BRAKE ADAPTIVE BRAKE provides increased braking safety. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE also has the HOLD function (Y page 188) and hill start assist (Y page 141).

Theft deterrent locking system

Immobilizer X To activate: remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock.

X To deactivate: switch on the ignition. The immobilizer prevents your vehicle from being started without the correct SmartKey. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. The engine can be started by anyone with a valid SmartKey that is left inside the vehicle.

i The immobilizer is always deactivated when you start the engine.

64 Theft deterrent locking system Sa fe ty

In the event that the engine cannot be started when the starter battery is fully charged, the immobilizer may be faulty. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA) or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).

ATA (anti-theft alarm system)

X To arm: lock the vehicle with the SmartKey. Indicator lamp: flashes. The alarm system is armed after approximately 15 seconds.

X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the SmartKey. i If you then do not open a door or the rear door, the alarm system switches back on again after approximately 40 seconds.

X To stop the alarm: insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock. The alarm is switched off.

or X Press the% or& button on the SmartKey. The alarm is switched off.

A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the alarm system is armed and you open: Ra door Ra door using the mechanical key Rthe rear door Rthe hood

The alarm is also triggered if: Rthe position of the vehicle is changed. Ra window is smashed. The alarm is not switched off, even if you close the open door that has triggered it, for example.

i If the alarm stays on for more than 30 seconds, the Tele Aid system automatically initiates a call to the Customer Assistance center. The mbrace emergency call system initiates the call if: Ryou have subscribed to the Tele Aid service. Rthe Tele Aid service has been activated properly. Rthe requiredmobile phone, power supply and GPS are available.

Theft deterrent locking system 65

Sa fe ty

Z

66

Useful information .............................. 68 SmartKey ............................................. 68 Doors .................................................... 73 Rear door ............................................. 76 Side windows ...................................... 77 Sliding sunroof .................................... 79

67

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

SmartKey

Important safety notes

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, and do not give them access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. They could: Rinjure themselves on vehicle parts Rbe seriously or fatally injured by extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or have an accident with vehicle equipment that may still be in operation even after the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition, such as the seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment or memory function.

If children open a door, they could cause severe or even fatal injury to other persons; if they get out of the vehicle, they could injure themselves when doing so or be seriously or even fatally injured by any passing traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very

hot, and a child could be burned on these parts.

G WARNING Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or cargo compartment unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers Rsudden changes of direction Ran accident

G WARNING If you attach heavy or large objects to the SmartKey, the SmartKey could be unintentionally turned in the ignition lock. This could cause the engine to be switched off. There is a risk of an accident. Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the SmartKey. Remove any bulky key rings before inserting the SmartKey into the ignition lock.

SmartKey functions

G WARNING If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle, they could: Ropen the doors, thus endangering other people or road users. Rget out and disrupt traffic. Roperate the vehicle's equipment. Additionally, children could set the vehicle in motion if, for example, they: Rrelease the parking brake. Rshift the automatic transmission out of parking position P. Rshift the manual transmission into neutral. Rstarting the engine. There is a risk of an accident and injury.

68 SmartKey Op

en in g an d cl os in g

When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of reach of children.

: & To lock the vehicle ; % To unlock the vehicle X To unlock centrally: press the% button. If you do not open the vehicle within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking: Rthe vehicle is locked again. Rthe theft deterrent locking system is armed again.

X To lock centrally: press the& button.

The SmartKey centrally locks/unlocks: Rthe doors Rthe rear door Rthe fuel filler flap

i When unlocking, the turn signals flash once. When locking, they flash three times.

You can also set an audible signal to confirm that the vehicle has been locked. The audible signal can be activated and deactivated using the on-board computer (Y page 216). When it is dark, the surround lighting also comes on if it is activated in the on-board computer (Y page 215).

Changing the settings of the locking system

You can change the setting of the locking system in such a way that only the driver's door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel on your own. i If the setting of the locking system is changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the& or% button locks or unlocks the vehicle.

X To change the setting: press and hold down the% and& buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until battery check lamp: flashes twice.

The SmartKey now functions as follows: X To unlock the driver's door and fuel filler flap: press the% button once.

X To unlock centrally: press the% button twice.

X To lock centrally: press the& button.

SmartKey 69

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

Restoring the factory settings

X Press the% and& buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until battery check lamp: flashes twice.

Mechanical key

General notes If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with the SmartKey, use the mechanical key. If you use the mechanical key to unlock and open the driver's door or the rear door, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 65). X To end the alarm: insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.

Removing the mechanical key

: Release catch ; Mechanical key

X Push release catch: in the direction of the arrow and at the same time remove mechanical key; from the SmartKey.

SmartKey battery

Important safety notes

G WARNING Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal injury. Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If a battery is swallowed, seekmedical attention immediately.

The SmartKey batteries contain perchlorate material, which may require special handling and regard for the environment. National guidelines must be observed during disposal. In California, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/ HazardousWaste/Perchlorate/ index.cfm. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.

Checking the battery

X Press the& or% button. The battery is working properly if battery check lamp: lights up briefly.

70 SmartKey Op

en in g an d cl os in g

If battery check lamp: does not light up during the test, the battery is discharged.

X Change the battery (Y page 71).

i You can get a battery in any qualified specialist workshop.

i Have the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.

i If the SmartKey battery is checked within the signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing the& or% button: Rlocks or Runlocks the vehicle

Replacing the battery You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery. X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 70).

: Battery compartment cover ; Mechanical key X Press mechanical key; into the opening in the SmartKey in the direction of the arrow until battery tray cover: opens. Do not hold the cover closed while doing so.

X Remove battery tray cover:.

= Battery X Repeatedly tap the SmartKey against your palm until battery= falls out.

X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to do so.

X Make sure that the surface of the battery is free from lint, grease and all other forms of contamination.

X Insert the front tabs of battery tray cover: and then press to close it.

X Insert the mechanical key into the SmartKey.

X Check the function of all SmartKey buttons on the vehicle.

SmartKey 71

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

Problems with the SmartKey

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

You cannot lock or unlock the vehicle using the SmartKey.

The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged. X Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door handle from a distance of approximately 1.5 ft (50 cm) and try to unlock or lock the vehicle again.

If this does not work: X Check the SmartKey battery (Y page 70) and replace it if necessary (Y page 71).

X Unlock (Y page 75) or lock (Y page 75) the vehicle using the mechanical key.

The SmartKey is faulty. X Lock or unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key (Y page 75).

X Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

You have lost a SmartKey.

X Have the SmartKey deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.

X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers. X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.

You have lost the mechanical key.

X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers. X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.

The engine cannot be started using the SmartKey.

The SmartKey has been in position 0 (Y page 139) for a considerable time. X Remove the SmartKey and reinsert it into the ignition lock. X Start the engine.

The on-board voltage is too low. X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior lighting, and try to turn the SmartKey again.

If this does not work: X Check the battery and charge it if necessary (Y page 301). or X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 303). or X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

72 SmartKey Op

en in g an d cl os in g

Doors

Important safety notes

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, and do not give them access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. They could: Rinjure themselves on vehicle parts Rbe seriously or fatally injured by extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or have an accident with vehicle equipment that may still be in operation even after the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition, such as the seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment or memory function.

If children open a door, they could cause severe or even fatal injury to other persons; if they get out of the vehicle, they could injure themselves when doing so or be seriously or even fatally injured by any passing traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and a child could be burned on these parts.

G WARNING Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or cargo compartment unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers Rsudden changes of direction Ran accident

G WARNING If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle, they could: Ropen the doors, thus endangering other people or road users. Rget out and disrupt traffic. Roperate the vehicle's equipment. Additionally, children could set the vehicle in motion if, for example, they: Rrelease the parking brake. Rshift the automatic transmission out of park position P or shift manual transmission into neutral. Rstart the engine. There is a risk of an accident and injury. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of reach of children.

Unlocking and opening doors from the inside If the vehicle has previously been locked with the SmartKey, opening a door from the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 65). Only open the door when the traffic situation permits.

Doors 73

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

X Front doors: pull door handle;. If the door is locked, locking knob: pops up. The door is unlocked and can be opened.

X Rear compartment doors: pull handle: up. The door is unlocked.

X Pull door handle;.

Centrally locking and unlocking the vehicle from the inside

G WARNING If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle, they could: Ropen the doors, thus endangering other people or road users. Rget out and disrupt traffic. Roperate the vehicle's equipment. Additionally, children could set the vehicle in motion if, for example, they: Rrelease the parking brake. Rshift the automatic transmission out of parking position P. Rshift the manual transmission into neutral. Rstarting the engine. There is a risk of an accident and injury. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of reach of children.

You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle from the inside. The central locking button does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.

X To unlock: press button:. X To lock: press button;. The vehicle locks when all the doors and the tailgate are closed.

You can open a front door from inside the vehicle even if it has been locked. Only open the door when the traffic situation permits. If the vehicle has been locked with the central locking button: Rand the SmartKey is restored to the factory settings, the entire vehicle is unlocked if a front door is opened from inside the vehicle. Rand the SmartKey is set to an individual setting, only the front door that is opened from inside the vehicle is unlocked.

If the vehicle has been locked centrally with the SmartKey, it does not unlock if you use the central locking button.

i You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from the inside if the vehicle has been locked from the outside using the SmartKey.

i It is only possible to lock the vehicle centrally if all doors are closed.

74 Doors Op

en in g an d cl os in g

Automatic locking feature

: To deactivate ; To activate X To disarm: press and hold button: for about five seconds until a tone sounds.

X To arm: press and hold button; for about five seconds until a tone sounds.

i If you press one of the two buttons and do not hear a tone, the relevant setting has already been selected.

The vehicle is locked automatically when the ignition is switched on and the vehicle's wheels are moving at a speed in excess of 9 mph (15 km/h). You could therefore be locked out if: Rthe vehicle is being pushed. Rthe vehicle is being towed. Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.

You can also switch the automatic locking function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 216).

Unlocking the driver's door (mechanical key) If the vehicle can no longer be centrally unlocked with the SmartKey, use the mechanical key. If you use the mechanical key to unlock and open the driver's door, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 65).

Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 70).

X Insert the mechanical key into the lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.

X Turn themechanical key counter-clockwise to position1. The door is unlocked.

X Turn the mechanical key back and remove it.

X Insert the mechanical key into the SmartKey.

Locking the vehicle If the vehicle can no longer be centrally locked with the SmartKey, use the mechanical key. X Close the front-passenger door, the rear doors and the tailgate.

X Press the locking button (Y page 74). X Make sure that the locking knobs on the doors are still visible. Press down the locking knobs by hand, if necessary.

X Close the driver's door from the outside.

Doors 75

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 70).

X Insert the mechanical key into the lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.

X Turn the mechanical key clockwise as far as it will go to position1.

X Turn the mechanical key back and remove it.

X Make sure that the doors and the tailgate are locked.

X Insert the mechanical key into the SmartKey.

i If you lock the vehicle as described above, the fuel filler flap is not locked. The anti- theft alarm system is not armed.

Rear door

Important safety notes

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, and do not give them access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. They could: Rinjure themselves on vehicle parts Rbe seriously or fatally injured by extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or have an accident with vehicle equipment that may still be in operation even after the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition, such as the seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment or memory function.

If children open a door, they could cause severe or even fatal injury to other persons; if they get out of the vehicle, they could injure themselves when doing so or be seriously or even fatally injured by any passing traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and a child could be burned on these parts.

G WARNING Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or cargo compartment unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers Rsudden changes of direction Ran accident

76 Rear door Op

en in g an d cl os in g

G WARNING Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust gases such as carbon monoxide. If the rear door is open when the engine is running, particularly if the vehicle is moving, exhaust fumes could enter the passenger compartment. There is a risk of poisoning. Turn off the engine before opening the rear door. Never drive with the rear door open.

! The tailgate swings out to the side when opened. Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient clearance.

i Do not leave the SmartKey in the cargo compartment. Otherwise, you could lock yourself out.

Opening You can only open the rear door after unlocking it first. X Press the% button on the SmartKey.

X Press release button: and pull door handle;.

X Open the rear door.

Closing X Push the rear door closed from outside the vehicle.

X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the & button on the SmartKey.

Side windows

Important safety notes

G WARNING While opening the side windows, body parts in the closing area could become trapped. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that no body parts are in close proximity during the closing procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or press the switch to open the side window again.

G WARNING While opening the side windows, body parts could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window moves. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or pull the switch to close the side window again.

Opening and closing the side windows The switches for all side windows are located on the driver's door. There is also a switch on each door for the corresponding sidewindow. The switches on the driver's door take precedence. The side windows cannot be operated from the rear when the override feature for the side windows is activated (Y page 60).

Side windows 77

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

: Front left ; Front right = Rear right ? Rear left X Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the ignition.

X To open: press the corresponding switch. X To close: pull the corresponding switch. X To open automatically: press the corresponding switch briefly beyond the point of resistance. The side window opens completely.

X To interrupt automatic operation: press or pull the corresponding switch again.

i You can continue to operate the side windows after you switch off the engine or remove the SmartKey. This function is available for up to five minutes or until the driver's or front-passenger door is opened.

i The side windows cannot be operated from the rear when the override feature for the side windows is activated (Y page 60).

Convenience opening i The convenience opening feature can only be operated using the SmartKey. The SmartKey must be close to the driver's door handle.

You can ventilate the vehicle before you start driving. To do this, the SmartKey is used to carry out the following functions simultaneously: Runlock the vehicle Ropen the side windows Ropen the sliding sunroof Rswitch on the seat ventilation for the driver's seat and front-passenger seat

X Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door handle.

X Press and hold the% button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof are in the desired position.

X To interrupt convenience opening: release the% button.

Problems with the side windows

G WARNING Closing the sidewindowswith increased force or without the anti-entrapment feature could lead to serious or even fatal injury. Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the side windows.

Problem: a side window cannot be closed because objects are trapped between the side window and the door frame. X Remove the objects. X Close the side window. Problem: a side window cannot be closed and you cannot see the cause. If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again slightly: X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding switch again until the side window has closed.

78 Side windows Op

en in g an d cl os in g

If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens again slightly: X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding switch again until the side window has closed. i If a side window no longer opens or closes due to a malfunction, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

Sliding sunroof

Important safety notes ! Only open the sliding sunroof if it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur. Do not allow anything to protrude from the sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could be damaged.

! If the sliding sunroof still cannot be opened or closed as a result of a malfunction, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

! The weather can change abruptly. It could start to rain or snow. Make sure that the sliding sunroof is closedwhen you leave the vehicle. The vehicle electronics can be damaged if water enters the vehicle interior.

i Resonance noises can occur in addition to the usual airflow noises when the sliding sunroof is open. They are caused by minor pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior. Change the position of the sliding sunroof or open a side window slightly to reduce or eliminate these noises.

Opening and closing the sliding sunroof

Overhead control panel : To raise ; To open = To close/lower X Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2(Y page 139) in the ignition.

X Press or pull the switch in the corresponding direction.

X To open automatically: press the switch briefly beyond the point of resistance in the direction of arrow;. The sliding sunroof opens completely.

X To interrupt automatic operation: press or pull the switch again. i When opening and raising the roof, automatic operation is only available if the sliding sunroof is in the closed position.

Operating the sliding sunroof manually The actuator is located in the cargo compartment, on the left-hand side behind the rear wall trim.

Sliding sunroof 79

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

X Open the rear door. X Pull off edge protection: from the door pillar in the direction of arrow;.

X Pull away rear panel trim= as far as necessary in the direction of arrow? until the electrical connections can be accessed.

X Disconnect the electrical connections. X Remove rear panel trim= completely.

X Take lug wrenchA out of the vehicle tool kit (Y page 296).

X Place lugwrenchA onto the hexagonal nut of the actuator.

X To open: turn lug wrenchA counter- clockwise.

X To close: turn lug wrenchA clockwise.

X Reconnect the electrical connections. X Re-install rear panel trim=. When doing so, hook lugsB of rear panel trim= into vehicle side wallC.

X Re-install edge protection:. X Close the rear door.

Problems with the sliding sunroof

G WARNING You could be severely or even fatally injured when closing the sliding sunroof with increased closing force or if the anti- entrapment feature is deactivated. Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the sliding sunroof.

! If the sliding sunroof still cannot be opened or closed as a result of a malfunction, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

Problem: the sunroof cannot be closed and you cannot see the cause.

80 Sliding sunroof Op

en in g an d cl os in g

If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and reopens again slightly: X Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.

If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and reopens again slightly: X Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.

Sliding sunroof 81

Op en in g an d cl os in g

Z

82

Useful information .............................. 84 Correct driver's seat position ............ 84 Seats .................................................... 85 Steering wheel .................................... 90 Mirrors ................................................. 93 Memory functions ............................... 95

83

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Correct driver's seat position

: Steering wheel ; Seat belts = Backrest X Observe the safety guidelines on seat adjustment (Y page 85).

X Make sure that seat= is adjusted properly. Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 86)

When adjusting the seat, make sure that: Ryou are as far away from the driver's air bag as possible. Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.

Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly. Ryou have moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. Ryou have set the seat cushion angle so that your thighs are gently supported. Ryou can depress the pedals properly. X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly (Y page 86). When doing so, make sure that you have adjusted the head restraint so that the back of your head is supported at eye level by the center of the head restraint.

X Observe the safety guidelines on steering wheel adjustment (Y page 85).

X Make sure that steering wheel: is adjusted properly. Adjusting the steering wheel electrically (Y page 91).

When adjusting the steering wheel, make sure that: Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your arms slightly bent. Ryou can move your legs freely. Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.

X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts (Y page 48).

X Check whether you have fastened seat belt; properly (Y page 50).

The seat belt should: Rfit snugly across your body Rbe routed across the middle of your shoulder Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the hip joints

X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors in such a way that you have a good view of road and traffic conditions (Y page 93).

X Vehicles with a memory function: save the seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror settings with the memory function (Y page 95).

84 Correct driver's seat position Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Seats

Important safety notes

G WARNING Children could become trapped if they adjust the seats, particularly when unattended. There is a risk of injury. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.

The seats can still be adjusted when there is no SmartKey in the ignition lock.

G WARNING In order to avoid possible loss of vehicle control, all seat, head restraint, steering wheel and rear view mirror adjustments, as well as fastening of seat belts, must be done before setting the vehicle in motion.

G WARNING Do not adjust the driver's seat while driving. Adjusting the seat while driving could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Never travel in a moving vehicle with the seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. This could cause serious or fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belts provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and seat belts are properly positioned on the body.

G WARNING Your seat belt must be adjusted so that you can correctly fasten your seat belt. Observe the following points: Radjust the seat backrest until your arms are slightly angled when holding the steering wheel. Radjust the seat to a comfortable seating position that still allows you to reach the

accelerator/brake pedal safely. The position should be as far back as possible with the driver still able to operate the controls properly. Radjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. Rnever place hands under the seat or near any moving parts while a seat is being adjusted.

Failure to do so could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury.

G WARNING According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained on the rear seats than on the front-passenger seat. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be placed in the rear seat whenever possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriately sized child restraint system or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. For additional information, see the "Children in the vehicle" section. A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/ or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint.

G WARNING For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.

Seats 85

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Z

! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat heating, observe the following information: Rkeep liquids from spilling on the seats. If liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as soon as possible. Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not switch on the seat heating. The seat heating should also not be used to dry the seats. Rclean the seat covers as recommended; see the "Interior care" section. Rdo not transport heavy loads on the seats. Do not place sharp objects on the seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools. The seats should only be occupied by passengers, if possible. Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.

! Make sure that there are no objects in the footwell or behind the seats when resetting the seats. There is a risk that the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.

! When the rear bench seat is folded forwards, the front seats cannot be moved to their rearmost position. You could otherwise damage the seats and the rear bench seat.

! Make sure that the sun visor is folded up before adjusting the backrest and head restraint height. The head restraint and sun visor could otherwise collidewhen the head restraint is fully extended.

i If the front door is open, the seats can be adjusted for up to 30 minutes after the ignition has been switched off.

i The rear-compartment head restraints can be removed (Y page 88). For more information, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

i You can find further information about enlarging the cargo compartment (folding

the rear bench seat forwards) on (Y page 260).

Adjusting the seats electrically ! Make sure that the cup holder on the center console is folded down before you move the front-passenger seat forwards.

: Head restraint height ; Seat cushion angle = Seat height ? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment A Backrest angle

i You can store the seat settings using the memory function (Y page 95).

Adjusting the head restraints

Important safety notes

G WARNING For safety reasons, always drive with the rear head restraints in the upright position when the rear seats are occupied. Keep the area around head restraints clear of articles (e.g. clothing) to not obstruct the folding operation of the head restraints.

G WARNING For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the

86 Seats Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.

Adjusting the front seat head restraint height

: Head restraint height ; Seat cushion angle = Seat height ? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment A Backrest angle X Slide head restraint adjustment button: up or down in the direction of the arrow.

Adjusting the luxury head restraints

G WARNING When folding back the head restraint side bolsters, do not put your hands between the side bolster and the cushion holder. There is a danger of becoming trapped.

X To adjust the side bolsters of the head restraint: push or pull right and/or left- hand side bolster: into the desired position.

X To adjust the angle of the head restraint: push or pull the head restraint in the direction of arrow;.

Resetting the front seat head restraints It is necessary to reset the front seat head restraints after the voltage supply has been interrupted, e.g. if the battery has been completely discharged or disconnected. X Make sure that the cup holder on the center console is folded down (Y page 262).

X Move the seat as far forward as possible and the head restraint in as far as possible.

Rear seat head restraints

Important safety notes G WARNING For safety reasons, always drive with the rear head restraints in the upright position when the rear seats are occupied. Keep the area around head restraints clear of articles (e.g. clothing) to not obstruct the folding operation of the head restraints.

G WARNING For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint in such a way that it is as close to the head as possible and the

Seats 87

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Z

center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. With a rear seat occupied, make sure to move the respective head restraint up from the lowest non-use position and have the occupant adjust the head restraint properly. Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head restraints installed when the rear seats are occupied. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident.

G WARNING Make sure the rear seat head restraints engage when placing them upright manually. Otherwise their protective function cannot be ensured. The back of the head will not be supported in the event of a collision. That could cause serious or even fatal injuries. Rear seat occupants can be seriously injured or killed.

Adjusting the rear seat head restraint height

X Once the head restraint is fully lowered, press release catch:.

X To raise: pull the head restraint up to the desired position.

X To lower: press release catch: and push the head restraint down until it is in the desired position.

Installing/removing the rear seat head restraints X To remove: pull the head restraint up to the stop.

X Press release catch: and pull the head restraint out of the guides.

X To re-install: place the head restraint in the guides of the backrest. i The notches on the guide rod must be on the left-hand side when viewed in the direction of travel.

X Push the head restraint down until you hear it engage in position.

Adjusting the multicontour seat

: To adjust the thigh cushion ; To adjust the backrest contour in the

lumbar region = To adjust the backrest contour in the

upper back region ? To adjust the side bolsters of the seat

backrest You can adjust the contour of the front seats individually so as to provide optimum support for your back and sides. X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 1 or 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

88 Seats Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support You can adjust the contour of the front seat backrests individually to provide optimum support for your back.

: To raise the backrest contour ; To soften the backrest contour = To lower the backrest contour ? To harden the backrest contour

Switching the seat heating on/off

General notes

G WARNING Repeatedly setting the seat heating to level 3 may result in excessive seat temperatures. The health of passengers that have limited temperature sensitivity or a limited ability to react to excessively high temperatures may be affected or they may even suffer burn-like injuries. Therefore, do not use seat heating level 3 repeatedly.

The red indicator lamps in the button indicate the heating level you have selected. X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock.

i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat heating may switch off. One or more of the indicator lamps in the seat heating button are flashing.

Switching the front-seat heating on/off

X To switch on: press button: repeatedly until the desired heating level is set.

X To switch off: press button: repeatedly until all the indicator lamps go out. i The system automatically switches down from level 3to level2 after approximately 8 minutes. The system automatically switches down from level 2to level1 after approximately 10 minutes. The system automatically switches off approximately 35 minutes after it is set to level 1.

Switching the rear-seat heating on/off

X To switch on: press button: repeatedly until the desired heating level is set.

X To switch off: press button: repeatedly until all the indicator lamps go out. i The system automatically switches down from level 3to level2 after approximately 8 minutes.

Seats 89

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Z

The system automatically switches down from level 2to level1 after approximately 10 minutes. The system automatically switches off approximately 35 minutes after it is set to level 1.

Problems with the seat heating If the on-board voltage is too low, the seat heating is switched off automatically. X Switch off electrical consumers which you do not need, such as the rear window defroster or interior lighting. If the on-board voltage is only interrupted briefly, the seat heating will switch back on automatically. If the seat heating is not switched on automatically:

X Switch the seat heating on manually (Y page 89)

Switching the seat ventilation on/off

Activating/deactivating

Seat ventilation is only available for the front seats. The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons indicate the ventilation level you have selected. X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X To switch on: press button: repeatedly until the desired ventilation level is set.

i If you open the side windows and the sliding sunroof using the SmartKey (Y page 78), the driver's seat ventilation automatically switches to the highest level.

X To switch off: press button: repeatedly until all the indicator lamps go out.

i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat ventilation may switch off.

Problems with the seat ventilation If one or all of the indicator lamps in the seat ventilation button are flashing, the seat ventilation has switched off automatically. The vehicle's electrical system voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on. X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as the rear window defroster or interior lighting. Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat ventilation will switch back on automatically.

Steering wheel

Important safety notes

G WARNING Do not adjust the steeringwheel while driving. Adjusting the steering wheel while driving could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. The electrical steering wheel adjustment feature can be operated at any time. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury.

90 Steering wheel Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Adjusting the steering wheel

: To adjust the steering wheel height ; To adjust the steering wheel position

(fore-and-aft adjustment)

i If the driver's door is open, the steering wheel can be adjusted for up to 30 minutes after the ignition has been switched off.

i Further related subjects: REASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature (Y page 92) RStoring settings (Y page 95)

Steering wheel heating

Activating/deactivating

: To switch on the steering-wheel heating ; To switch off the steering-wheel heating = Indicator lamp

The steering-wheel heating heats the leather areas of the steering wheel.

X To activate:make sure that the SmartKey is in position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock.

X Turn the catch in the direction of arrow:. Indicator lamp= lights up.

X To deactivate: make sure that the SmartKey is in position1 or2 in the ignition lock.

X Turn the catch in the direction of arrow;. Indicator lamp= goes out.

i The steering wheel heating does not switch off automatically.

i The steering wheel heatingmay switch off temporarily if: Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior is above 86 (30 ) Rthe temperature of the steering wheel is above 95 (35 )

Indicator lamp= remains on.

i The steering wheel heating is deactivated if you remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock.

Problems with the steering wheel heating

: To switch on the steering-wheel heating ; To switch off the steering-wheel heating = Indicator lamp

Steering wheel 91

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Z

If steering wheel heating indicator lamp= is flashing, the steering wheel heating has switched off automatically. The vehicle's electrical system voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on. X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as the rear window defroster or interior lighting. Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the steering wheel heating will switch back on automatically.

Steering wheel EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature

Important safety notes

G WARNING Make sure that nobody can become trapped when you activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature. If there is a risk of someone becoming trapped, stop the adjustment procedure. To halt the procedure: Rpress the steering column adjustment button. Rpress one of the memory function position buttons.

The steering column stops moving immediately. Do not keep the memory function position button pressed as this will start the memory function and set the steering wheel and seat in motion. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle. They could open the driver's door and thereby unintentionally activate the EASY- ENTRY/EXIT feature and become trapped.

G WARNING Let the system complete the adjustment procedure before setting the vehicle in motion. All steering wheel adjustment must be completed before setting the vehicle in

motion. Driving off with the steering wheel still adjusting could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle.

! Do not activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature, if the seat backrest is reclined too far backwards. This can damage the front or rear seats. You must first move the backrest to a vertical position.

The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting in and out of your vehicle easier. You can activate and deactivate the EASY- ENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 216).

Position of the steering wheel when the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is active The steering wheel moves upwards and towards the dashboard if: Ryou remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock or Ryou open the driver's door with the SmartKey in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock.

i The steering wheel only moves upwards and towards the dashboard if it has not already reached the upper end stop.

Position of the steering wheel for driving The steering wheel is moved to the last selected position when: Rthe driver's door is closed. Ryou insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.

The last position of the steering wheel is stored when you switch off the ignition or when you store the setting with the memory function (Y page 95).

92 Steering wheel Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Mirrors

Rear-view mirror X Adjust the rear-view mirror by hand so you have a good overview of the traffic conditions behind you.

Exterior mirrors

Adjusting the exterior mirrors

G WARNING The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the image. Objects are actually closer than they appear. You couldmisjudge the distance from vehicles driving behind and cause an accident, e.g. when changing lane. For this reason, make sure of the actual distance from the vehicle driving behind by glancing over your shoulder.

X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 1 or 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press button: to select the left-hand exterior mirror.

or X Press button; to select the right-hand exterior mirror.

X Press button= up, down, or to the left or right until you have adjusted the exterior mirror to the correct position. You should have a good overview of traffic conditions.

i The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger field of vision.

i The exterior mirrors are heated automatically if the rear window defroster is switched on and the outside temperature is low.

Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically

X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 1 or 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Briefly press button:. Both exterior mirrors fold in or out. i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are always folded out fully while driving. They could otherwise vibrate.

i If you are driving faster than 9 mph (15 km/h), you can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors.

Setting the exterior mirrors

If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise not fold in when you select the

Mirrors 93

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Z

"Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board computer (Y page 217). X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 1(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Briefly press button:.

Folding the exterior mirrors in/out automatically If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function is activated in the on-board computer (Y page 217): Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside. Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and then open the driver's or front- passenger door.

Exterior mirror pushed out of position X Press button: repeatedly until you hear the mirror engage in position. The mirror housing is engaged again and you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual (Y page 93).

Automatic anti-glare mirrors

G WARNING If incident light from headlamps is prevented from striking the sensor in the rear-view mirror, for instance, by luggage piled too high in the vehicle, the mirror's automatic anti- glare function will not operate. Incident light could then blind you. This may distract you from the traffic conditions and, as a result, you may cause an accident.

The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror on the driver's side automatically go into anti- glare mode if: Rthe ignition is switched on and Rincident light from headlamps strikes the sensor in the rear-view mirror.

i Themirrors do not go into anti-glaremode if reverse gear is engaged or if the interior lighting is switched on.

Parking position for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side

Setting/storing the parking position

Using reverse gear

: Left-hand exterior mirror ; Right-hand exterior mirror = Adjustment button ? Memory button

You can position the front-passenger side exterior mirror in such a way that you can see the rear wheel on that side as soon as you engage reverse gear. You can store this position. X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and that the SmartKey is in position 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press button; for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side.

X Engage reverse gear. The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side moves to the preset parking position.

X Use adjustment button= to adjust the exterior mirror to a position that allows you to see the rear wheel and the curb. The parking position is stored. i If you shift the transmission to another position, the exterior mirror on the front-

94 Mirrors Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

passenger side returns to the driving position.

Using the memory button

: Left-hand exterior mirror ; Right-hand exterior mirror = Adjustment button ? Memory button

You can position the front-passenger side exterior mirror in such a way that you can see the rear wheel on that side as soon as you engage reverse gear. This setting can be stored using memory button M?. X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X With the exterior mirror on the front- passenger side activated, use adjustment button= to adjust the exterior mirror. In the exterior mirror, the rear wheel and the curb should be visible.

X Press memory buttonM? and one of the arrows on adjustment button= within three seconds. The parking position is stored if the exterior mirror does not move.

X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat the steps.

Calling up a stored parking position setting

: Left-hand exterior mirror ; Right-hand exterior mirror = Adjustment button ? Memory button X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Adjust the exterior mirror on the front- passenger side using button;.

X Engage reverse gear. The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side moves to the stored parking position.

The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side moves back to its original position: Ras soon as you exceed a speed of 9 mph (15 km/h) Rif you press button: for the exterior mirror on the driver's side

Memory functions

Storing settings

G WARNING Only use the memory function on the driver's side when the vehicle is stationary. You could otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions by the seat moving of its own accord, and as a result cause an accident.

Memory functions 95

Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Z

X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2(Y page 139) or that the respective door is open.

X Adjust the seat (Y page 86) and head restraint (Y page 86).

X On the driver's side, adjust the steering wheel (Y page 91) and the exterior mirrors (Y page 93).

X Press the M memory button. X Press one of memory buttons 1, 2 or 3 within three seconds. The settings are stored in the selected storage position.

Calling up a stored setting ! If you want to move the seat from the fully reclined position to a stored seat position, first raise the backrest using the seat switch. The seat could otherwise be damaged.

X Press and hold the relevant memory button 1, 2 or 3, until the seat, head restraints, steeringwheel andmirrors are in the stored position. i The setting procedure is interrupted as soon as you release the memory button.

96 Memory functions Se at s, st ee rin

g w he el an d m irr or s

Useful information .............................. 98 Exterior lighting .................................. 98 Interior lighting ................................. 105 Replacing bulbs ................................. 108 Windshield wipers ............................ 114

97

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Exterior lighting

Important safety notes For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.

Driving abroad

Conversion to symmetrical low beam Switch the headlamps to symmetrical low beam in countries in which traffic drives on the opposite side of the road from the country where the vehicle is registered. This prevents glare to oncoming traffic. When using symmetrical lights, the edge of the road is not lit as widely and as far ahead as normal. Have the headlamps converted at a qualified specialist workshop as close to the border as possible before driving in these countries.

Conversion to asymmetrical low beam after returning Have the headlamps converted back to asymmetrical low-beam headlamps at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible after crossing the border again.

Light switch

Operation ! Switch off the parking lamps and low- beam headlamps when you leave the vehicle. This prevents the battery from discharging.

! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the parking lamps or standing lamps are automatically switched off to enable the next engine start. Always park your vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according to legal standards. Avoid the continuous use of the T parking lamps for several hours. If possible, switch on the X right or the W left standing lamp.

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps

If you hear a warning tone when you leave the vehicle, the lights may still be switched on. X Turn the light switch to. The turn signals, high-beam headlamps and the high-beam flasher are operated using the combination switch (Y page 103).

98 Exterior lighting Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

The exterior lighting (except the parking/ standing lamps) switches off automatically if you: Rremove the SmartKey from the ignition lock Ropen the driver's door with the SmartKey in position 0.

Low-beam headlamps

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps X To switch on the low-beam headlamps: turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine.

X Turn the light switch to L. The L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

Daytime running lamps

Daytime running lamps in Canada

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps

The daytime running lamps function is required by law in Canada. It cannot therefore be deactivated. X Turn the light switch to. With the engine running: depending on the ambient light, the daytime running lamps or the low-beam headlamps are switched on. When the low-beam headlamps are switched on, the L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

When the engine is running and the vehicle is stationary: if youmove the selector lever from a drive position to P, the daytime running lamps/low-beam headlamps go out after three minutes. When the engine is running, the vehicle is stationary and in high ambient light brightness: if you turn the light switch to T, you turn on the daytime running lamps and parking lamps. If the engine is running and you turn the light switch to L, the manual settings take precedence over the daytime running lamps.

Exterior lighting 99

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Daytime running lamps in the USA

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps

In the USA, the daytime running lamps are deactivated upon delivery from the factory. X To activate the daytime running lamps: activate the daytime running lamps function in the on-board computer (Y page 215).

X Turn the light switch to. With the engine running: depending on the ambient light, the daytime running lamps or the low-beam headlamps are switched on. When the low-beam headlamps are switched on, the L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

If the engine is running and you turn the light switch to T or L, the manual settings take precedence over the daytime running lamps.

Automatic headlamp mode

G WARNING If the light switch is set to and it is foggy, snowing or there is poor visibility, the low- beam headlamps will not come on automatically. This could endanger you and

others. In such situations turn the light switch to L. The automatic headlamp feature is only an aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's lighting at all times.

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps X To switch on automatic headlamp mode: turn the light switch to. SmartKey in position 1 in the ignition lock: the parking lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light. With the engine running: if you have activated the daytime running lamps function in the on-board computer, the daytime running lamps or the low-beam headlamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light. When the low-beam headlamps are switched on, the L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

100 Exterior lighting Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Fog lamps (except AMG vehicles)

G WARNING If you suspect that driving conditions will be foggy, turn the light switch toL before you start your journey. Your vehicle may otherwise not be visible and you could endanger yourself and others.

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps BN Fog lamps (except AMG vehicles) CR Rear fog lamp X To switch on the fog lamps: turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine.

X Turn the light switch to T, L or .

X Press the N button. The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

X To switch off the front fog lamps: press the N button. The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.

Only vehicles with front fog lamps have the fog lamps function.

Rear fog lamp

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps BN Fog lamps (except AMG vehicles) CR Rear fog lamp

Exterior lighting 101

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

X To switch on the rear fog lamp: turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine.

X Turn the light switch to L or. X Press the R button. The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

X To switch off the rear fog lamp: press the R button. The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.

Parking lamps

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps

BN Fog lamps (except AMG vehicles) CR Rear fog lamp X To switch on: turn light switch to T.

Standing lamps

1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, side marker lamps,

license plate and instrument cluster lighting

4 Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps

5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps BN Fog lamps (except AMG vehicles) CR Rear fog lamp

Switching on the standing lamps ensures the corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.

102 Exterior lighting Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

X To switch on the parking lamps: the SmartKey is not inserted in the ignition lock or it is in position 0(Y page 139).

X Turn the light switch toW (left-hand side of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of the vehicle).

Headlamp cleaning system The headlamps are cleaned automatically if the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated ten times while the lights are on and the engine is running (Y page 114). When you switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is resumed from 0.

Combination switch

Turn signal

: High-beam headlamps ; Turn signal, right = High-beam flasher ? Turn signal, left X To indicate briefly: press the combination switch briefly to the pressure point in the direction of arrow; or?. The corresponding turn signal flashes three times.

X To indicate: press the combination switch beyond the pressure point in the direction of arrow; or?.

High-beam headlamps

: High-beam headlamps ; Turn signal, right = High-beam flasher ? Turn signal, left X To switch on the high-beamheadlamps: turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine.

X Turn the light switch to L or. X Press the combination switch beyond the pressure point in the direction of arrow:. In the position, the high-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark and the engine is running. The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the high- beam headlamps are switched on.

X To switch off the high-beam headlamps:move the combination switch back to its normal position. The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.

Exterior lighting 103

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

High-beam flasher

: High-beam headlamps ; Turn signal, right = High-beam flasher ? Turn signal, left X To switch on: turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 1 or 2 or start the engine.

X Pull the combination switch briefly in the direction of arrow=.

Hazard warning lamps

X To switch on the hazardwarning lamps: press button:. All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a turn signal using the combination switch, only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.

X To switch off the hazard warning lamps: press button:.

The hazard warning lamps automatically switch on if: Ran air bag is deployed Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices are triggered, or Rthe vehicle is slowed down rapidly from a speed of over 45 mph (70 km/h) and comes to a halt

The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if an air bag or the Emergency Tensioning Devices are triggered and the SmartKey is in position 1 in the ignition lock. The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of over 6mph (10km/h) again after a full brake application.

i The hazard warning lamps still operate if the ignition is switched off.

Cornering light function

The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. The cornering light function can only be activated if the low-beam headlamps are switched on and the fog lamps are switched off. Active: if you are driving at speeds below 25 mph (40 km/h) and switch on the turn signal or turn the steering wheel Not active: if you are driving at speeds above 25 mph (40 km/h) or switch off the turn

104 Exterior lighting Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

signal or turn the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position The cornering light function may remain lit for a short time, but is automatically switched off after no more than three minutes.

Headlamps and indicator lamps fogged up on the inside The headlamps and the indicator lamps in the exterior mirrors may fog up on the inside if there is high atmospheric humidity. X Drive with the headlamps switched on. The level of moisture diminishes, depending on the length of the journey and the weather conditions (humidity and temperature).

If the level of moisture does not diminish: X Have the headlamps checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

Interior lighting

Overview of interior lighting

Front overhead control panel : p Switches the left-hand front reading

lamp on/off ; c Switches the front interior lighting

on = t Switches the cargo compartment

lamp/rear interior lighting on/off ? | Switches the front interior lighting/

automatic interior lighting control off

A p Switches the right-hand reading lamp on/off

B Switches the automatic interior lighting control on

Rear-compartment overhead control panel : p Switches the right-hand reading

lamp on/off ; p Switches the left-hand reading lamp

on/off

Interior lighting control

General notes The interior lighting functions are automatically deactivated after some time except for when the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock. This prevents your vehicle's battery from discharging. The brightness of the ambient lightingmay be set using the control on the instrument cluster (Y page 205).

Interior lighting 105

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

Automatic interior lighting control

Front overhead control panel : p Switches the left-hand front reading

lamp on/off ; c Switches the front interior lighting

on = t Switches the cargo compartment

lamp/rear interior lighting on/off ? | Switches the front interior lighting/

automatic interior lighting control off A p Switches the right-hand reading

lamp on/off B Switches the automatic interior lighting

control on X To switch on: set rocker switchB to the center position.

The interior lighting switches on automatically when it is dark if you: Runlock the vehicle Ropen a door Rremove the SmartKey from the ignition lock X To switch off: press the | symbol on rocker switchB.

The interior lighting remains switched off even when it is dark if you: Runlock the vehicle Ropen a door. Rremove the SmartKey from the ignition lock The interior light is activated for a short while when the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed switch-off using the on-board computer (Y page 216).

When a front door is opened, the front interior lighting comes on. When a rear door is opened, the rear interior lighting comes on. In addition, the courtesy lights come on.

i If a door remains open and the SmartKey is not in the ignition lock, the interior lighting switches off after a short while.

Manual interior lighting control

Front interior lighting ! If the interior lighting has been switched on manually, it will not be switched off automatically. This can cause the starter battery to discharge. Make sure that the interior lighting does not remain switched on too long after the engine has been switched off.

Front overhead control panel : p Switches the left-hand front reading

lamp on/off ; c Switches the front interior lighting

on = t Switches the cargo compartment

lamp/rear interior lighting on/off ? | Switches the front interior lighting/

automatic interior lighting control off A p Switches the right-hand reading

lamp on/off B Switches the automatic interior lighting

control on

106 Interior lighting Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

X To switch on: press the c symbol on rocker switchB.

X To switch off: set rocker switchB to the center position.

Reading lamps

Front overhead control panel : p Switches the left-hand front reading

lamp on/off ; c Switches the front interior lighting

on = t Switches the cargo compartment

lamp/rear interior lighting on/off ? | Switches the front interior lighting/

automatic interior lighting control off A p Switches the right-hand reading

lamp on/off B Switches the automatic interior lighting

control on X To activate/deactivate: press the p button.

Cargo compartment lamp G WARNING To prevent possible personal injury, always keep hands and fingers away from the cargo compartment opening when closing the tailgate. Be especially careful when small children are around.

G WARNING Make sure the tailgate is closed when the engine is running and while driving. Among other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO)

gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death.

! Switch off the cargo compartment lamp if you wish to leave the rear door open for a longer period. The battery may otherwise discharge.

! Do not close the rear door while lock: is engaged at the bottom. Otherwise, you could damage lock:.

Front overhead control panel : p Switches the left-hand front reading

lamp on/off ; c Switches the front interior lighting

on = t Switches the cargo compartment

lamp/rear interior lighting on/off ? | Switches the front interior lighting/

automatic interior lighting control off A p Switches the right-hand reading

lamp on/off B Switches the automatic interior lighting

control on X To switch on/off: press the t button. i If you open the rear door, the cargo compartment lamp comes on. You will then be unable to switch it off using the t button. Switch off the cargo compartment lamp if you wish to leave the rear door open for a longer period. This prevents the battery from discharging.

Interior lighting 107

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

X Open the rear door. X To switch off with the rear door open: press lock: down in the direction of the arrow until it engages. The cargo compartment lamp is switched off.

X To switch on with the rear door open: press lock cylinder; on the door handle. The cargo compartment lamp resumes its normal function.

Rear interior lighting

Front overhead control panel : p Switches the left-hand front reading

lamp on/off ; c Switches the front interior lighting

on = t Switches the cargo compartment

lamp/rear interior lighting on/off ? | Switches the front interior lighting/

automatic interior lighting control off

A p Switches the right-hand reading lamp on/off

B Switches the automatic interior lighting control on

X To switch on/off: press the t button. i The rear interior lighting switches on when you open a rear door. You will then be unable to switch it off using the t button. Switch off the rear interior lighting if you wish to leave the rear doors open for a longer period. This prevents the battery from discharging.

Replacing bulbs

Important safety notes

G DANGER Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You could get an electric shock and be seriously or even fatally injured if you touch the electric contacts on Xenon bulbs. Therefore, never remove the cover from Xenon bulbs. Do not change the Xenon bulbs yourself, but have them replaced at a qualified workshop.

Xenon bulbs If your vehicle is equipped with Xenon bulbs, you can recognize this by the following: the cone of light from the Xenon bulbs moves from the top to the bottom and back again when you start the engine. For this to be observed, the lights must be switched on before starting the engine. Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure that these function correctly at all times. Have the headlamp setting checked regularly. LED lamps You can replace neither Xenon bulbs nor LED bulbs. Have LED bulbs changed at a qualified specialist workshop. Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure

108 Replacing bulbs Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

that these function correctly at all times. Have the headlamp setting checked regularly. Before changing bulbs Have the following bulbs changed at a qualified specialist workshop: RAdditional turn signals in the exterior mirrors RHigh-mounted brake lamp RHigh-beam/low-beam headlamps (Xenon bulbs) RDaytime running lamps RParking lamps/standing lamps RLicense plate lamp

i Individual segments of the license plate lamp LEDs may fail without a display message appearing in the multifunction display. Regularly check the license plate lamp. If necessary, visit a qualified specialist workshop.

You can replace the following bulbs: RFog lamp/cornering light with fog lamp function RTurn signal lamp (front) RBrake/tail lamp RTurn signal lamp (rear) RTail lamps/standing lamps RBackup lamp RRear fog lamp RSide marker lamps

G WARNING Bulbs and lamps can become very hot. For this reason, allow them to cool down before changing them. Otherwise, you could burn yourself when you touch them. Keep bulbs out of the reach of children. Otherwise, they could, for example, damage the bulbs and injure themselves. Never use a bulb which has been dropped. Such a bulb may explode and injure you. Halogen bulbs are pressurized and could explode when you change them, especially if they are very hot. You should therefore wear

eye protection and gloves when you are changing them.

Other bulbs There are bulbs other than the Xenon bulbs that you cannot replace. Replace only the bulbs listed (Y page 109). Have the bulbs that you cannot replace yourself changed at a qualified specialist workshop. If you require assistance changing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop. Do not touch the glass tube of new bulbs with your bare hands. Even minor contamination can burn into the glass surface and reduce the service life of the bulbs. Always use a lint- free cloth or only touch the base of the bulb when installing. Only use bulbs of the correct type. If the new bulb still does not light up, consult a qualified specialist workshop. Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure that these function correctly at all times. Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.

Overview: changing bulbs/bulb types

Front bulbs You can replace the following bulbs. The bulb type can be found in the legend.

: Turn signal lamp: 1156 NA ; Side marker lamp: T 4 W = Cornering light function with fog lamp

function: H1155W (except AMGvehicles)

Replacing bulbs 109

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

Rear bulbs You can replace the following bulbs. The bulb type can be found in the legend.

: Tail lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W ; Brake lamp/tail lamp: P 21/5 W = Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W ? Side marker lamp: T 4 W A Backup lamp: P 21 W B Rear fog lamp: P 21 W

Changing the front bulbs

Front fog lamps/cornering lamps with fog lamp function

X Switch off the lights. X Unscrew screws:. X Remove cover;.

X Unscrew screws=. i Only remove screws=. Do not turn adjustment screw?. If adjustment screw? has been turned, the front fog lamp adjustment must be checked at a qualified workshop.

X Remove lampA.

X Hold lampA. X Lightly press bulb holderB, turn it counter-clockwise to the stop and pull it out.

110 Replacing bulbs Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

X Take bulbC out of bulb holderB. X Insert the new bulb into bulb holderB. X Insert bulb holderB into lampA and turn it clockwise to the stop.

X Insert lampA. X Replace and tighten screws=.

X Position cover;. X Replace and tighten screws:.

Turn signal ! Make sure that the protective grille does not hit any painted surfaces. You could otherwise damage the paintwork.

! Do not fasten the screws too tightly. You could otherwise damage the lens.

Turn signal lamp with protection grille (AMG vehicles) X Switch off the lights. X AMG vehicles: pull protection grille: in the direction of the arrow out of mounting;.

X Fold up protection grille:.

Example: turn signal lamp X Switch off the lights. X Unscrew screws=. X Remove lens?.

Example: turn signal lamp

Replacing bulbs 111

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

X Turn bulbA counter-clockwise, applying slight pressure, and remove it from the bulb holder.

X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and turn it clockwise until it engages.

X Install lens?. X Replace and tighten screws=.

X AMG vehicles: fold down protection grille: and allow it to engage in mounting;.

Side marker lamps ! Do not fasten the screws too tightly. You could otherwise damage the lens.

Front side marker lamp (example)

The bulbs of the front and rear side marker lamps are changed in the same way. X Switch off the lights. X Unscrew screws:. X Remove housing;.

X Remove dust cover=. X Push the catch to the side and pull the bulb holder with the bulb out of housing;.

X Lightly press bulb?, turn it counter- clockwise and pull it out.

X Insert the new bulb and, applying slight pressure, turn it clockwise until it engages.

X Insert the bulb holder into housing;. X Attach dust cover=. X Insert housing;. X Replace and tighten screws:.

Changing the rear bulbs

G 55 AMG only: protective grille ! Make sure that the protective grille does not hit any painted surfaces. You could otherwise damage the paintwork.

Protection grille (AMG vehicles)

You must remove the protective grille before you can change the bulbs in the tail lamps.

112 Replacing bulbs Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

X Unscrew screws;. X Swing protection grille: to the right. X After changing the bulbs, swing protection grille: to the left.

X Tighten screws;.

Tail lamp ! When installing the lens, make sure that the seal is positioned correctly.

! Do not fasten the screws too tightly. You could otherwise damage the lens.

X Switch off the lights. X Unscrew screws:. X Remove lens;.

= Turn signal ? Brake/tail lamp A Tail lamp/standing lamp

X Turn the corresponding bulb counter- clockwise, applying slight pressure, and remove it from the bulb holder.

X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and turn it clockwise until it engages.

X Install lens;. X Replace and tighten screws:. X AMG vehicles: secure the protection grille (Y page 112).

Backup lamp/rear fog lamp ! Do not fasten the screws too tightly. You could otherwise damage the lens.

Example: rear fog lamp X Switch off the lights. X Unscrew screws;. X Remove lens:.

X Turn bulb= anti-clockwise, applying slight pressure, and remove it from the bulb holder.

X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and turn it clockwise until it engages.

Replacing bulbs 113

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

X Install lens:. X Replace and tighten screws;.

Windshield wipers

Switching the windshield wipers on/ off

G WARNING The windshield will no longer be wiped properly if the wiper blades are worn. This could prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident. Replace the wiper blades twice a year, ideally in spring and fall.

! Do not operate the windshield wipers when the windshield is dry, as this could damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust that has collected on the windshield/rear window can scratch the glass if wiping takes place when the windshield/rear window is dry. If it is necessary to switch on thewindshield wipers in dry weather conditions, always use washer fluid when operating the windshield wipers.

! If the windshield wipers leave smears on the windshield/rear window after the vehicle has been washed in an automatic car wash, this may be due to wax or other residue. Clean the windshield/rear window with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.

! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due to optical influences and the windshield becoming dirty in dry weather conditions, the windshield wipers may be activated inadvertently. This could then damage the windshield wiper blades or scratch the windshield. For this reason, you should always switch off the windshield wipers in dry weather.

Combination switch 1 $ Windshield wipers off 2 Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor

set to low sensitivity) 3 Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor

set to high sensitivity) 4 Continuous wipe, slow 5 Continuous wipe, fast B Single wipe C To wipe with washer fluid X Switch on the ignition. X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.

Intermittent wiping is interrupted if you stop and open a front door. This protects people getting into and out of the vehicle from being sprayed with water. Intermittent wiping continues when all doors are closed and: Ryou shift the automatic transmission to drive position D or reverse gear R or Ryou change the wipe setting on the combination switch.

In the or position, the appropriate wiping frequency is set automatically according to the intensity of the rain. In the position, the rain sensor is more sensitive than in the position, causing the windshield wipers to wipe more frequently.

114 Windshield wipers Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Switching the rear window wiper on/ off

Combination switch : Switch 2 b To wipe with washer fluid 3 I To switch on intermittent wiping 4 0 To switch off intermittent wiping 5 b To wipe with washer fluid X Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock.

X Turn switch: on the combination switch to the corresponding position. When the rearwindowwiper is switched on, the icon appears in the instrument cluster. i The rear window wiper comes on automatically if you shift the selector lever to R while the windshield wipers are on.

Replacing the wiper blades

Important safety notes

G WARNING If the windshield wipers begin to move while you are changing the wiper blades, you could be trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of injury. Always switch off the windshield wipers and ignition before changing the wiper blades.

! To avoid damaging the wiper blades, make sure that you touch only the wiper arm of the wiper.

! Never open the hood if a windshield wiper arm has been folded away from the windshield. Never fold a windshield wiper arm without a wiper blade back onto the windshield/ rear window. Hold the windshield wiper arm firmly when you change the wiper blade. If you release the windshield wiper arm without a wiper blade and it falls onto the windshield, the windshield may be damaged by the force of the impact. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the wiper blades changed at a qualified specialist workshop.

Removing the wiper blades

: Windshield wiper arm ; Wiper blade = Locking spring ? Hinge piece X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock.

X Fold wiper arm: away from the windshield until it engages.

X Position wiper blade; horizontally. X Press locking spring=. X Slide wiper blade; with hinge piece? from wiper arm:.

Windshield wipers 115

Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Z

Installing the wiper blade

: Windshield wiper arm ; Wiper blade = Locking spring ? Hinge piece X Slide wiper arm: into new wiper blade; with hinge piece?.

X Engage locking spring= into the end of the wiper arm.

X Make sure that wiper blade; is seated correctly.

X Fold wiper arm: back onto the windshield.

Problems with the windshield wipers

The windshield wipers are obstructed Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windshield wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated. X For safety reasons, you should remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock.

X Remove the cause of the obstruction. X Switch the windshield wipers back on.

The windshield wipers are inoperative The windshield wiper drive is malfunctioning. X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.

X Have the windshield wipers checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

116 Windshield wipers Li gh ts an d w in ds hi el d w ip er s

Useful information ............................ 118 Overview of climate control sys- tems ................................................... 118 Operating the climate control sys- tems ................................................... 121 Setting the air vents ......................... 134

117

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Overview of climate control systems

Important safety notes

G WARNING Severe conditions (e.g. strong air pollution) may require replacement of the filter before its scheduled replacement interval. A clogged filter will reduce the air volume to the interior and the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. Have a blocked filter replaced at a Mercedes- Benz Center as soon as possible.

Observe the settings recommended on the following pages. The windows could otherwise fog up. This could prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident. Dual-zone automatic climate control regulates the temperature and the humidity in the vehicle interior and filters undesirable substances from the air. Automatic climate control is only operational when the engine is running. Optimum operation is only achieved if you drivewith the side windows and sliding sunroof closed. The climatic comfort deteriorates whilst the sliding sunroof is open. The automatic climate control cannot maintain the set temperature with the sliding sunroof open. You have to adjust the climate control manually.

i The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off.

i The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off (Y page 134).

i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 78). This will speed up the cooling process and the desired vehicle interior temperature will be reached more quickly.

i The integrated filter can filter out most particles of dust, and completely filters out pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount of air supplied to the vehicle interior. For this reason, you should always observe the interval for replacing the filter, which is specified in the Maintenance Booklet. As it depends on environmental conditions, e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may be shorter than stated in the Maintenance Booklet.

118 Overview of climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

Control panel for dual-zone automatic climate control

Canada only : Sets the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; Defrosts the windshield (Y page 131) = Switches the ZONE function on/off (Y page 131) ? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124) A Switches the rear window defroster on/off(Y page 133) B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 131) C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D Sets the air distribution (Y page 131) E Increases the airflow (Y page 131) F Reduces the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H Switches climate control on/off (Y page 121) I Sets climate control to automatic (Y page 130)

Overview of climate control systems 119

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

USA only : Sets the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; Defrosts the windshield (Y page 131) = Switches maximum cooling MAX COOL on/off (Y page 132) ? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124) A Switches the rear window defroster on/off(Y page 133) B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 131) C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D Sets the air distribution (Y page 131) E Increases the airflow (Y page 131) F Reduces the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H Switches climate control on/off (Y page 121) I Sets climate control to automatic (Y page 130)

Information about using dual-zone automatic climate control The following contains notes and recommendations on optimum use of automatic climate control. RActivate climate control using the and buttons. The indicator lamps in the and buttons light up. RSet the temperature to 72 (22 ). ROnly use the "defrosting" function briefly until the windshield is clear again.

ROnly use "air-recirculation" mode briefly, e.g. if there are unpleasant outside odors or when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise fog up, since no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle in air-recirculation mode. RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp in the button goes out.

120 Overview of climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

Operating the climate control systems

Switching climate control on/off

Points to observe before use

G WARNING When the climate control system is deactivated, the outside air supply and circulation are also deactivated. Only choose this setting for a short time. Otherwise the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others.

Switching climate control on

Canada only : Sets the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; Defrosts the windshield (Y page 131) = Switches the ZONE function on/off (Y page 131) ? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124) A Switches the rear window defroster on/off(Y page 133) B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 131) C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D Sets the air distribution (Y page 131) E Increases the airflow (Y page 131) F Reduces the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H Switches climate control on/off (Y page 121) I Sets climate control to automatic (Y page 130)

Operating the climate control systems 121

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock. X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode.

or X Press the^ button. The indicator lamp in the^ button goes out. The previously selected settings are restored.

USA only : Sets the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; Defrosts the windshield (Y page 131) = Switches maximum cooling MAX COOL on/off (Y page 132) ? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124) A Switches the rear window defroster on/off(Y page 133) B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 131) C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D Sets the air distribution (Y page 131) E Increases the airflow (Y page 131) F Reduces the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H Switches climate control on/off (Y page 121) I Sets climate control to automatic (Y page 130)

122 Operating the climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock. X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode.

or X Press the^ button. The indicator lamp in the^ button goes out. The previously selected settings are restored.

Switching off climate control

Canada only : Sets the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; Defrosts the windshield (Y page 131) = Switches the ZONE function on/off (Y page 131) ? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124) A Switches the rear window defroster on/off(Y page 133) B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 131) C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D Sets the air distribution (Y page 131) E Increases the airflow (Y page 131) F Reduces the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H Switches climate control on/off (Y page 121) I Sets climate control to automatic (Y page 130) X Press the^ button. The indicator lamp in the^ button lights up.

Operating the climate control systems 123

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

USA only : Sets the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; Defrosts the windshield (Y page 131) = Switches maximum cooling MAX COOL on/off (Y page 132) ? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124) A Switches the rear window defroster on/off(Y page 133) B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 131) C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D Sets the air distribution (Y page 131) E Increases the airflow (Y page 131) F Reduces the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H Switches climate control on/off (Y page 121) I Sets climate control to automatic (Y page 130) X Press the^ button. The indicator lamp in the^ button lights up.

Activating/deactivating cooling with air dehumidification

Points to observe before use

G WARNING If you switch off the cooling function, the vehicle will not be cooled when weather conditions are warm. The windows can fog up more quickly. Window fogging may impair visibility and endanger you and others.

The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is only available when the engine is running. The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected.

124 Operating the climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

Condensation may drip from the underside of the vehicle when it is in cooling mode. This is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.

Activating the cooling with air dehumidification function ! If the cooling with air dehumidification does not switch on, it is possible that the climate control system has lost coolant. Have the cooling with air dehumidification checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

Canada only : To set the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; To defrost the windshield (Y page 131) = To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 131) ? To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 124) A To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 133) B To set the temperature, right (Y page 131) C To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D To set the air distribution (Y page 131) E To increase the airflow (Y page 131) F To reduce the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H To switch climate control on/off (Y page 121) I To set climate control to automatic (Y page 130) X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up.

Operating the climate control systems 125

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

USA only : To set the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; To defrost the windshield (Y page 131) = To switch maximum cooling on/off (Y page 132) ? To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 124) A To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 133) B To set the temperature, right (Y page 131) C To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D To set the air distribution (Y page 131) E To increase the airflow (Y page 131) F To reduce the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H To switch climate control on/off (Y page 121) I To set climate control to automatic (Y page 130) X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up.

126 Operating the climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

Switching off the cooling with air dehumidification

Canada only : To set the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; To defrost the windshield (Y page 131) = To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 131) ? To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 124) A To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 133) B To set the temperature, right (Y page 131) C To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D To set the air distribution (Y page 131) E To increase the airflow (Y page 131) F To reduce the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H To switch climate control on/off (Y page 121) I To set climate control to automatic (Y page 130) X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out. The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function has a delayed switch-off feature.

Operating the climate control systems 127

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

USA only : To set the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; To defrost the windshield (Y page 131) = To switch maximum cooling on/off (Y page 132) ? To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 124) A To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 133) B To set the temperature, right (Y page 131) C To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D To set the air distribution (Y page 131) E To increase the airflow (Y page 131) F To reduce the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H To switch climate control on/off (Y page 121) I To set climate control to automatic (Y page 130) X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out. The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function has a delayed switch-off feature.

128 Operating the climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function

Canada only : To set the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; To defrost the windshield (Y page 131) = To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 131) ? To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 124) A To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 133) B To set the temperature, right (Y page 131) C To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D To set the air distribution (Y page 131) E To increase the airflow (Y page 131) F To reduce the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H To switch climate control on/off (Y page 121) I To set climate control to automatic (Y page 130)

When you press the button, the indicator lamp in the button flashes three times or remains off. You can no longer switch on the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Operating the climate control systems 129

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

USA only : To set the temperature, left (Y page 131) ; To defrost the windshield (Y page 131) = To switch maximum cooling on/off (Y page 132) ? To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 124) A To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 133) B To set the temperature, right (Y page 131) C To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 134) D To set the air distribution (Y page 131) E To increase the airflow (Y page 131) F To reduce the airflow (Y page 131) G Display H To switch climate control on/off (Y page 121) I To set climate control to automatic (Y page 130)

When you press the button, the indicator lamp in the button flashes three times or remains off. You can no longer switch on the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Setting climate control to automatic

G WARNING If you switch off the cooling function, the vehicle will not be cooled when weather conditions are warm. The windows can fog up more quickly. Window fogging may impair visibility and endanger you and others.

In automatic mode, the set temperature is maintained at a constant level. The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and the air distribution. Automatic mode will achieve optimal operation if cooling with air dehumidification is also activated. If desired, cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated.

130 Operating the climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Set the desired temperature. X To switch on: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up. Automatic air distribution and airflow are activated.

X To deactivate: press the_ button. or X Press theI orK button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out.

Setting the temperature You can set the temperature separately for the driver's and front-passenger sides with controls: orB(Y page 119). X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Set control: orB(Y page 119) to the desired temperature. Only change the temperature setting in small increments. Start at 72 (22 ).

Setting the air distribution X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press the_ button repeatedly until the desired symbol appears in the display.

P Directs the airflow through the center vents

O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents

S Directs the airflow through the center and footwell vents

Directs air through the defroster vents b Canada only: directs the airflow

through the defroster and center vents

a Directs air through the defroster and footwell vents

_ Canada only: directs the airflow through the defroster, center and side air vents and the footwell

Setting the airflow X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X To increase: press theK button. X To reduce: press theI button.

i The airflow from the rear-compartment vents and the center vents is the same.

Switching the ZONE function on/off X To switch on: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up. i The temperature setting for the driver's side is not adopted for the front-passenger side and the rear compartment. The temperature for the front-passenger side and the rear compartment must be set separately.

X To switch off: press button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out. i The temperature setting for the driver's side is adopted for the front-passenger side and the rear compartment.

Defrosting the windshield You can use this function to defrost the windshield or to defrost the inside of the windshield and the side windows. i You should only select the defrosting function until the windshield is clear again.

Operating the climate control systems 131

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X To activate: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up. The climate control system switches to the following functions: Rcooling with air dehumidification (only with engine running) Rhigh airflow (depending on the outside temperature) Rhigh temperature (depending on the outside temperature) Rair distribution to the windshield and front side windows Rair-recirculation mode off

X To deactivate: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out. The previously selected settings are restored. The cooling with air dehumidification function remains on. Air- recirculation mode remains deactivated.

or X Press the button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode.

or X Turn controls: orB clockwise or counter-clockwise (Y page 119).

or X Press theK orI button.

Activating/deactivating MAX COOL maximum cooling The MAX COOL function is only available in vehicles for the USA.

MAX COOL is only operational when the engine is running. X To activate: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up.

X To activate: press off-road button again. The indicator lamp goes out. The previously selected settings are restored.

When you activate MAX COOL, climate control switches to the following functions: Rmaximum cooling Rmaximum airflow Rair-recirculation mode on

Defrosting the windows

Windows fogged up on the inside X Activate the cooling with air dehumidification function.

X Activate automatic mode. X If the windows continue to fog up, activate the defrosting function (Y page 131). i You should only select this setting until the windshield is clear again.

Windows fogged up on the outside X Switch on the windshield wipers (Y page 114).

X Press the_ button repeatedly until the P orO symbol appears in the display.

132 Operating the climate control systems Cl im at e co nt ro l

i You should only select this setting until the windshield is clear again.

Switching the windshield defroster on/off

G WARNING Any accumulation of snow and ice should be removed from the windshield before driving. Otherwise, your vision may be impaired, which could endanger you or others.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X To switch on: press button;. Indicator lamp: lights up.

X To switch off: press button;. Indicator lamp: goes out. i At outside temperatures above 50(10), the windshield heating cannot be activated. Indicator lamp: lights up briefly when you attempt to activate it and then goes out again.

i The windshield defroster has a high current draw. You should therefore switch it off as soon as the windshield is clear. The windshield heating otherwise switches itself off automatically after 10 minutes.

i If you turn on the windshield heating for the fourth consecutive time, the windshield heating will automatically switch off after 5 minutes.

i If the vehicle's electrical system voltage is too low because too many electrical

consumers are switched on, indicator lamp: flashes. After approximately 30 seconds, the windshield heating turns off automatically.

Switching the rear window defroster on/off

Activating/deactivating

G WARNING Any accumulation of snow and ice should be removed from the rear window before driving. Visibility could otherwise be impaired, endangering you and others.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X USA only: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up or goes out. i The rear window defroster has a high current draw. You should therefore switch it off as soon as the rear window is clear. as it only switches off automatically after several minutes.

i If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window defroster may switch off.

Problems with the rear window defroster If the indicator lamp in the rear window defroster button flashes, the on-board voltage is too low. The rear window defroster has deactivated prematurely or cannot be activated. X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading lamps or interior lighting. When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window defroster is activated again automatically.

Operating the climate control systems 133

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

Activating/deactivating air- recirculation mode

G WARNING Fogged windows impair visibility, endangering you and others. If the windows begin to fog on the inside, switching off the air recirculation mode immediately should clear interior window fogging. If interior window fogging persists, make sure the air conditioning is activated, or press the button.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X To switch on: press thed button. The indicator lamp in thed button lights up. i Air-recirculation mode is automatically activated at high levels of pollution or at high outside temperatures. When air- recirculation mode is activated automatically, the indicator lamp in the d button is not lit. Outside air is added after approximately 30 minutes.

X To deactivate: press thed button. The indicator lamp in thed button goes out. i Air-recirculation mode switches off automatically: Rafter approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately 41 Rafter approximately five minutes if cooling with air dehumidification is deactivated Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately 41 (5 )

Activating/deactivating the residual heat function The "residual heat" function is only available in Canada. It is possible to make use of the residual heat of the engine to continue heating the stationary vehicle for up to 30 minutes after the engine has been switched off. The heating timedepends on the coolant temperature and on the interior temperature that has been set. i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.

i If you activate the residual heat function at high temperatures, only the ventilation will be activated.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 0(Y page 139) in the ignition lock or remove it.

X To activate: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up.

X To deactivate: press the button. The indicator lamp in the button goes out. i Residual heat is deactivated automatically: Rafter approximately 30 minutes Rwhen the ignition is switched on Rif the battery voltage drops Rif the coolant temperature is too low

Setting the air vents

Important safety notes

G WARNING When operating the climate control, the air that enters the passenger compartment through the air vents can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This could cause burns or frostbite to unprotected skin in the immediate area of the air vents.

134 Setting the air vents Cl im at e co nt ro l

Always keep sufficient distance between unprotected parts of the body and the air vents. If necessary, use the air distribution adjustment to direct the air to air vents in the vehicle interior that are not in the immediate area of unprotected skin.

General notes In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air through the air vents into the vehicle interior, please observe the following notes: Rkeep the air intake grill on the hood free of blockages, such as ice, snow or leaves. Rnever cover the air vents or air intake grilles in the vehicle interior.

i For virtually draft-free ventilation, adjust the sliders of the air vents to the center position.

i If the automatic climate control constantly differs from the set temperature or if undesired drafts are noticeable, proceed as follows: X Open the side air vents X Open the center air vents X Open the rear air vents X Set the temperature to 72 (22 ). The automatic climate control adjusts to the set temperature.

Setting the center air vents

Center air vents : Center air vent, left ; Center air vent, right = Center vent thumbwheel, right ? Center vent thumbwheel, left X To open/close: turn thumbwheels= and? to the right or left.

Setting the side air vents

Side air vents : Side air vent ; Swiveling side air vent = Control for side air vent X Toopen/close: turn thumbwheel= to the left or right.

Setting the air vents 135

Cl im at e co nt ro l

Z

Setting the rear-compartment air vents

X To open/close: turn thumbwheel: up or down.

X To set the air direction: move slider; for the corresponding rear-compartment air vent to the left, right, up or down.

136 Setting the air vents Cl im at e co nt ro l

Useful information ............................ 138 Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle 138 Driving ............................................... 138 Automatic transmission ................... 145 Refueling ............................................ 153 Parking ............................................... 156 Driving tips ........................................ 158 Driving systems ................................ 168 Off-road driving systems .................. 193 Towing a trailer ................................. 198

137

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle

Important safety notes New and replaced brake pads and discs only reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometers of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the brake pedal.

The first 1000 miles (1500 km) The more you look after the engine when it is new, the more satisfied you will be with its performance in the future. RYou should therefore drive at varying vehicle and engine speeds for the first 1,000 miles (1,500 km). RAvoid heavy loads, e.g. driving at full throttle, during this period. RChange gear in good time, before the tachometer needle is of the way to the red area of the tachometer. RDo not manually shift to a lower gear to brake the vehicle. RIf possible, do not depress the accelerator pedal past the point of resistance (kickdown). ROnly select shift ranges 3, 2 or 1 when driving slowly, e.g. in mountainous terrain.

After 1,000 miles (1,500 km), you can increase the engine speed gradually and bring the vehicle to full speed. Additional breaking-in notes for AMG vehicles: RDo not drive faster than 85 mph (140 km/h) for the first 1,000 miles (1,500 km). ROnly allow the engine to reach a maximum engine speed of 4,500 rpm briefly. RChange gear in good time. RAvoid driving off-road before the differential oil change at 2,000 miles (3,000 km). RIdeally, for the first 1,000miles (1,500 km), drive in program C. i You should also observe these breaking- in notes if the engine or parts of the drive train on your vehicle have been replaced.

i Always observe the respective speed limits.

AMG vehicles with rear axle locking differential Change the oil after a breaking-in period of 2,000miles (3,000 km) to improve protection of the differential. This oil change will lengthen the service life of the differential. Have the oil change carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose.

Driving

Important safety notes

G WARNING Objects in the driver's footwell can restrict the pedal travel or obstruct a depressed pedal. The operating and road safety of the vehicle is jeopardized. There is a risk of an accident.

138 Driving Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Make sure that all objects in the vehicle are stowed correctly, and that they cannot enter the driver's footwell. Install the floormats securely and as specified in order to ensure sufficient clearance for the pedals. Do not use loose floormats.

G WARNING Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage of the pedals, e.g.: Rshoes with thick soles Rshoes with high heels Rslippers There is a risk of an accident. Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct usage of the pedals.

G WARNING If you switch off the ignition while driving, safety-relevant functions are only available with limitations, or not at all. This could affect, for example, the power steering and the brake boosting effect. You will require considerably more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an accident. Do not switch off the ignition while driving.

G WARNING If the parking brake has not been fully released when driving, the parking brake can: Roverheat and cause a fire Rlose its hold function. There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release the parking brake fully before driving off.

! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use the engine's full performance until it has reached operating temperature. Only shift the automatic transmission to the desired drive position when the vehicle is stationary. Where possible, avoid spinning the drive wheels when pulling away on slippery roads. You could otherwise damage the drive train.

! Avoid high engine speeds when the engine is cold. The engine's service life could otherwise be significantly shortened. Do not use the engine's full performance until it has reached operating temperature.

! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil temperatures below 68 (+20 ), the maximum engine speed is restricted in order to protect the engine. To protect the engine and maintain smooth engine operation, avoid driving at full throttle when the engine is cold.

Key positions

g To remove the SmartKey 1 Power supply for some consumers, such

as the windshield wipers 2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)

and drive position 3 To start the engine

As soon as the ignition is switched on, all the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light up. If an indicator lamp does not go out after starting the engine or lights up while driving, see (Y page 244). If the SmartKey is in position 0 in the ignition lock for an extended period of time, it can no longer be turned in the ignition lock. The steering is then locked. To unlock, remove the SmartKey and reinsert it into the ignition lock. The steering is locked when you remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock.

Driving 139

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

X Remove the SmartKey when the engine is switched off. The starter battery could otherwise be discharged.

If you cannot turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock, the starter battery may not be charged sufficiently. X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary (Y page 301).

or X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 303).

i You can only remove the SmartKey if: Rthe SmartKey is in position 0 in the ignition lock. Rthe automatic transmission selector lever is in P.

Starting the engine

Important safety notes

G WARNING Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.

G WARNING Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive under these conditions, drive only with at least one window fully open at all times.

! Do not depress the accelerator pedal when starting the engine.

Starting procedure X Shift the automatic transmission to position P. The transmission position display in the multifunction display shows P. i For further information about the automatic transmission, see (Y page 145).

i If you depress the brakewhen starting the engine, pedal travel is unusually long and there is less pedal resistance.

X Make sure that the parking brake is applied.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 139) and release it as soon as the engine is running.

i You can also use the touch-start function. To do this, turn the SmartKey to position 3 (Y page 139) and release it immediately. The engine then starts automatically.

Pulling away

Automatic transmission

G WARNING If the engine speed is above the idling speed and you engage transmission position D or R, the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is a risk of an accident. When engaging transmission position D or R, always firmly depress the brake pedal and do not simultaneously accelerate.

! Only shift the automatic transmission to reverse gear R or park position P when the vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.

! Do not depress the accelerator pedal while depressing the brake pedal. This impairs engine performance and results in premature wear on the brake system and drivetrain.

140 Driving Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

! If a warning tone sounds and the Release Park. Brake message appears in the multifunction display, the parking brake is still applied. Release the parking brake.

X Depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed.

X Shift the automatic transmission to position D or R. i Before driving off, wait until the gear change is fully completed.

X Release the parking brake (Y page 157). X Release the brake pedal. X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.

i It is only possible to shift the automatic transmission from position P to a different position if you depress the brake pedal. Only then is the selector lever lock released.

i The vehicle locks centrally once you have pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors drop down. You can open the doors from the inside at any time. You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 216).

i Upshifts take place at higher engine speeds after a cold start. This helps the catalytic converter to reach its operating temperature more quickly.

Hill start assist

G WARNING After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away. There is a risk of an accident and injury. Therefore, quickly move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start assist.

Hill start assist helps you when pulling away forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient.

It holds the vehicle for a short time after you have removed your foot from the brake pedal. This gives you enough time to move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal and to depress it before the vehicle begins to roll. X Take your foot off the brake pedal. i Once you have taken your foot off the brake pedal, the vehicle is held for around one second.

X Pull away. Hill start assist will not function if: Ryou are pulling away on a level road or on a downhill gradient. Rthe transmission is in position N. Rthe parking brake is applied. RESP is malfunctioning.

ECO start/stop function (AMG vehicles)

Important safety notes

G WARNING If the engine is switched off automatically and you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted automatically. The vehicle may begin moving. There is a risk of accident and injury. If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off the ignition and secure the vehicle against rolling away.

General notes The ECO start/stop function is only available for the G 63 AMG. The ECO start/stop function switches the engine off automatically when the vehicle stops moving. The engine starts automatically when the driver wants to pull away again. The ECO start/stop function thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.

Driving 141

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

The ECO start/stop function is activated each time the engine is switched on. The ECO start/stop function is only available in drive program C. The system is operational when the symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display. The system is operational if all conditions for automatic engine switch-off have been fulfilled (Y page 142) and the symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display. In addition, the Stop/Start active message is shown in the AMG menu in the multifunction display. If not all conditions for automatic engine switch-off (Y page 142) are fulfilled, the symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display. In addition, the Stop/Start inactive message is shown in the AMG menu in the multifunction display. If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 142) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated, the symbol is not displayed. The Stop/Start active or Stop/Start inactive message in the AMG menu in the multifunction display goes out.

Deactivating/activating the ECO start/ stop function

ECO button

X To switch off: press button: in drive program C.

or X Switch to drive program S or M (Y page 149). Indicator lamp; on button: and the symbol in themultifunction display go out. The Stop/Start active or Stop/Start inactivemessage in the AMGmenu in the multifunction display goes out.

X To switch on: press button:. Indicator lamp; lights up. If drive program S or M is active, the automatic transmission switches to drive program C. If all conditions for automatic engine switch-off (Y page 142) are fulfilled, the symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display. In addition, the Stop/Start activemessage is shown in the AMGmenu in themultifunction display. If conditions for automatic engine switch- off (Y page 142) have not been fulfilled, the symbol will be shown in yellow. If this is the case, the ECO start/stop function is not available. In addition, the Stop/Start inactive message is shown in the AMG menu in the multifunction display.

i If indicator lamp; is off, the ECO start/ stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.

Automatic engine switch-off If the vehicle is braked to a standstill in D or N, the ECO start/stop function switches off the engine automatically. The ECO start/stop function is operational and the symbol is displayed in green in the multifunction display, if: Rthe indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit green. Rno off-road program has been selected.

142 Driving Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Rthe vehicle is stationary. Rthe outside temperature is within the comfort range. Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature. Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior has been reached. Rthe battery is sufficiently charged. Rthe system detects that the windshield is not fogged up when the air-conditioning system is switched on. Rthe hood is closed. Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's seat belt is fastened.

If conditions for automatic engine switch-off have not been fulfilled, the symbol will be shown in yellow. In addition, the Stop/Start inactive message is shown in the AMG menu in the multifunction display.

i If you shift the transmission from R to D, the ECO start/stop function is available again once the symbol reappears in green in the multifunction display.

i The engine can be automatically switched off an unlimited number of times.

i You can still activate the HOLD function when the vehicle is stationary, even if the engine has been switched off automatically. It is then not necessary to continue applying the brakes during the automatic stop phase. When you depress the accelerator pedal, the engine starts automatically and the braking effect of the HOLD function is deactivated. Depress the accelerator pedal carefully, as the engine must be started first.

i During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control system only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require full climate control capacity, the ECO start/stop function can be deactivated by pressing the ECO button (Y page 142).

Automatic engine start The engine starts automatically if: RIn general:

- you switch off the ECO start/stop function by pressing the ECO button.

- you release the brakes when in transmission position D or N and when the HOLD function is not active.

RBy the driver: - you release the brakes when in transmission position D or N.

- you depress the accelerator pedal. - you engage reverse gear R. - you move the transmission out of position P.

- you switch to drive program S or M. - you unfasten your seat belt or open the driver's door.

RBy the system: - the vehicle starts to roll. - the brake system requires this. - the temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range.

- the system detects moisture on the windshield when the air-conditioning system is switched on.

- the charge level of the battery is too low.

i Shifting the transmission to position P does not start the engine.

Driving 143

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Problems with the engine

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

The engine does not start. The starter motor can be heard.

RThere is a malfunction in the engine electronics. RThere is a malfunction in the fuel supply. X Turn the SmartKey back to position 0 in the ignition lock before attempting to start the engine again.

X Try to start the engine again (Y page 140). Avoid excessively long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this (Y page 139) will drain the battery.

If the engine does not start after several attempts: X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

The engine does not start. The starter motor can be heard. The yellow reserve fuel warning lamp is lit and the needle of the fuel gauge display shows 0.

The fuel tank is empty. X Refuel the vehicle.

The engine does not start. You cannot hear the starter motor.

The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or discharged. X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 303). If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it: X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

The startermotor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high. X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two minutes.

X Try to start the engine again. If the engine still does not start: X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

The engine is not running smoothly and is misfiring.

There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical component of the engine management system. X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.

X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.

144 Driving Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

The coolant temperature gauge shows a value above 248 (120 ). A display message may also appear in the multifunction display and awarning tonemay sound.

The coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently. X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to cool down.

X Check the coolant level (Y page 285). Observe the warning notes as you do so and add coolant if necessary.

If the coolant level is correct, the radiator fan may be faulty. The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently. X At coolant temperatures below 248 (120 ), drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.

X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain and start/stop traffic.

Automatic transmission

Important safety notes

G WARNING If the engine speed is above the idling speed and you engage transmission position D or R, the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is a risk of an accident. When engaging transmission position D or R, always firmly depress the brake pedal and do not simultaneously accelerate.

G WARNING The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine. The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an accident. After switching off the engine, always switch to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking brake.

i Bear in mind that the power transmission between the engine and the transmission is interrupted when the engine is switched off. For this reason, shift the automatic transmission to P when the engine is switched off and the vehicle is at a

standstill. Apply the parking brake to prevent the vehicle from rolling away.

Selector lever

Overview of transmission positions ! If the engine speed is too high or if the vehicle is rolling, do not shift the transmission directly from D to R, from R to D or directly to P. Do not open the driver's door while the vehicle is in motion. At low speeds in transmission position D or R, park position P is otherwise engaged automatically. The transmission could be damaged.

Automatic transmission 145

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Selector lever j Park position k Reverse gear i Neutral h Drive

When you select a transmission position, the selector lever subsequently returns to its original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears in the transmission position display in the multifunction display.

Transmission position and drive program display ! If the transmission position display in the multifunction display is not working, you should pull away carefully to checkwhether the desired transmission position is engaged. Select transmission position D. Do not restrict the shift range.

: Transmission position ; Drive program

Current transmission position: and current drive program; appear in the multifunction display.

The current position of the selector lever is shown by the indicators next to the selector lever. The indicators light up when the SmartKey is inserted into the ignition lock. The indicators go out when the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock. When the selector lever is in position D, you can influence the gearshifts made by the automatic transmission by: Rrestricting the shift range Rchanging gear yourself

Engaging park position P X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed.

X Press the P button in the center console.

i If you depress the brake pedal and push the selector lever forwards or back to the first point of resistance, park position P is disengaged. The transmission shifts to neutral N.

Park position P is automatically engaged: Rif you remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock Rif you open the driver's door while traveling at low speed in transmission position D or R Rif DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 176) brakes your vehicle until it is stationary and at least one of the following conditions is fulfilled: - the engine is switched off. - the driver's door is open and the seat belt is not fastened.

- there is a system malfunction. - the power supply is insufficient.

Engaging reverse gear R ! Only shift the automatic transmission to R when the vehicle is stationary.

146 Automatic transmission Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed.

X Push the selector lever forwards past the first point of resistance. Transmission position R is engaged.

i For AMG vehicles: when reverse gear is engaged and the ECO start/stop function is switched on, the engine starts up automatically (Y page 141).

Shifting to neutral N

G WARNING When leaving the SmartKey in the starter switch, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle. It is possible for children to switch on the ignition which could result in unsupervised use of vehicle equipment. Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury.

If the vehicle is stationary: X Depress the brake pedal. X Depending on the current transmission position, press the selector lever forwards or backwards to the first point of resistance. The automatic transmission shifts to N.

If the engine has been switched off, the automatic transmission automatically shifts to N. i For AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function switches the engine off automatically if the vehicle is braked to a standstill when in neutral N and the brake is still depressed (Y page 141).

Remaining in neutral N

G WARNING If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle, they could: Ropen the doors, thus endangering other people or road users. Rget out and disrupt traffic. Roperate the vehicle's equipment. Additionally, children could set the vehicle in motion if, for example, they: Rrelease the parking brake. Rshift the automatic transmission out of parking position P. Rstarting the engine. There is a risk of an accident and injury. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of reach of children.

X Make sure that the ignition is switched on. X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed.

X Shift to neutral N. X Release the brake pedal. X If the parking brake is applied, release it. X Switch off the ignition and leave the SmartKey in the ignition lock.

Shifting to transmission position D X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed.

X Push the selector lever back past the first point of resistance. Transmission position D is engaged.

i For AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function switches the engine off automatically if the vehicle is braked to a standstill when in transmission position D and the brake is still depressed (Y page 141).

Automatic transmission 147

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Transmission positions

B Park position Do not shift the transmission into position P (Y page 145) unless the vehicle is stationary. The parking lock should not be used as a brake when parking. In addition to engaging the parking lock, you must always apply the parking brake to secure the vehicle.

i The SmartKey can only be removed if the transmission is in position P. When there is no SmartKey in the ignition lock, the selector lever is locked in position P.

Have the vehicle electronics checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.

C Reverse gear Only shift the transmission to R when the vehicle is stationary.

A Neutral No power is transmitted from the engine to the drive wheels. Releasing the brakes will allow you to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to push it or tow it. Do not shift the transmission to N while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged. If ESP is deactivated or faulty: only shift the transmission to positionN if the vehicle is in danger of skidding, e.g. on icy roads. If you want to engage the transfer case, shift briefly into N (Y page 194).

! Rolling in neutralN can damage the drive train.

7 Drive The automatic transmission changes gear automatically. All forward gears are available.

Changing gear The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. This automatic gearshifting behavior is determined by: Ra shift range restriction, if selected Rthe position of the transfer case (HIGH RANGE or LOW RANGE) Rthe position of the accelerator pedal Rthe road speed

148 Automatic transmission Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Driving tips

Accelerator pedal position Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear: Rlittle throttle: early upshifts Rmore throttle: late upshifts

Kickdown Use kickdown for maximum acceleration: X Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point. The automatic transmission shifts to a lower gear depending on the engine speed.

X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the desired speed is reached. The automatic transmission shifts back up.

Rocking the vehicle free Rocking the vehicle free by shifting back and forth between transmission positions D and R can help to free a vehicle that has become stuck in mud or snow. The vehicle's engine management restricts switching between transmission positions D and R to speeds up to a maximum of 5 mph (9 km/h). To shift back and forth between transmission positions D and R, move the selector lever forwards and backwards past the point of resistance.

Towing a trailer X Drive in the middle of the engine speed range on uphill gradients.

X Limit shift range to 3 or 2 depending on the uphill or downhill gradient (Y page 150), even if cruise control or SPEEDTRONIC is activated.

X Shift the transfer case into low-range driving position LOW RANGE on extreme uphill gradients or steep downhill gradients (Y page 194).

Program selector button

General notes The program selector button allows you to choose between drive programs with different driving characteristics.

i In AMG vehicles, drive program E is called drive program C.

Drive programs

E Economy C Controlled Efficiency

Comfortable, economical driving

S Sport Sporty driving style

M Manual Manual gear shifting

i When the engine is started, the automatic transmission always switches to automatic drive program E (drive program C in AMG vehicles).

i For further information on the automatic drive program, see (Y page 150).

i Only change from automatic drive program E or S to manual drive program M when the vehicle is stationary.

Selecting the drive program

Example: program selector button X Press program selector button: repeatedly until the letter for the desired

Automatic transmission 149

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

gearshift program appears in the multifunction display. i Only change from automatic drive program E or S to manual drive program M when the vehicle is stationary.

Steering wheel paddle shifters

In the automatic drive program, you can restrict or derestrict the shift range by using steering wheel paddle shifters: and; (Y page 150). In the manual drive program you can change gears manually using steering wheel paddle shifters: and;(Y page 151).

i You can only change gear with the steering wheel paddle shifters when the transmission is in position D.

Automatic drive program Drive program E (drive program C on AMG vehicles) is characterized by the following: Rcomfort-oriented engine and transmission settings Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from the automatic transmission shifting up sooner Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in forward and reverse gears, unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully

Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving stability on slippery road surfaces, for example Rthe automatic transmission shifting up sooner. This results in the vehicle being driven at lower engine speeds and the wheels being less likely to spin

Drive program S is characterized by the following: Rsporty engine and transmission settings Rthe vehicle pulling away in first gear Rthe automatic transmission shifting up later Rthe fuel consumption possibly being higher as a result of the later automatic transmission shift points

Shift ranges

Introduction When the automatic transmission is in position D, it is possible to restrict or derestrict the shift range. The shift range selected is shown in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts only as far as the selected gear. Driving situations

= You can use the engine's braking effect.

5 The braking effect of the engine can be utilized on downhill gradients or when driving: Ron steep mountain roads Rin mountainous terrain Rin arduous conditions

4 The braking effect of the engine can be utilized on extremely steep downhill gradients and long downhill stretches.

150 Automatic transmission Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Restricting the shift range X Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter (Y page 150). The automatic transmission shifts down one gear and restricts the shift range to the relevant gear.

i If the engine exceeds the maximum engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine damage by not shifting down.

i If the maximum engine speed for the shift range is reached and you continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission shifts up in order to prevent the engine from overrevving, even if the shift range is restricted.

Derestricting the shift range X Pull the right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter (Y page 150). The automatic transmission shifts up one gear and restricts the shift range to the relevant gear.

Clearing the shift range restriction X Pull and hold the right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter (Y page 150) untilD is shown again in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts from the current shift range directly to D.

Selecting the ideal shift range X Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter (Y page 150) and hold it in position. The automatic transmission shifts to the gear which allows optimum acceleration and deceleration. To do this, the automatic transmission shifts down one or more gears.

i The automatic transmission cannot shift down beyond second gear. To shift to first gear, you have to pull the left steering wheel paddle shifter.

Manual drive program

Introduction In drive program M, you can change gear manually using the steering wheel paddle shifters. For this, the transmission must be in position D. The gear currently selected and engaged is shown in the multifunction display. Manual drive program M differs from drive programs E and S with regard to spontaneity, responsiveness and smoothness of gear changes.

Switching on the manual drive program X Press the program selector button (Y page 149) repeatedly untilM appears in the multifunction display.

Upshifting (except AMG vehicles) X Pull the right-hand paddle (Y page 150). The automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear.

Shifting up (AMG vehicles) ! Inmanual drive programM, the automatic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting speed for the current gear is reached. When the engine limiting speed is reached, the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine from overrevving. Always make sure that the engine speed does not reach the red area of the tachometer. There is otherwise a risk of engine damage.

X Pull the right-hand paddle (Y page 150). The automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear.

Before the engine speed reaches the red area, an upshift indicator will be shown in the multifunction display. X If the color in the speedometer multifunction display changes to red and

Automatic transmission 151

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

the UP display message is shown, shift up a gear.

Downshifting X Pull the left-hand paddle (Y page 150). The automatic transmission shifts down to the next gear.

i If you slow down or stop without shifting down, the automatic transmission automatically shifts down.

Selecting the optimal gear for maximum acceleration X Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter until the transmission selects the optimum gear for the current speed.

Kickdown You can also use kickdown for maximum acceleration in manual drive program M. X Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point. The transmission shifts to a lower gear depending on the engine speed.

X Shift back up once the desired speed is reached.

i Vehicles with an AMG engine: it is not possible to use kickdown in manual drive program M. i Vehicles without an AMG engine: if you apply full throttle, the automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear when the maximum engine speed is reached. This prevents the engine from overrevving.

Switching off themanual drive program X Press the program selector button (Y page 149) repeatedly until E (C in AMG vehicles) or S appears in the multifunction display.

152 Automatic transmission Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Problems with the automatic transmission

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

The acceleration ability is deteriorating. The transmission no longer changes gear.

The transmission is in emergency mode. It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear. X Stop the vehicle. X Shift the transmission to position P. X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock. X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine. X Shift the transmission to position D or R. If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.

X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.

You hear a warning tone.

You have: Rswitched off the engine Ropened the driver's door Rnot moved the selector lever to position P X Move the selector lever to position P.

Refueling

Important safety notes

G WARNING Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns violently and can cause serious personal injury. Never allow sparks, flames or smoking materials near gasoline. Turn off the engine before refueling. Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling fumes and any skin or clothing contact. Direct skin contact with fuels and the inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your health.

! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a gasoline engine. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage to the fuel system and engine.

! Do not switch on the ignition if you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel lines. Notify a qualified specialist workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained completely.

! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the fuel system.

! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted surfaces. You could otherwise damage the paintwork.

! Use a filter when refueling from a fuel can. Otherwise, the fuel lines and/or injection system could be blocked by particles from the fuel can.

If you overfill the fuel tank, pressuremay build up in the fuel tank. This could cause fuel to spray out when the fuel pump nozzle is removed. There is a risk of injury. The fuel tank is full when the fuel pump nozzle first switches off. End the refueling process.

Refueling 153

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Further information on fuel and fuel quality (Y page 343)

Refueling

Vehicles with a fuel filler flap

Example: G 550 fuel filler cap : To open the fuel filler flap ; Tire pressure table = Fuel type ? To insert the fuel filler cap

When you open or close the vehicle with the SmartKey, the fuel filler flap is automatically unlocked or locked. The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed 8 in the instrument cluster. The arrow next to the filling pump indicates the side of the vehicle. The fuel filler flap is located to the rear on the right.

Vehicles without a fuel filler flap

Opening the fuel filler cap

: To open the fuel filler flap ; Tire pressure table = Fuel type ? To insert the fuel filler cap X Switch the engine off. i When the engine is running and the fuel filler flap is open, the yellow reserve fuel warning lamp and the= (USA only) or; (Canada only) Check Engine warning lamp may light up. Further information about warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster can be found in the Digital Operator's Manual.

X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock.

X Turn the fuel filler cap counterclockwise and remove it.

X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder bracket on the inside of filler flap?.

Refueling X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel pump nozzle into the tank and refuel.

i Do not add any more fuel after the pump stops filling for the first time. Otherwise, fuel may leak out.

154 Refueling Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Closing X Replace the fuel filler cap and turn it clockwise. The fuel filler cap audibly engages.

X Close the fuel filler flap.

i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the vehicle. A locking pin otherwise prevents the fuel filler flap from closing after the vehicle has been locked.

Fuel filler flap emergency release

The emergency release is located in the cargo compartment, on the right-hand side when viewed in the direction of travel, behind the rear panel trim. i The vehicle body in the emergency release area has sharp edges. There is a risk of injury. Avoid contact with the edges on the inside of the vehicle body.

X Open the rear door. X Remove edge protection:. X Remove rear panel trim;.

X Pull emergency release= in the direction of the arrow. The fuel filler flap is unlocked.

X Open the fuel filler flap.

Refueling 155

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Problems with the fuel and fuel tank

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Fuel is leaking from the vehicle.

G Risk of explosion or fire The fuel line or the fuel tank is defective. X Turn the SmartKey to position 0(Y page 139) in the ignition lock immediately and remove it.

X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.

The fuel filler flap is not unlocked. or The SmartKey batteries are discharged. X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 68). or X Unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key (Y page 70). X Open the rear door. X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release (Y page 155).

The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed. X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release (Y page 155).

X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

Parking

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, they could set it in motion by, for example: Rrelease the parking brake. Rshift the automatic transmission out of the parking position P. Rstart the engine. In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of an accident and injury.

When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.

G WARNING Flammable material such as leaves, grass or twigsmay ignite if they come into contactwith hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust gas flow. There is a risk of fire. Park the vehicle so that no flammable materials come into contact with parts of the vehicle which are hot. Take particular care not to park on dry grassland or harvested grain fields.

156 Parking Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

G WARNING If you switch off the ignition while driving, safety-relevant functions are only available with limitations, or not at all. This could affect, for example, the power steering and the brake boosting effect. You will require considerably more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an accident. Do not switch off the ignition while driving.

Switching off the engine

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you switch off the ignition while driving, safety-relevant functions are only available with limitations, or not at all. This could affect, for example, the power steering and the brake boosting effect. You will require considerably more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an accident. Do not switch off the ignition while driving.

G WARNING The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine. The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an accident. After switching off the engine, always switch to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking brake.

Vehicles with automatic transmission X Shift the transmission to position P. X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock (Y page 139) and remove it. The immobilizer is activated.

X Apply the parking brake firmly. X Turn the steering wheel until the steering wheel lock engages.

i If you turn off the engine with the SmartKey and then remove it from the

ignition lock or open a front door, the automatic transmission shifts to P automatically.

i The SmartKey can only be removed if the automatic transmission is in position P.

Parking brake

G WARNING If you must brake the vehicle with the parking brake, the braking distance is considerably longer and the wheels could lock. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents. Only use the parking brake to brake the vehicle when the service brake is faulty. Do not apply the parking brake too firmly. If the wheels lock, release the parking brake until the wheels begin turning again.

G WARNING If you leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, they could set it in motion by, for example: Rreleasing the parking brake Rshifting the automatic transmission out of the parking position P Rstarting the engine. They could also operate the vehicle's equipment. There is a risk of an accident and injury. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKeywith you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.

Parking 157

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

i When you apply parking brake; to brake the vehicle, the brake lamps do not light up.

X To apply: pull parking brake; up firmly. Parking brake; is applied. When the ignition is switched on or the engine is running, theF (USA only) or J (Canada only) indicator lamp is lit in the instrument cluster.

X To release: depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed. The selector lever lock is released.

X Pull parking brake; up firmly. X Press release button: on parking brake; and move parking brake; down to the stop. When the ignition is switched on or the engine is running, theF (USA only) or! (Canada only) indicator lamp goes out in the instrument cluster.

i If you pull away with parking brake; applied, a warning tone sounds.

Parking the vehicle for a long period If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than four weeks, the battery may be damaged by exhaustive discharge. X Connecting a trickle charger. i You can obtain information about trickle chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.

If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and seek advice.

Driving tips

General driving tips

Important safety notes

G WARNING Always remember that you must concentrate primarily on driving the vehicle. The driver's concentration must always be directed primarily at road traffic. For your own safety and that of others, we recommend that you stop the vehicle at a safe place and in accordance with the traffic conditions before making or accepting a phone call. Comply with all legal requirements if you use the telephone while driving. Use the hands- free system and only use the telephone when road, weather and traffic conditions permit. In some jurisdictions, it is forbidden for drivers to use mobile phones while driving. Only operateCOMAND (CockpitManagement and Data System) in compliance with all legal requirements andwhen the road,weather and traffic conditions permit. You may otherwise not be able to observe the traffic conditions, endangering yourself and others. Remember that your vehicle covers a distance of 44 ft (approximately 14 m) a second when it is traveling at only 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h).

G WARNING If you switch off the ignition while driving, safety-relevant functions are only available with limitations, or not at all. This could affect, for example, the power steering and the brake boosting effect. You will require considerably more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an accident. Do not switch off the ignition while driving.

158 Driving tips Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Drive sensibly save fuel Observe the following tips to save fuel: X The tires should always be inflated to the recommended tire pressure.

X Remove unnecessary loads. X Remove roof carriers when they are not needed.

X Warm up the engine at low engine speeds. X Avoid frequent acceleration or braking. X Have all maintenance work performed at the service intervals specified in the Maintenance Booklet or indicated by the service interval indicator.

Fuel consumption also increases when driving in cold weather, in stop-and-go traffic and in mountainous terrain.

Drinking and driving

G WARNING Drinking and driving and/or taking drugs and driving are very dangerous combinations. Even a small amount of alcohol or drugs can affect your reflexes, perceptions and judgment. The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident are greatly increasedwhen you drink or take drugs and drive. Do not drink or take drugs and drive or allow anyone to drive who has been drinking or taking drugs.

Pedals

G WARNING Objects in the driver's footwell can restrict the pedal travel or obstruct a depressed pedal. The operating and road safety of the vehicle is jeopardized. There is a risk of an accident. Make sure that all objects in the vehicle are stowed correctly, and that they cannot enter the driver's footwell. Install the floormats securely and as specified in order to ensure sufficient clearance for the pedals. Do not use loose floormats.

Exhaust check

G WARNING Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive under these conditions, drive only with at least one window fully open at all times.

Certain engine systems are designed to keep the level of poisonous components in exhaust fumes within legal limits. These systems only work at peak efficiency if they are serviced exactly in accordance with the manufacturer's specifications. For this reason, all work on the engine should only be carried out by qualified and authorized Mercedes-Benz technicians. The engine settings must not be changed under any circumstances. Furthermore, all specific service work must be carried out at regular intervals and in accordance with the Mercedes-Benz service requirements. Details can be found in the Maintenance Booklet.

Braking

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you activate the LOW off-road gear while driving on a slippery road surface, the wheels may lose traction: Rif you remove your foot from the accelerator pedal when driving Rif off road ABS intervenes when braking If the wheels lose traction. the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.

Driving tips 159

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Never activate the LOW off-road gear while driving on a slippery road surface.

Downhill gradients ! On long and steep gradients, you must reduce the load on the brakes by shifting early to a lower gear. This allows you to take advantage of the engine braking effect and helps avoid overheating and excessive wear of the brakes. When you take advantage of the engine braking effect, a drive wheel may not turn for some time, e.g. on a slippery road surface. This could cause damage to the drive train. This type of damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz warranty.

Heavy and light loads

G WARNING If you rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving, the braking system can overheat. This increases the stopping distance and can even cause the braking system to fail. There is a risk of an accident. Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Never depress the brake pedal and the accelerator pedal at the same time.

! Depressing the brake pedal constantly results in excessive and premature wear to the brake pads.

If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.

Wet roads If driving in heavy rain for a prolonged period of time without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first time. This may also occur after the vehicle has been washed.

You have to depress the brake pedal more firmly. Maintain a greater distance from the vehicle in front. After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up the brake discs, thereby drying them more quickly and protecting them against corrosion.

Limited braking performance on salt- treated roads If you drive on salted roads, a layer of salt residue may form on the brake discs and brake pads. This can result in a significantly longer braking distance. RBrake occasionally to remove any possible salt residue. Make sure that you do not endanger other road users when doing so. RCarefully depress the brake pedal and the beginning and end of a journey. RMaintain a greater distance to the vehicle ahead.

Servicing the brakes ! If the brake warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster and you hear a warning tone even though the parking brake has been released, the brake fluid level may be too low. Observe additional warning messages in the multifunction display. The brake fluid level may be too low due to brake pad wear or leaking brake lines. Have the brake system checked immediately. This work should be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

! A function or performance test should only be carried out on a 2-axle dynamometer. If you are planning to have the vehicle tested on such a dynamometer, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to obtain further information first. Otherwise, you could damage the drive train or the brake system.

160 Driving tips Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

! As the ESP system operates automatically, the engine and the ignition must be switched off (the SmartKey must be in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock) if the parking brake is tested on a brake dynamometer (for a maximum of ten seconds). Braking applications triggered automatically by ESP may otherwise seriously damage the brake system.

Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings installed on your vehicle which have been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which correspond to an equivalent quality standard. Brake pads/linings which have not been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which are not of an equivalent quality could affect your vehicle's operating safety. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use brake fluid that has been specially approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or which corresponds to an equivalent quality standard. Brake fluid which has not been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which is not of an equivalent quality could affect your vehicle's operating safety. All checks and maintenance work on the brake system must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Have brake pads installed and brake fluid replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. If your brake system is subject only to moderate loads, you should test the functionality of your brakes at regular intervals by pressing firmly on the brake pedal at high speeds. This improves the grip of the brake pads. You can find a description of Brake Assist (BAS) on (Y page 61).

High-performance brake system for AMG vehicles The high-performance brake system is only installed on the G 63 AMG and the G 65 AMG.

The high-performance brake system is designed for heavy loads. This may lead to noise when braking. This will depend on: RSpeed RBraking force REnvironmental conditions, such as temperature and humidity

The wear of individual components of the brake system, such as the brake pads/linings or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions. For this reason, it is impossible to state a mileage that will be valid under all circumstances. An aggressive driving style will lead to high wear. You can obtain further information about this from your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. New and replaced brake pads and discs only reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometers of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the brake pedal. Keep this in mind, and adapt your driving and braking accordingly during this break-in period. Excessive heavy braking results in correspondingly high brake wear. Observe the brake system warning lamp in the instrument cluster and note any brake status messages in the multifunction display. For high-performance driving in particular, it is important to maintain and have the brake system checked regularly.

Parking brake

G WARNING If you must brake the vehicle with the parking brake, the braking distance is considerably longer and the wheels could lock. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents. Only use the parking brake to brake the vehicle when the service brake is faulty. Do not apply the parking brake too firmly. If the wheels lock, release the parking brake until the wheels begin turning again.

Driving tips 161

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

If you brake the vehicle with the parking brake, the brake lamps will not light up. If you drive on wet roads or dirt-covered surfaces, road salt and/or dirt could get into the parking brake. In order to prevent corrosion and a reduction in the braking power of the parking brake, observe the following: Rpull the parking brake upwards with the release button depressed from time to time before beginning the journey (Y page 157). Rdrive for approximately 110 yds (100 m) at a maximum speed of 12 mph (20 km/h).

Driving on wet roads

Hydroplaning If water has accumulated to a certain depth on the road surface, there is a danger of hydroplaning occurring, even if: Ryou drive at low speeds. Rthe tires have adequate tread depth. For this reason, in the event of heavy rain or in conditions in which hydroplaning may occur, you must drive in the following manner: Rlower your speed. Ravoid ruts. Rbrake carefully.

Driving on flooded roads ! Do not drive through flooded areas. Check the depth of anywater before driving through it. Drive slowly through standing water. Otherwise, water may enter the vehicle interior or the engine compartment. This can damage the electronic components in the engine or the automatic transmission. Water can also be drawn in by the engine's air suction nozzles and this can cause engine damage.

If you have to drive on stretches of road on which water has collected, please bear in mind that: Rthe maximum permissible still water depth depends on the vehicle equipment Ryou should drive no faster than at walking pace

Off-road fording ! Under no circumstances should you accelerate before entering the water. The bow wave could cause water to enter and damage the engine and other assemblies.

! Do not open any of the vehicle's doors while fording. Otherwise, water could get into the vehicle interior and damage the vehicle's electronics and interior equipment.

: Fording depth, 24 in (60 cm)

i You may only drive through fresh water. RObserve the safety notes (Y page 164) and the general notes (Y page 164) on off-road driving. REstablish how deep the water is and the characteristics of the body of water before fording. RSwitch off the air-conditioning system. RShift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 193). REngage the differential locks, if necessary (Y page 196). RRestrict the shift range to 1 or 2(Y page 150).

162 Driving tips Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

RAvoid high engine speeds. REnter and exit the water at a flat place and at a steady walking pace. RDrive slowly and at an even speed through the water. RDo not stop and do not switch off the engine. RWater offers a high degree of resistance, and the ground is slippery and in some cases unstable. Therefore, it is difficult and dangerous to pull away in the water. REnsure that a bow wave does not form as you drive. RClean any mud from the tire tread after fording. RApply the brakes to dry them after fording. Always observe the fording depth values (Y page 350).

Winter driving

General notes

G DANGER If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of fatal injury. If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area around the vehicle are clear of snow. To ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a window on the side of the vehicle that is not facing into the wind.

G WARNING If snow chains are installed to the front wheels, they may drag against the vehicle body or chassis components. This could cause damage to the vehicle or the tires. There is a risk of an accident.

To avoid hazardous situations: Rnever install snow chains to the front wheels Ralways install snow chains in pairs to the rear wheels.

Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified specialist workshop at the onset of winter. Observe the notes in the "Winter operation" section (Y page 314).

Driving with summer tires Observe the notes in the "Winter operation" section (Y page 314).

Slippery road surfaces

G WARNING If you shift down on a slippery road surface in an attempt to increase the engine's braking effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents. Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.

G WARNING The outside temperature indicator is not designed to serve as an ice-warning device and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The roadmay still be icy, especially in wooded areas or on bridges.

G WARNING If you activate the LOW off-road gear while driving on a slippery road surface, the wheels may lose traction: Rif you remove your foot from the accelerator pedal when driving Rif off road ABS intervenes when braking If the wheels lose traction. the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.

Driving tips 163

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Never activate the LOW off-road gear while driving on a slippery road surface.

Drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking maneuvers. Do not use cruise control. If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be stopped when moving at low speed: X Shift the transmission to position N. X Try to bring the vehicle under control using corrective steering. i For more information on driving with snow chains, see (Y page 315).

Off-road driving

Important safety notes

G WARNING Do not load items on the basic carrier bars. It may cause instability during somemaneuvers which could result in an accident. Drive slowly in unknown terrain. This will make it easier to recognize unexpected obstacles and avoid damage to the vehicle. To help avoid the vehicle rolling over, never turn it around on steep inclines. If the vehicle cannot complete the attempted climb, back it down in reverse gear. Do not drive along the side of a slope. The vehicle might otherwise rollover. If in doing so the vehicle begins to show a tendency to roll, immediately steer into a line of gravity (straight up or downhill). Never let the vehicle roll backwards in idle. You may lose control of the vehicle if you use only the service brake. For information on driving downhill, see "Driving downhill".

When driving off-road, sand, mud and water, possiblymixedwith oil, for example, could get into the brakes. This could result in a reduced braking effect or in total brake failure and also in increased wear and tear. The braking characteristics change depending on the

material ingressing the brakes. Clean the brakes after driving off-road. If you detect a reduced braking effect or grinding noises, have the brake system checked in a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible. Adapt your driving style to the different braking characteristics. Driving off-road increases the likelihood of damage to the vehicle, which, in turn, can lead to failure of the mechanical assembly or systems. Adapt your driving style to suit the terrain conditions. Drive carefully. Have damage to the vehicle rectified immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.

General notes

H Environmental note Protection of the environment is of primary importance. Treat nature with respect. Observe all prohibiting signs.

Read this section carefully before driving your vehicle off-road. Practice by driving overmore gentle off-road terrain first. Familiarize yourself with the characteristics of your vehicle and the gear shift operation before driving through difficult terrain. The following driving systems are specially adapted to off-road driving: R4ETS (Y page 62) RTransfer case (Y page 193) RDifferential locks (Y page 195) Observe the following notes: Rstop your vehicle and, if necessary, shift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 194) before driving off- road. RAMG vehicles: to shift the transfer case to LOW RANGE, deactivate the ECO start/ stop function (Y page 142). Rengage the differential locks, if necessary (Y page 196).

i ABS, 4ETS, ESP and BAS are deactivated when the differential locks are activated.

164 Driving tips Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

This allows the front wheels to lock briefly, so that these can dig into a loose surface. However, please note that locked wheels skid and can no longer steer. RCheck that items of luggage and loads are stowed safely and are well secured (Y page 261). RTo avoid damaging the vehicle, make sure there is always sufficient ground clearance. RAlways keep the engine running and in gear when driving on a downhill gradient. RAlways keep the engine running and in gear when driving on a slope. RDrive slowly and evenly, if necessary at a walking pace. REnsure that the wheels are in contact with the ground at all times. RDrive with extreme care on unfamiliar off- road routes where visibility is poor. For safety reasons, get out of the vehicle first and survey the off-road route. RCheck the depth of water before fording rivers and streams. RWhen fording, do not stop and do not switch off the engine. RLook out for obstacles, such as rocks, holes, tree stumps and furrows. RAlways keep the doors, rear door, side windows and the sliding sunroof closed while the vehicle is in motion. RSwitch off cruise control. RDo not stray from marked routes or paths. RAdapt your speed to the terrain. The rougher, steeper or more ruts on the terrain, the slower your speed should be. RDrive slowly and at an even speed through the water. Ensure that a bowwave does not form as you drive. ROn sand, drive quickly to overcome the rolling resistance. Otherwise the vehicle's wheels could become stuck in loose ground. RDo not jump with the vehicle as this will interrupt the vehicle's propulsion.

RAvoid high engine speeds. Drive at appropriate engine speeds (maximum 3,000 rpm). RDo not shift the automatic transmission to transmission position N. RAlways check the vehicle for damage after off-road driving.

i Information about retrofitting special all- terrain tires is available from any qualified specialist workshop.

i Do not use the HOLD function when driving off-road, on steep uphill or downhill gradients or on slippery or loose surfaces. The HOLD function cannot hold the vehicle on such surfaces.

Checklist before driving off-road ! If the engine oil warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion, stop the vehicle in a safe place as soon as possible. Check the engine oil level. The engine oil warning lampwarningmust not be ignored. Continuing the journey while the symbol is displayed could lead to engine damage.

X Engine oil level: check the engine oil level and add oil if necessary. Only then does the engine receive enough oil when the vehicle is standing on a steep incline.

X Tire-changing tool kit: check that the jack is working and make sure you have the lug wrench, a robust tow cable and a folding spade in the vehicle.

X Wheels and tires: check the tire tread depth and tire pressure.

X Check for damage and remove any foreign objects, e.g. small stones, from the wheels/tires.

X Replace any missing valve caps. X Replace dented or damaged wheels. X Carry a sound spare wheel.

Driving tips 165

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Checklist after driving off-road Driving over rough terrain places greater demands on your vehicle than driving on normal roads. After driving off-road, check the vehicle. This allows you to detect damage promptly and reduce the risk of an accident to yourself and other road users. X Shift the transfer case to HIGH RANGE(Y page 194).

X Disengage the differential locks (Y page 198).

X Clean the headlamps and rear lights and check for damage.

X Clean the front and rear license plates. X Clean the wheels and tires with a water jet and remove any foreign objects.

X Clean thewheels, tires, wheel housings and the vehicle underside with a water jet; check for any foreign objects and damage.

X Check whether twigs or other parts of plants have become trapped. These increase the risk of fire and can damage fuel pipes, brake hoses or the rubber bellows of the axle joints and propeller shafts.

X After the trip, examine without fail the entire undercarriage, wheels, tires, brakes, bodywork structure, steering, chassis and exhaust system for damage.

X After driving for extended periods across sand, mud, gravel, water or in similarly dirty conditions, have the brake discs, wheels, brake pads/linings and axle joints checked and cleaned.

X If you notice strong vibrations after off-road driving, check for foreign objects in the wheels and drive train and, if necessary, remove them. Foreign objects can disturb the balance and cause vibrations.

X Test the brakes.

Driving on sand Observe the following rules when driving on sand: RShift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 194). RAvoid high engine speeds. RLimit the shift range of the automatic transmission according to the off-road conditions. RDrive quickly to overcome the rolling resistance. Otherwise the vehicle's wheels could become stuck in loose ground. RDrive in the tracks of other vehicles if possible. When doing so, make sure that: - the tire ruts are not too deep. - the sand is sufficiently firm. - your vehicle has sufficient ground clearance

Tire ruts and gravel roads ! Check that the ruts are not too deep and that your vehicle has sufficient clearance. Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged or bottom out and get stuck.

Observe the following rules when driving along ruts in off-road terrain or on roads with loose gravel: RShift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 194). RAvoid high engine speeds. RObserve the safety notes (Y page 164) and the general notes (Y page 164) on off-road driving. RRestrict the shift range of the automatic transmission to 1(Y page 150). RDrive slowly. RWhere ruts are too deep, drive with the wheels of one side on the center grassy area, if possible.

166 Driving tips Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Driving over obstacles ! Obstacles could damage the floor of the vehicle or components of the chassis. Ask passengers for guidance when driving over large obstacles. The passenger should always keep a safe distance from the vehicle when doing so in order to avoid injury as a result of unexpected vehicle movements. After driving off-road or over obstacles, check the vehicle for possible damage, especially to the underbody and the components of the chassis.

! Drive with particular care when driving over an obstacle while driving up or down a steep slope. The vehicle could otherwise tilt and slide sideways or tip over.

Observe the following rules when driving over tree stumps, large stones and other obstacles: RObserve the safety notes (Y page 164) and the general notes (Y page 164) on off-road driving. RShift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 194). RAvoid high engine speeds. RRestrict the shift range to 1(Y page 150). RMake sure that you have enough ground clearance before driving across an obstacle. RDrive very slowly. RTry to drive straight over the center of obstacles: front wheel first, then rear wheel.

Traveling uphill

Approach/departure angle

G WARNING If you drive on a steep incline at an angle or turn when driving on an incline, the vehicle could slip sideways, tip and rollover. There is a risk of an accident. Always drive on a steep incline in the line of fall (straight up or down) and do not turn the vehicle.

i Always observe the approach/departure angle values (Y page 351). RObserve the safety notes (Y page 164) and the general notes (Y page 164) on off-road driving. RDo not drive at an angle on slopes, inclines or gradients, but instead follow the direct line of fall. Note that the climbing ability of your vehicle depends on the terrain conditions. RBefore driving on extreme uphill and downhill gradients, shift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 194). REngage the differential locks, if necessary (Y page 196). RDrive slowly. RAccelerate gently and make sure that the wheels are gripping. RAvoid high engine speeds, except when driving on sandy and muddy routes with high driving resistance.

Driving tips 167

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

RAvoid high engine speeds drive at an appropriate engine speed (maximum 3,000 rpm). RWhen driving down an incline, make use of the engine's braking effect. Observe the engine speed; do not overrev the engine.

i Further information on the maximum engine speed: (Y page 206). RSelect a shift range appropriate to the gradient. RBefore tackling steep downhill gradients, select shift range 1(Y page 150). RAlways check the brakes after driving off- road.

i Hill start assist will aid you when pulling away on a hill. For more information, see "Hill start assist" (Y page 141).

Maximum gradient-climbing capability Accelerate carefully and make sure that the wheels do not spin when driving on steep terrain.

i If the load on the front axle is reduced when pulling away on a steep uphill slope, the front wheels have a tendency to spin. 4ETS detects this and brakes the wheels accordingly. The rear wheel torque is increased, making it easier to drive off.

Always observe the maximum gradient climbing ability values (Y page 351).

Hilltops When driving on an uphill gradient, reduce pressure slightly on the accelerator immediately before reaching the top of the hill (do not shift the transmission to position N). Use the vehicle's own impetus to drive over the top of the hill.

This style of driving prevents: Rthe vehicle from lifting off the ground on the brow of a hill Rloss of traction Rthe vehicle from traveling too quickly down the other side

Driving downhill RBefore tackling steep downhill gradients, select shift range 1(Y page 150). This way you use the engine's braking effect to reduce the speed. If this is not sufficient, brake gently. When doing so, make sure that the vehicle is facing in the direction of the line of fall. RObserve the notes on driving in mountainous terrain (Y page 168). RDrive slowly. RDo not drive at an angle down steep inclines. Steer into the line of fall and drive with the front wheels aligned straight. Otherwise, the vehicle could slip sideways, tip and roll over. RCheck that the brakes areworking normally after a long downhill stretch.

i The special off-road ABS setting (Y page 61) enables repeated, brief, precise locking of the front wheels, which leads to the wheels digging into the loose ground. Note that when the front wheels are fully braked, they slide easily over the surface of the ground, making it difficult to steer.

Driving systems

Cruise Control

Important safety notes

G WARNING The brake pedal moves when cruise control brakes the vehicle. A foot in the area under the brake pedal could become trapped. The movement of the pedal, and therefore the

168 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

vehicle's ability to brake, may be restricted by objects in the area under the brake. There is a risk of an accident and injury. Do not place your foot under the brake pedal. Keep the area under the brake pedal free from obstructions.

If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise control can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. Cruise control cannot take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. Cruise control is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and for braking in good time. Adjust your driving style to the traffic conditions. Only engage cruise control when the current road, weather and traffic conditions permit it to be done safely. Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance to the vehicle in front. Do not use cruise control: Rin traffic conditions that do not allow you to drive at a constant speed, e.g. heavy traffic, on winding roads or off-road Ron slippery road surfaces. Braking or accelerating could cause the drive wheels to lose traction and the vehicle could then skid Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or snow

General notes Cruise control maintains a constant road speed for you. On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden, you must select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will make use of the braking effect of the engine, which relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a steady speed for a prolonged period. You can

store any road speed above 20 mph (30 km/h).

i Cruise control should not be activated during off-road driving.

Cruise control lever

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

You can operate cruise control and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever. When you activate cruise control, the stored speed is shown in the multifunction display for five seconds. The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control lever indicates which system you have selected: RLIM indicator lamp off: cruise control is selected. RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.

Driving systems 169

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Activation conditions To activate cruise control, all of the following activation conditions must be fulfilled: Rthe parking brake must be released. Ryou are driving faster than 20 mph (30 km/h). RESP must be active, but not intervening. Rthe transmission must be in position D.

Selecting cruise control

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control X Checkwhether LIM indicator lamp; is off. If it is off, cruise control is already selected. If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the direction of arrowA. LIM indicator lamp; in the cruise control lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.

Storing and maintaining the current speed

Storing and maintaining

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

You can store the current speed if you are driving faster than 20 mph (30 km/h). X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed.

X Briefly press the cruise control lever up: or down?.

X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. Cruise control is activated. The vehicle automatically maintains the stored speed.

i Cruise control may be unable to maintain the stored speed on uphill and downhill gradients. The stored speed is resumed when the gradient levels out. Cruise control maintains the stored speed on downhill gradients by automatically applying the brakes.

Calling up the last speed stored G WARNING If you call up the stored speed and it is lower than the current speed, the vehicle

170 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident. Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you do not know the stored speed, store the desired speed again.

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you=.

X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. Cruise control is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last speed stored.

i If no speed is stored, cruise control stores the current speed and maintains it.

Calling up the last speed stored

Storing and maintaining

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

You can store the current speed if you are driving faster than 20 mph (30 km/h). X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed.

X Briefly press the cruise control lever up: or down?.

X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. Cruise control is activated. The vehicle automatically maintains the stored speed.

i Cruise control may be unable to maintain the stored speed on uphill and downhill gradients. The stored speed is resumed when the gradient levels out. Cruise control maintains the stored speed on downhill gradients by automatically applying the brakes.

Calling up the last speed stored G WARNING If you call up the stored speed and it is lower than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored

Driving systems 171

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

speed, the vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident. Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you do not know the stored speed, store the desired speed again.

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you=.

X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. Cruise control is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last speed stored.

i If no speed is stored, cruise control stores the current speed and maintains it.

Setting a speed

Adjusting

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

Keep in mind that it may take a brief moment until the vehicle accelerates or decelerates to the set speed. X To increase the speed: press the cruise control lever up:.

X To decrease the speed: press the cruise control lever down?.

X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until the desired speed is reached.

X Release the cruise control lever. The new speed is stored.

172 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Making adjustments in 1mph increments (1 km/h increments in Canada)

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control X Briefly press the cruise control lever up: for a higher speed or down? for a lower speed. The last speed stored is increased or reduced.

Adjusting in 5 mph increments (10 km/h increments):

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed

A To switch between cruise control and variable SPEEDTRONIC

B To deactivate cruise control X Briefly press the cruise control lever up: or down? to beyond the pressure point. The last speed stored is increased or reduced.

i Cruise control is not deactivated if you depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake, cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.

Deactivating cruise control

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

There are several ways to deactivate cruise control: X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwardsB.

or X Brake.

Driving systems 173

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

or X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the direction of arrowA. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM indicator lamp; in the cruise control lever lights up.

Cruise control is automatically deactivated if: Ryou apply the parking brake Ryou are driving at less than 20 mph (30 km/h) RESP intervenes or you deactivate ESP Ryou shift the transmission to position N while driving

i The last speed stored is cleared when you switch off the engine.

SPEEDTRONIC

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving, the braking system can overheat. This increases the stopping distance and can even cause the braking system to fail. There is a risk of an accident. Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Never depress the brake pedal and the accelerator pedal at the same time.

! Depressing the brake pedal constantly results in excessive and premature wear to the brake pads.

If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. SPEEDTRONIC cannot take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time and for staying in lane. Only engage SPEEDTRONIC when the current road, weather and traffic conditions permit it to be

done safely. Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance to the vehicle in front.

General notes SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that you do not exceed the set speed. On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer, you must select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will make use of the braking effect of the engine, which relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need additional braking, depress the brake pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.

i The speed indicated in the speedometer may differ slightly from the limit speed stored.

Cruise control lever

: To store the current speed or a higher speed

; LIM indicator lamp = To call up the last speed stored ? To store the current speed or a lower

speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC

You can operate cruise control and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.

174 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control lever indicates which system you have selected: RLIM indicator lamp off: cruise control is selected. RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.

You can use the cruise control lever to limit the speed to any speed above 30 km/hwhile the engine is running.

Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. SPEEDTRONIC cannot take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time and for staying in lane. Only engage SPEEDTRONIC when the current road, weather and traffic conditions permit it to be done safely. Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance to the vehicle in front. X Checkwhether LIM indicator lamp; is on.

If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already selected. If it is not, press the cruise control lever in the direction of arrowA. LIM indicator lamp; in the cruise control lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.

Storing the current speed

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

You can use the cruise control lever to limit the speed to any speed above 18 mph while the engine is running. X Briefly press the cruise control lever up: or down?. The current speed is stored and shown in the multifunction display.

i On downhill gradients, the speed can be exceeded despite variable SPEEDTRONIC. In this case, you will hear a warning tone and the Limit Exceeded message will appear in the multifunction display. If necessary, apply the brakes yourself.

Driving systems 175

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Calling up the last speed stored

Calling up the last speed stored

: To activate or increase speed ; LIM indicator lamp = To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed ? To activate or reduce speed A To switch between cruise control and

variable SPEEDTRONIC B To deactivate cruise control

If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. SPEEDTRONIC cannot take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time and for staying in your lane. Only engage SPEEDTRONIC when the current road, weather and traffic conditions permit it to be done safely. Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance to the vehicle in front. X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you=.

i If you call up the stored speed and your current speed is higher, you will hear a warning tone. The Limit Exceeded message appears in the multifunction display.

i If no speed is stored, variable SPEEDTRONIC stores the current speed and maintains it.

Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC

There are several ways to deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC: X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwardsB.

or X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the direction of arrowA. LIM indicator lamp; in the cruise control lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated. Cruise control is selected.

It is not possible to deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC by braking. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated automatically when you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown), but only if your current speed does not differ by more than 12mph from the stored speed.

DISTRONIC PLUS

Important safety notes

G WARNING DISTRONIC PLUS does not react to: Rpeople or animals Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stopped or parked vehicles Roncoming and crossing traffic

176 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

As a result, DISTRONIC PLUSmay neither give warnings nor intervene in such situations. There is a risk of an accident. Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.

G WARNING DISTRONIC PLUS cannot always clearly identify other road users and complex traffic situations. In such cases, DISTRONIC PLUS may: Rgive an unnecessary warning and then brake the vehicle Rneither give a warning nor intervene Raccelerate unexpectedly There is a risk of an accident. Continue to drive carefully and be ready to brake, in particular when warned to do so by DISTRONIC PLUS.

G WARNING DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle with up to 40% of the maximum braking force. If this braking force is insufficient, DISTRONIC PLUS warns you visually and audibly. There is a risk of an accident. In such cases, apply the brakes yourself and try to take evasive action.

G WARNING If you call up the stored speed and it differs from the current speed, the vehicle accelerates or decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the vehicle could accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident. Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you do not know the stored speed, store the desired speed again.

If you fail to adapt your driving style, DISTRONIC PLUS can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of

road, weather and traffic conditions. DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time and for staying in lane. Only engage DISTRONIC PLUS when the current road, weather and traffic conditions permit it to be done safely, and adapt your driving style accordingly. Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance to the vehicle in front. If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a risk of collision but cannot sufficiently decelerate the vehicle in order to maintain the set distance, you will be warned visually and acoustically. DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision without your intervention. An intermittent warning tonewill then sound and the distance warning lamp will light up in the instrument cluster. Brake immediately in order to increase the distance from the vehicle in front, or take evasive action, provided it is safe to do so. DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or vehicles driving on a different line. Therefore, always pay attention to traffic conditions even when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Otherwise, you may fail to recognize dangers in time, cause an accident and injure yourself and others. In particular, the detection of obstacles can be impaired if there is: Rthe sensor is dirty or covered Rsnow or heavy rain Rinterference by other radar sources Rthere is the possibility of strong radar reflections, for example, in parking garages.

If DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. This can happen unexpectedly, especially when towing or in a car wash. There is a risk of an accident. In these or similar situations, deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS. If you want DISTRONIC PLUS to assist you, the following activation conditions must be

Driving systems 177

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

fulfilled (Y page 179) and the radar sensor system must be operational.

General notes DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes automatically so that the set speed is not exceeded. On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer, you must select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will make use of the braking effect of the engine, which relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a slower-moving vehicle in front, your vehicle is braked in order to maintain the preset distance to the vehicle in front. If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC PLUS operates in the same way as cruise control in the speed range between 20 mph (Canada: 30 km/h) and120 mph (Canada: 200 km/h). If a vehicle is driving in front of you, it operates in the speed range between 0 mph (0 km/h) and 120 mph (Canada: 200 km/h). Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on roads with steep gradients. As DISTRONIC PLUS transmits radar waves, it can resemble the radar detectors of the responsible authorities. You can refer to the relevant chapter in the Operator's Manual if questions are asked about this.

i USA only: This device has been approved by the FCC as a Vehicular Radar System. The radar sensor is intended for use in an automotive radar system only. Removal, tampering, or altering of the device will void any warranties, and is not permitted by the FCC. Do not tamper with, alter, or use in any non-approved way.

Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

i Canada only: This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Removal, tampering, or altering of the device will void any warranties, and is not permitted. Do not tamper with, alter, or use the device in any non-approved way. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Cruise control lever

: To activate or increase speed ; To set the specified minimum distance = LIM indicator lamp ? To activate at the current speed/last

stored speed A To activate or reduce speed B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and

variable SPEEDTRONIC C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS

With the cruise control lever, you can operate DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.

178 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

X To switch between variable SPEEDTRONIC and DISTRONIC PLUS: press the cruise control lever in the direction of arrowB.

LIM indicator lamp= on the cruise control lever indicates which function you have selected: RLIM indicator lamp= off: DISTRONIC PLUS is selected. RLIM indicator lamp= on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.

Activating DISTRONIC PLUS

Activation conditions In order to activate DISTRONIC PLUS, the following conditions must be fulfilled: Rthe engine must be started. It may take up to two minutes after pulling away before DISTRONIC PLUS is operational. Rthe parking brake must be released. Rthe differential lock must be deactivated. RESP must be active, but not intervening. Rthe transmission must be in position D. Rthe driver's door must be closed when you shift from P to D or your seat belt must be fastened. Rthe front-passenger door and rear doors must be closed. Rthe vehicle must not skid. Rthe DISTRONIC PLUS function must be selected (Y page 178). Rthe transfer case must be in the HIGH RANGE transmission position. Rthe vehicle must not be on an uphill or downhill gradient of more than 22-25%. Rthe radar sensor must be free from dirt (Y page 291).

Activating while driving

When driving at speeds below 20 mph (30 km/h) you can activate DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle in front has been detected and is shown in the multifunction display. If the vehicle in front is no longer detected and displayed, DISTRONIC PLUS switches off and a tone sounds. X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you?, or press it up: or downA. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.

X Press the cruise control lever up: or downA repeatedly until the desired speed is set.

X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the vehicle in front, but only up to the desired stored speed.

i If you do not fully release the accelerator pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS Passive message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower- moving vehicle in front will then not be maintained. You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator pedal.

Driving systems 179

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Switching on while stationary This function may be useful if you want to keep up with the traffic flow, e.g. at the end of a tailback. You can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS if: Rthe vehicle in front and Ryour vehicle are stationary X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you?, or press it up: or downA. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected. i DISTRONIC PLUS can be activated at a standstill at under 20 mph (30 km/h) only if a vehicle in front has been detected. Therefore, the DISTRONIC PLUS distance display in the instrument cluster should be activated (Y page 213).

X Keep the cruise control lever pressed up: or downA until the desired speed is set. i You can use the cruise control lever to set the stored speed and the control on the cruise control lever to set the specified minimum distance (Y page 183).

Activating at the current speed/last stored speed G WARNING If you call up the stored speed and it differs from the current speed, the vehicle accelerates or decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the vehicle could accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident. Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you do not know the stored speed, store the desired speed again.

X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you?.

X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first time it is activated, the current speed is

stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise speed to the previously stored value.

Driving with DISTRONIC PLUS

Pulling away and driving

X If the vehicle in front pulls away: remove your foot from the brake pedal.

X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you?, or press it up: or downA.

or X Accelerate briefly. Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its speed to that of the vehicle in front.

If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC PLUS operates in the same way as cruise control. If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle. In this way, the distance you have selected is maintained. If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in front is driving faster, it accelerates your vehicle, but only up to the speed you have stored. If you depress the brake, DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated unless your vehicle is stationary.

180 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Changing lanes If you change to the passing lane, DISTRONIC PLUS supports you when: Ryou are driving faster than 40 mph (60 km/h). RDISTRONIC PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front. Ryou switch on the appropriate turn signal. RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger of collision.

If these conditions are fulfilled, your vehicle is accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in front becomes too small.

i When changing lanes, DISTRONIC PLUS monitors the left lane on left-hand drive vehicles and the right lane on right-hand drive vehicles.

Stopping G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, even if it is braked only by DISTRONIC PLUS, it could roll away if: Rthere is a malfunction in the system or in the voltage supply. RDISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated with the cruise control lever, e.g. by a vehicle occupant or from outside the vehicle. Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have been tampered with. Rthe battery is disconnected. Rthe accelerator pedal has been depressed, e.g. by a vehicle occupant.

There is a risk of an accident. If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the vehicle against rolling away.

If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until it is stationary.

Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains stationary and you do not need to depress the brake.

i Depending on the specified minimum distance, your vehicle will come to a standstill at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in front. The specified minimum distance is set using the control on the cruise control lever.

On steep uphill or downhill inclines or if there is a malfunction, the transmission may also automatically be shifted into position P.

Displays in the instrument cluster

Displays in the speedometer

Example: DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the speedometer

When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or two segments; in the set speed range light up. If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front, segments; between speed of the vehicle in front: and stored speed= light up.

i For design reasons, the speed displayed in the speedometer may differ slightly from the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.

Driving systems 181

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated

Distance display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated : Vehicle in front, if detected ; Distance indicator, current distance to

the vehicle in front = Specified minimum distance to the

vehicle in front; adjustable ? Own vehicle

You can select the distance display in the Assistance menu (Y page 213) of the on- board computer. X Select the Distance Display function using the on-board computer.

Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated

Distance display with DISTRONIC PLUS activated in the multifunction display : DISTRONIC PLUS activated ; Own vehicle

= Specified minimum distance to the vehicle in front; adjustable

? Vehicle in front, if detected

In the Assistance menu (Y page 213) of the on-board computer, you can select the distance display. X Select the Distance Display function using the on-board computer (Y page 213).

You will see the stored speed for about five secondswhen you activateDISTRONICPLUS.

Setting a speed

: To store the current speed or a higher speed

; To store the current speed or a lower speed

X Press the cruise control lever up: for a higher speed or down; for a lower speed.

X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until the desired speed is reached.

X Release the cruise control lever. The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed to the new speed stored.

X To adjust the set speed in 1 mph increments (1 km/h increments): briefly

182 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

press the cruise control lever up: or down; to the pressure point. Every time the cruise control lever is pressed up: or down; the last speed stored is increased or reduced.

X To adjust the set speed in 5 mph increments (10 km/h increments): briefly press the cruise control lever up: or down; to the pressure point. Every time the cruise control lever is pressed up: or down;, the last speed stored is increased or reduced.

i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.

Setting the specifiedminimumdistance

You can set the specified minimum distance for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that DISTRONIC PLUS keeps to the vehicle in front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can see this distance in the multifunction display (Y page 213).

X To increase: turn control= in direction;. DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in front.

X To decrease: turn control= in direction:. DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in front.

i Make sure that you maintain the minimum distance to the vehicle in front as required by law. Adjust the distance to the vehicle in front if necessary.

Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS

There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS: X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards:.

or X Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary. or X Briefly press the cruise control lever in the direction of arrow=. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM indicator lamp; in the cruise control lever lights up.

When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you will see the DISTRONIC PLUS Off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.

Driving systems 183

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

i The last speed stored remains stored until you switch off the engine.

DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if: Ryou engage the parking brake. Ryou are driving more slowly than 15 mph (25 km/h) and there is no longer a vehicle in front, or if the vehicle in front is no longer detected. RESP intervenes or you deactivate ESP. Rthe transmission is in theP,R orN position. Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards you in order to pull away and the front- passenger door or one of the rear doors is open. Rthe vehicle has skidded. If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will hear a warning tone. You will see the DISTRONIC PLUS Off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds. In the Assistance menu (Y page 213) of the on-board computer, you can select the distance display.

Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS

General notes The following contains descriptions of certain road and traffic conditions in which you must be particularly attentive. In such situations, brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then deactivated.

Cornering, going into and coming out of a bend

The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle may brake unexpectedly or late.

Vehicles traveling on a different line

DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles traveling on a different line. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.

Other vehicles changing lanes

184 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle will be too short.

Narrow vehicles

DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the vehicle in front on the edge of the road, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.

Obstructions and stationary vehicles

DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC PLUS will not brake for these.

Crossing vehicles

DISTRONIC PLUS may detect vehicles that are crossing your lane by mistake. Activating DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with crossing traffic, for example, could cause your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.

Blind Spot Assist

Important safety notes

G WARNING Blind Spot Assist does not react to: Rvehicles overtaken too closely on the side, placing them in the blind spot area Rvehicles approaching and driving by with a speed difference of more than approximately 11 km/h

As a result, Blind Spot Assist may not give warnings in such situations. There is a risk of an accident. Always observe the traffic conditions carefully, andmaintain a safe lateral distance.

G WARNING Blind Spot Assist does not react to: Rvehicles overtaken too closely on the side, placing them in the blind spot area Rvehicles approaching and driving by with a speed difference of more than 6.8 mph (11 km/h)

As a result, Blind Spot Assist may not give warnings in such situations. There is a risk of an accident.

Driving systems 185

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Always observe the traffic conditions carefully, andmaintain a safe lateral distance.

Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to detect some vehicles and is no substitute for attentive driving. In particular, the detection of obstacles can be impaired if there is: Rdirt on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors. Rvisibility is poor, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or snow. Rthere is a narrow vehicle traveling in front, e.g. a motorcycle or bicycle. Rthe road has very wide lanes. Rthe road has narrow lanes. Ryou are not driving in themiddle of the lane. Rthere are barriers or other road boundaries.

i USA only: This device has been approved by the FCC as a Vehicular Radar System. The radar sensor is intended for use in an automotive radar system only. Removal, tampering, or altering of the device will void any warranties, and is not permitted by the FCC. Do not tamper with, alter, or use in any non-approved way. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

General notes Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system tomonitor both the left and right sides of your vehicle. It supports you from a speed of approximately 20 mph (30 km/h). A warning display in the exterior mirrors draws your attention to vehicles detected in the monitored area. If you then switch on the corresponding turn signal to change lane, you will also receive an optical and audible collision warning. For this purpose, Blind Spot Assist uses sensors in the rear bumper.

Monitoring range of the sensors

Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to 10 ft (3 m) behind your vehicle and directly next to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram. If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not driving in the middle of their lane. This may be the case if the vehicles are driving on the inner side of their lane. Due to the nature of the system: Rwarnings may be issued in error when driving close to crash barriers or similar solid lane borders. Rthe warning is canceled when driving for an extended period next to long vehicles, such as trucks.

The two sensors for Blind Spot Assist are integrated into the sides of the rear bumper. Make sure that the bumper is free from dirt, ice or slush around the sensors. The rear sensors must not be covered, for example by bicycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a severe impact or in the event of damage to the bumpers, have the function of the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise not work properly.

186 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Indicator and warning display

G WARNING Blind Spot Assist does not react to: Rvehicles overtaken too closely on the side, placing them in the blind spot area Rvehicles approaching and driving by with a speed difference of more than 6.8 mph (11 km/h)

As a result, Blind Spot Assist may not give warnings in such situations. There is a risk of an accident. Always observe the traffic conditions carefully, andmaintain a safe lateral distance.

: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp

When Active Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator lamp: in the exteriormirrors lights up yellow at speeds of up to 20 mph(30 km/h). At speeds above 20 mph (30 km/h) the indicator lamp goes out and Blind Spot Assist is operational. If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above 20 mph (30 km/h), warning lamp: on the corresponding side lights up red. Thiswarning is always emitted when a vehicle enters the blind spot monitoring range from behind or from the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the warning only occurs if the difference in speed is less than 7 mph (12 km/h). The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse gear is engaged. In this event, Blind Spot Assist is no longer active.

The brightness of the indicator/warning lamps is adjusted automatically according to the ambient light.

Collision warning

: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp

If a vehicle is detected in themonitoring range of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the corresponding turn signal, a double warning tone sounds. Red warning lamp: flashes. If the turn signal remains on, vehicles detected are indicated by the flashing of red warning lamp:. There are no further warning tones.

Switching on Blind Spot Assist

: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp

Driving systems 187

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

X Make sure that Blind Spot Assist is activated in the on-board computer (Y page 213).

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock. Warning lamps: in the exterior mirrors light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds and then turn yellow.

HOLD function

General notes The HOLD function can assist the driver in the following situations: Rwhen pulling away, especially on steep slopes Rwhen maneuvering on steep slopes Rwhen waiting in traffic The vehicle is kept stationary without the driver having to depress the brake pedal. The braking effect is canceled and the HOLD function deactivated when you depress the accelerator pedal to pull away.

i Do not use the HOLD function when driving off-road, on steep uphill or downhill gradients or on slippery or loose surfaces. The HOLD function cannot hold the vehicle on such surfaces.

Activation conditions You can activate the HOLD function if: Rthe vehicle is stationary. Rthe engine is running or it has been switched off by the ECO start/stop function (AMG vehicles). Rthe engine is running. Rthe driver's door is closed or your seat belt is fastened. Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N. RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.

Activating the HOLD function The vehicle's brakes are applied when the HOLD function is activated. For this reason, deactivate the HOLD function while in the car wash or while towing. X Make sure that the activation conditions are met.

X Depress the brake pedal. X Quickly depress the brake pedal further until appears in the multifunction display. The HOLD function is activated. You can release the brake pedal.

i If depressing the brake pedal the first time does not activate the HOLD function, wait briefly and then try again.

Deactivating the HOLD function

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away despite being braked by the HOLD function if: Rthere is a malfunction in the system or in the voltage supply. Rthe HOLD function has been deactivated by pressing the accelerator pedal or the brake pedal, e.g. by a vehicle occupant. Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have been tampered with. Rthe battery is disconnected There is a risk of an accident. If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off the HOLD function and secure the vehicle against rolling away.

The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if: Ryou accelerate and the transmission is in position D or R. Ryou shift the transmission to position P.

188 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Ryou depress the brake pedal again with a certain amount of pressure until disappears from the multifunction display. Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS. On steep uphill or downhill gradients or if there is a malfunction, the transmission may also be automatically shifted into position P.

4MATIC (permanent four-wheel drive) ! Never tow the vehicle with one axle raised. This may damage the transfer case. Damage of this sort is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. All wheels must remain either on the ground or be fully raised. Observe the instructions for towing the vehicle with all wheels in full contact with the ground.

! When testing the parking brake, operate the vehicle only briefly (for a maximum of ten seconds) on a brake test dynamometer. When doing this, turn the SmartKey to position 0 or 1 in the ignition. Failure to do this can cause damage to the drive train or the brake system.

! A function or performance test should only be carried out on a two-axle dynamometer. Before you operate the vehicle on such a dynamometer, please consult a qualified workshop. You could otherwise damage the drive train or the brake system.

4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are permanently driven. Together with ESP and 4ETS, it improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip. If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip: ROnly depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away. RAccelerate less when driving. If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot

take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. 4MATIC is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time and for staying in lane. Only engage 4MATIC when the current road, weather and traffic conditions permit it to be done safely, and adapt your driving style accordingly. Drive carefully and maintain a suitable distance to the vehicle in front.

i In wintry driving conditions, themaximum effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if you use winter tires (M+S tires), with snow chains if necessary.

For information about driving off-road, see (Y page 164).

PARKTRONIC

Important safety notes ! When parking, pay particular attention to objects above or below the sensors, such as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when they are in the immediate vicinity of the vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or the objects. The sensorsmay not detect snow and other objects that absorb ultrasonic waves. Ultrasonic sources such as an automatic car wash, the compressed-air brakes on a truck or a pneumatic drill could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction. PARKTRONICmay not function correctly on uneven terrain.

PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and audibly the distance between your vehicle and an object. PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a replacement for your attention to your immediate surroundings. You are always responsible for safe maneuvering, parking and exiting a parking space. Ensure that the areas in front, behind and to the side of the

Driving systems 189

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

vehicle are safe before maneuvering, parking or pulling away. There must not be any persons, animals or objects in the area in which you are maneuvering. PARKTRONIC does not take into account any persons or objects located below or above the detection range. As a result, PARKTRONIC cannot warn you about objects in this area. PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when you: Rswitch on the ignition Rshift the transmission to position D, R or N Rrelease the parking brake PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above 11 mph (18 km/h). It is reactivated at lower speeds. PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper and four sensors in the rear bumper.

Range of the sensors

General notes

: Example: sensors in the front bumper, left-hand side

Side view

Top view

The sensors must be free from dirt, ice or slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking care not to scratch or damage them (Y page 291).

Front sensors

Center Approximately 40 in (approximately 100 cm from brush guard)

Corners Approximately 24 in (approximately 60cm)

Rear sensors

Center Approximately 36 in (approximately 90 cm) from spare wheel

Corners Approximately 32 in (approximately 80 cm)

Minimum distance

Center Approximately 8 in (approximately 20 cm)

Corners Approximately 8 in (approximately 20 cm)

If there is an obstacle within this range, the relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below the minimum, the distance may no longer be shown.

190 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Warning displays

Warning display for the front area : Segments on the left-hand side of the

vehicle ; Segments on the right-hand side of the

vehicle = Segments showing operational readiness

The warning displays show the distance between the sensors and the obstacle. The warning display for the front area is located on the dashboard above the center air vents. The warning display for the rear area is located on the headliner in the rear compartment. The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow segments showing operational readiness= light up. The selected transmission position and the direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the engine is running.

Transmission position

Warning display

D Front area activated

R, N or the vehicle is rolling backwards

Rear and front areas activated

P No areas activated

One or more segments light up as the vehicle approaches an obstacle, depending on the vehicle's distance from the obstacle. From the: Rsixth segment onwards, you will hear an intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds. Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now reached the minimum distance.

Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC

: Indicator lamp ; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC

If indicator lamp: lights up, PARKTRONIC is deactivated.

i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated when you turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.

Towing a trailer PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area when you establish an electrical connection between your vehicle and a trailer.

Driving systems 191

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Problems with PARKTRONIC

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Only the red segments in the PARKTRONIC warning displays are lit. You also hear a warning tone for approximately two seconds. PARKTRONIC is deactivated after a few seconds, and the indicator lamp in the PARKTRONIC button lights up.

PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off. X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

Only the red segments in the PARKTRONIC warning displays are lit. PARKTRONIC is deactivated after a few seconds.

The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference. X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 291). X Switch the ignition back on.

The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or ultrasound waves. X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.

Rear view camera

Important safety notes The rear view camera is only an aid. It is not a replacement for your attention to your immediate surroundings. You are always responsible for safe maneuvering and parking. Whenmaneuvering or parking, make sure that there are no persons, animals or objects in the area in which you are maneuvering. Under the following circumstances, the rear view camera will not function, or will function in a limited manner: Rthe rear door is open Rin heavy rain, snow or fog Rat night or in very dark places Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light Rif the area is lit by fluorescent light or LED lighting (the display may flicker)

Rif there is a sudden change in temperature, e.g. when driving into a heated garage in winter Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this event, have the camera position and setting checked at a qualified specialist workshop Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose

192 Driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Activating/deactivating the rear view camera

: Rear view camera

X To activate:make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock.

X Make sure that the rear view camera function is selected in COMAND (see the separate operating instructions for COMAND).

X Engage reverse gear. The area behind the vehicle is shown with guide lines and "Reverse parking" function: in the COMAND display.

To deactivate: the rear view camera is deactivated if you: Rshift the transmission to position P Rdrive forward ten meters Rshift the transmission from R to another position after 15 seconds Rdrive forwards at a speed of over 5 mph (10 km/h)

Off-road driving systems

Transfer case

General notes The vehicle has permanent all-wheel drive. Power is always transmitted to both axles. For further information on driving off-road, see (Y page 164).

Shift ranges

G WARNING If you do not wait for the transfer case gear change process to complete, the transfer case could remain in the neutral position. The power transmission to the driven wheels is then interrupted. There is a danger of the vehicle rolling away unintentionally. There is a risk of an accident. Wait until the transfer case shift process is completed.

Donot turn off the enginewhile changing gear and do not shift the automatic transmission to another gear.

HIGH RANGE

Position for all normal on- road driving conditions

LOW RANGE

Low-range position for driving off-road. Also for use on steep uphill or downhill gradients, especially when towing a trailer. The vehicle travels around half the speed of on-road driving rangeHIGHRANGE. The tractive power is correspondingly higher.

Off-road driving systems 193

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Shifting the transfer case

Important safety notes G WARNING When the transfer case is in the neutral position, power transmission to the driven wheels is interrupted. As a result, the vehicle could roll away. There is a risk of an accident. Secure the vehiclewith the parking brake, and on uphill or downhill gradients, also secure it with a device such as a wheel chock.

Always wait for the gear change process from HIGH RANGE to LOW RANGE and from LOW RANGE to HIGH RANGE to complete. Do not turn off the enginewhile changing gear and do not shift the automatic transmission to another gear.

General notes

: Current shift range

: Indicator lamp ; LOW RANGE button

Switching on the off-road gear ratio ! Only carry out the gear selection if: Rthe engine is running. Rthe vehicle is rolling.

Rthe automatic transmission is in selector lever position N. Ryou are driving no faster than 25 mph (40 km/h).

You could otherwise damage the transfer case.

i AMG vehicles: to shift the transfer case to LOWRANGE, deactivate the ECO start/ stop function (Y page 142).

X Press LOW RANGE button;. When the shift procedure is complete, the LOW RANGE transfer case position appears in the multifunction display. Indicator lamp: lights up.

X Shift the transmission to position D.

Switching off the off-road gear ratio G WARNING When the transfer case is in the neutral position, power transmission to the driven wheels is interrupted. As a result, the vehicle could roll away. There is a risk of an accident. Secure the vehiclewith the parking brake, and on uphill or downhill gradients, also secure it with a device such as a wheel chock.

! Only carry out the gear selection if: Rthe engine is running. Rthe vehicle is rolling. Rthe automatic transmission is in selector lever position N. Ryou are driving no faster than 43 mph (70 km/h).

194 Off-road driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

You could otherwise damage the transfer case.

X Press button;. When the shift procedure is complete, the HIGH RANGE transfer case position appears in the multifunction display. Indicator lamp: goes out.

If the gear change is not completed, the following messages could appear in the display: RTC shift Conditions Not Fulfilled You have not met one or more shift conditions. RTC NEUTRAL On The transfer case has canceled the gear change process and is in N. Transfer case position N appears in the multifunction display. RTC shift Canceled The transfer case has not performed the gear change process.

X Carry out the gear change process again. Make sure to meet all conditions for changing gears. RTC Malfunction Visit Workshop There is a malfunction in the transfer case.

X Do not shift the transfer case. X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.

Shifting to neutral G WARNING When the transfer case is in the neutral position, power transmission to the driven wheels is interrupted. As a result, the vehicle could roll away. There is a risk of an accident. Secure the vehiclewith the parking brake, and on uphill or downhill gradients, also secure it with a device such as a wheel chock.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 139).

X Apply the parking brake.

X Depress the brake pedal. X Move the selector lever to position N(Y page 145).

X Press and hold LOW RANGE button; for approximately 10 seconds. When the shift procedure is complete, the TC In Neutral message appears in the multifunction display for 5 seconds.

If the gear change is not completed, the following messages could appear in the display (Y page 233).

i If the transfer case is in Neutral, the SmartKey is in the ignition lock and you open the driver's door, the TC In Neutral message appears in the multifunction display. If you then release the parking brake, a warning tone will sound.

Differential locks

General notes

G WARNING When the differential locks are engaged, ABS, 4ETS, ESP and BAS are deactivated. As a result, the wheels could lock when braking and the braking distance is increased. There is a risk of an accident. Disengage the differential locks immediately on firm surfaces with good grip.

! In order to avoid damage to the transfer case, you must operate the vehicle on a dynamometer (1-axle dynamometer) only if: Rthe axle not driven on is jacked up or Rthe corresponding propeller shaft is disconnected and the transfer case differential lock is engaged.

Otherwise, the transfer case can be damaged.

Off-road driving systems 195

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Differential locks improve the traction of the vehicle. Your vehicle is equipped with a differential lock each for: Rthe transfer case: this controls the balance between the front and rear axles. Rthe rear axle: this controls the balance between the wheels on the rear axle. Rthe front axle: this controls the balance between the wheels on the front axle.

Information on differential and differential locks When the vehicle drives around a curve, the wheels on the outside of the curvemust cover a greater distance. Therefore, the wheels turn more rapidly than on the inside. The differential, a transmission in the drive train, compensates for these different rotational speeds, making cornering possible. The disadvantage of a differential is thatmore power is transferred to the wheels that have the least grip. An example: a wheel of a driven axle is on a snow-covered surface and therefore does not have any traction. The differential causes this wheel to be subjected to the strongest driving force, as the flow of force takes the path of least resistance. The opposite wheel on this axle, however, which stands on firm ground and could therefore allow propulsion, receives no driving power. 4ETS compensates for this disadvantage. 4ETS provides good steerability by automatically braking the spinning wheel. 4ETS provides the wheel on the firm surface with more drive force, which in turn provides propulsion. ESP and 4ETS are traction systems that are ideal for road driving and suitable for light off- road driving. The LOW RANGE off-road gear also improves off-road capability. Moreover, the more difficult conditions in off- road driving require further measures such as locking one or several differentials. Your vehicle is equipped with three differential locks:

Ra central differential lock for the transfer case, Ra differential lock for the front axle and Ra differential lock for the rear axle. Each differential lock can be engagedwith the respective switch on the center console. If the transfer case differential is disabled, the front and rear wheels turn at the same speed. If the differential for the rear axle is locked, both rear wheels turn at the same speed, regardless of their individual torques. Please note that activating the differential locks severely restricts the vehicle's steerability. Please note that the functions of the differential are absolutely necessary for driving on paved roads. The differential locks must never be engaged when driving on paved roads. Otherwise, the vehicle may not be steerable and you could lose control of the vehicle. The differential locks must therefore only be engaged when driving off-road. You may only engage the differential locks if the functions of the 4ETS and ESP driving systems and the LOW RANGE off-road gear are insufficient.

i The differential locks are only available in the LOW RANGE off-road gear.

Engaging the differential locks

Important safety notes G WARNING When differential locks are engaged on a firm, high-grip surface, the vehicle's steerability is greatly impaired. In particular, engaging the differential locks when cornering could lead to you losing control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident. Disengage the differential locks immediately on firm surfaces with good grip.

G WARNING When the differential locks are engaged, ABS, 4ETS, ESP and BAS are deactivated. As a result, the wheels could lock when braking

196 Off-road driving systems Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

and the braking distance is increased. There is a risk of an accident. Disengage the differential locks immediately on firm surfaces with good grip.

! Only engage the differential locks when: Ryou are driving at walking pace. Rthe driven wheels are not spinning. Ryou are not driving on a firm road surface.

General notes The switches are located on the center console.

: Function indicator lamps (red) ; Differential lock for the front axle = Differential lock for the transfer case ? Differential lock for the rear axle A Activation indicator lamps (yellow)

Engage the differential locks: Roff-road Rto deactivate ABS, 4ETS, ESP and BAS while off-road Rwhen fording For further information on driving off-road, see (Y page 164).

i You can only engage the differential locks if the transfer case is in the LOW RANGE off-road driving position (Y page 193).

i You can activate the differential locks in the following order=,?,;.

Differential lock for the transfer case X To engage: switch the transfer case to the LOW RANGE off-road driving position (Y page 194).

X Press switch=. When the transfer case is in the LOW RANGE off-road driving position, the yellow activation indicator lamp below switch= lights up. The warning lamp in the instrument panel lights up. When the differential is locked, the red function indicator lamp above switch= lights up. In the multifunction display you see the: ABS not available Differential Locked message. The ! warning lamps in the instrument cluster light up. The differential lock for the transfer case is engaged. 4ETS, ESP, BAS and ABS are deactivated.

The vehicle's ability to steer is severely restricted. Drive carefully and accelerate gently for optimum traction.

i You can now engage the differential lock for rear axle? and the differential lock for front axle; as required.

Differential lock for the rear axle X To engage: press switch?. Yellow activation indicator lampA lights up first, followed by red function indicator lamp: of switch?. The differential lock for the rear axle is engaged.

Differential lock for the front axle X To engage: press switch;. First, the yellow activation indicator lamp lights up, followed by the red function indicator lamp.

Off-road driving systems 197

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

The differential lock for the front axle is engaged.

Disengaging the differential locks You can disengage the differential locks in the following order:;,?,=. X To simultaneously disengage all differential locks: press switch=. Yellow activation indicator lampsA and red function indicator lamps: go out. After approximately three seconds of normal driving, ABS, 4ETS, ESP and BAS are activated. The ABS not available Differential Locked message disappears in the multifunction display and the , ! and warning lamps in the instrument cluster go out.

X Shift the transfer case to the HIGH RANGE on-road position (Y page 194).

i If red function indicator lamps: do not go out after disengaging the differential locks, bring the vehicle to a standstill in accordance with the traffic conditions. Then continue driving, as the load change can release the differential locks.

Towing a trailer

Notes on towing a trailer

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving, the braking system can overheat. This increases the stopping distance and can even cause the braking system to fail. There is a risk of an accident. Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Never depress the brake pedal and the accelerator pedal at the same time.

G WARNING When the vehicle/trailer combination begins to lurch, you could lose control of it. The vehicle/trailer combination could even rollover. There is a risk of an accident. On no account should you attempt to straighten up the vehicle/trailer combination by increasing the speed. Reduce vehicle speed and do not countersteer. Apply the brake as necessary.

G WARNING If you install a ball coupling other than the one deliveredwith the vehicle, the trailer tow hitch and the rear axle may be overloaded. This applies especially if the ball coupling in question is longer or angled differently. This could seriously impair the driving characteristics and the trailer can come loose. There is a risk of an accident. Only install the ball coupling delivered with the vehicle or a ball coupling that is designed to meet your trailer towing requirements. Do not modify the ball coupling or the trailer tow hitch.

G WARNING If the ball coupling is not installed correctly or not secured with the bolt provided and the corresponding spring cotter, the trailer may come loose. There is a risk of an accident. Always install and secure the ball coupling as described. Before every journey, ensure that the ball coupling is secured with the bolt and the corresponding spring cotter.

Please observe the manufacturer's operating instructions for the trailer coupling if a detachable trailer coupling is used. You will find the applicable permissible values, which must not be exceeded, in the vehicle documents. You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the vehicle identification plates and those for the towing vehicle in the "Technical data" section (Y page 342).

198 Towing a trailer Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If you do not couple the trailer to the towing vehicle correctly, the trailer could become detached. Make sure that the following values are not exceeded: Rthe permissible trailer drawbar noseweight Rthe permissible trailer load Rthe permissible rear axle load of the towing vehicle Rthe maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of both the towing vehicle and the trailer

When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling characteristics will be different in comparison with when driving without a trailer. The vehicle/trailer combination: Ris heavier Ris restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability Rhas an increased braking distance Ris affected more by strong crosswinds Rdemands more sensitive steering Rhas a larger turning circle This could impair the handling characteristics. When towing a trailer, always adjust your speed to the current road and weather conditions. Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed for your vehicle/trailer combination.

General notes RDo not exceed the legally prescribed maximum speed for vehicle/trailer combinations in the relevant country. This lowers the risk of an accident. ROnly install an approved trailer coupling on your vehicle. Further information on availability and on installation is available from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

RThe bumpers of your vehicle are not suitable for installing detachable trailer couplings. RDo not install hired trailer couplings or other detachable trailer couplings on the bumpers of your vehicle. RIf you do not need the ball coupling, remove the ball coupling from the ball coupling recess. This reduces the risk of damage to the ball coupling.

i When towing a trailer, set the tire pressure on the rear axle of the towing vehicle for a maximum load; see the tire pressure table in the fuel filler flap (Y page 316).

Youwill find installation dimensions and loads in the technical data (Y page 351). The maximum noseweight of the trailer drawbar on the ball coupling for up to 3 people is 562 lbs (255 kg). The maximum permissible trailer drawbar noseweight for more than 3 persons and the maximum load in the trunk can be found in the trailer drawbar noseweight table (Y page 352). However, the actual noseweight must not exceed the value given on the trailer tow hitch or trailer identification plates. The lowest weight applies.

i When towing a trailer, set the tire pressure on the rear axle of the towing vehicle for a maximum load; see the tire pressure table in the fuel filler flap (Y page 316).

Please note that when towing a trailer, PARKTRONIC (Y page 189) and Blind Spot Assist (Y page 185) are only available with limitations, or not at all.

i On vehicles without level control, the height of the ball coupling will alter according to the load placed on the vehicle. If necessary, use a trailer with a height- adjustable drawbar.

Towing a trailer 199

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

Driving tips X On long and steep downhill gradients, select shift range 1, 2 or 3 (Y page 150) in good time. i This also applies if you have activated cruise control or SPEEDTRONIC.

X If necessary, shift the transfer case to LOW RANGE(Y page 194). This will use the braking effect of the engine, so that less braking will be required to maintain the speed. This relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need additional braking, depress the brake pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.

The maximum permissible speed for vehicle/ trailer combinations depends on the type of trailer. Before beginning the journey, check the trailer's documents to see what the maximum permissible speed is. Observe the legally prescribed maximum speed in the relevant country. For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased when towing a trailer. Refer to the "Technical data" section to find out whether this applies to your vehicle. If you utilize any of the added maximum rear axle load when towing a trailer, the vehicle/trailer combination may not exceed a maximum speed of 60 mph (100 km/h) for reasons concerning the operating permit. This also applies in countries in which the permissible maximum speed for vehicle/trailer combinations is above 60 mph (100 km/h). When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling characteristics will be different in comparison to when driving without a trailer and it will consume more fuel. On long and steep downhill gradients, you must select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time. i This also applies if you have activated cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS.

This will use the braking effect of the engine, so that less braking will be required to maintain the speed. This relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need additional braking, depress the brake pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.

Driving tips If the trailer swings from side to side: X Do not accelerate. X Do not counter-steer. X Brake if necessary. RMaintain a greater distance from the vehicle in front than when driving without a trailer. RAvoid braking abruptly. If possible, brake gently at first to allow the trailer to run on. Then, increase the braking force rapidly. RThe values given for gradient-climbing capabilities from a standstill refer to sea level. When driving in mountainous areas, note that the power output of the engine, and consequently the vehicle's gradient- climbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.

Trailer power supply ! You can connect accessories with a maximum power consumption of 180 W to the permanent power supply. You must not charge a trailer battery using the power supply.

The trailer socket of your vehicle is equipped at the factorywith a permanent power supply. The permanent power supply is supplied via trailer socket pin 9. A qualified specialist workshop can provide more information about installing the trailer electrics.

200 Towing a trailer Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Trailer with 7-pin connector

General notes You can make a connection to the 13-pin socket on the ball coupling using an adapter or, if necessary, an adapter cable. Both can be obtained in a qualified specialist workshop.

Installing the adapter ! Make sure that there is enough slack in the cable for cornering so that the cable cannot become detached.

X Open the socket cover. X Insert the connector with lug: into groove; on the socket and turn the connector clockwise to the stop.

X Make the cover engage. X If you are using an adapter cable, secure the cable to the trailer with cable ties.

i When the socket is connected, the ultrasonic backing up aid is deactivated.

Towing a trailer 201

Dr iv in g an d pa rk in g

Z

202

Useful information ............................ 204 Important safety notes .................... 204 Displays and operation .................... 205 Menus and submenus ...................... 208 Display messages ............................. 220 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster ............................ 242

203

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Important safety notes

G WARNING The driver's concentration must always be directed primarily at road traffic. For your safety and the safety of others, selecting features through the multifunction steering wheel should only be done by the driver when traffic and road conditions permit it to be done safely. Bear in mind that at a speed of only 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), the vehicle covers a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14m) per second.

G WARNING No messages will be displayed if either the instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative. As a result, you will not be able to see information about your driving conditions, such as Rspeed Routside temperature Rwarning/indicator lamps Rmalfunction/warning messages Rfailure of any systems Driving characteristics may be impaired.

If youmust continue to drive, do sowith added caution. Contact an authorized Mercedes- Benz Center as soon as possible.

G WARNING Malfunction and warning messages are only displayed for certain systems and are intentionally not very detailed. The malfunction and warning messages are simply a reminder with respect to the operation of certain systems. They do not replace the owner's and/or driver's responsibility to maintain the vehicle's operating safety. Have all required maintenance services and safety checks performed on the vehicle. Bring the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to address the malfunction and warning messages.

G WARNING All categories of messages contain important information which should be taken note of and, where a malfunction is indicated, addressed as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Failure to repair the condition noted may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes- Benz Limited Warranty, or result in property damage or personal injury.

For an illustration of the instrument cluster, see (Y page 205).

204 Important safety notes On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Displays and operation

Instrument cluster

Instrument cluster: miles : Speedometer with segments (Y page 206) ; Multifunction display (Y page 207) = Tachometer (Y page 206) ? Coolant temperature (Y page 205) A Fuel gauge B Instrument cluster lighting (Y page 205)

Instrument cluster lighting The brightness control knob is located on the bottom left of the instrument cluster (Y page 205). X Turn the brightness control knob clockwise or counter-clockwise. If the light switch is set to, T or L, the brightness is dependent upon the brightness of the ambient light.

i The light sensor in the instrument cluster automatically controls the brightness of the multifunction display. In daylight, the displays in the instrument cluster are not illuminated.

Displaying the coolant temperature

G WARNING Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids whichmay have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burnswhich can occur just by opening the engine hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.

! A display message is shown if the coolant temperature is too high.

Displays and operation 205

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

If the coolant temperature is over 248(120), do not continue driving. The engine will otherwise be damaged.

The coolant temperature gauge is in the instrument cluster on the right-hand side (Y page 205). Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 248 (120 ).

Tachometer ! Do not drive in the overrevving range, as this could damage the engine.

The red band in the tachometer indicates the engine's overrevving range. The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the engine when the red band is reached.

Outside temperature display

G WARNING The outside temperature indicator is not designed to serve as an ice-warning device and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The roadmay still be icy, especially in wooded areas or on bridges.

The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 207). Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.

Speedometer with segments The segments in the speedometer indicate which speed range is available. RCruise control activated (Y page 168): The segments light up from the stored speed to the maximum speed. RVariable SPEEDTRONIC activated (Y page 174):

The segments light up from the start of the scale to the selected limit speed. RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 179): One or two segments in the set speed range light up. RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front: The segments between the speed of the vehicle in front and the stored speed light up.

Operating the on-board computer

Overview

: Multifunction display ; To switch on the Voice Control System;

see the separate operating instructions = Right control panel ? Left control panel A Back button X To activate the on-board computer: turn the SmartKey to position 1(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

You can control the multifunction display and the settings in the on-board computer using the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel.

206 Displays and operation On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Left control panel

=

;

RCalls up the menu and menu bar

9

:

Press briefly: RScrolls in lists RSelects a submenu or function RIn the Audio menu: selects a stored station, an audio track or a video scene RIn the Tel (telephone) menu: switches to the phone book and selects a name or telephone number

9

:

Press and hold: RIn the Audio menu: selects the previous/next station or selects an audio track or a video scene using rapid scrolling RIn the Tel (telephone) menu: starts rapid scrolling if the phone book is open

a RConfirms a selection/display message RIn the Tel (telephone) menu: switches to the telephone book and starts dialing the selected number RIn the Audio menu: stops the station search function at the desired station

Right control panel

~ RRejects or ends a call RExits phone book/redial memory

6 RMakes or accepts a call RSwitches to the redial memory

W X

RAdjusts the volume

8 RMute

Back button

% Press briefly: RBack RSwitches off the Voice Control System; see the separate operating instructions RHides display messages/calls up the last Trip menu function used RExits the telephone book/redial memory

% Press and hold: RCalls up the standard display in the Trip menu

Multifunction display

: Transmission position (Y page 148) ; Drive program (Y page 149) = Description field ? Menu bar

Displays and operation 207

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

A Outside temperature or speed (Y page 215)

B Time C Transfer case position (Y page 193) X To show menu bar?: press the= or; button on the steering wheel.

Menu bar? disappears after a few seconds. Text field= shows the selected menu or submenu as well as display messages. For further information on displaying the transmission position, see (Y page 146).

i You can set the time using the audio system or COMAND, see the separate operating instructions.

The following messages may appear in the multifunction display: Z Upshift indicator (Y page 151) Cruise control (Y page 168) LIM SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 174) ECO start/stop function (AMG

vehicles) (Y page 141) LOW RANGE

LOW RANGE off-road gear (Y page 194)

HOLD function (Y page 188)

Menus and submenus

Menu overview Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to call up the menu bar and select a menu. Operating the on-board computer (Y page 206). Depending on the equipment installed in the vehicle, you can call up the following menus: RTrip menu (Y page 208) RNavi menu (navigation instructions) (Y page 209) RAudio menu (Y page 211) RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 212)

RDriveAssist menu (assistance) (Y page 213) RServ. menu (Y page 214) RSett. menu (Y page 214) RAMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 217)

Trip menu

Standard display

X Press and hold the% button on the steering wheel until the Trip menu with trip odometer: and odometer; is shown.

Trip computer "From start" or "From reset"

Example: trip computer "From Start" : Distance ; Time = Average speed ? Average fuel consumption X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.

X Press9 or: to select From Start or From Reset.

The values in the From Start submenu are calculated from the start of a journey whilst the values in the From Reset submenu are

208 Menus and submenus On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

calculated from the last time the submenu was reset (Y page 209). The From Start trip computer is automatically reset when: RThe ignition has been switched off for more than four hours. R999 hours have been exceeded. R9,999 miles have been exceeded. The From Reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 9,999 hours or 99,999 miles.

Displaying the range and current fuel consumption

: Approximate range ; Current fuel consumption (not for AMG

vehicles) X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select the current fuel consumption (not for AMG vehicles) and the approximate range.

The approximate range that can be covered depends on the fuel level and your current driving style. If there is only a small amount of fuel left in the fuel tank, the display shows a vehicle being refueledC instead of the range.

Digital speedometer

: Digital speedometer X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select the digital speedometer.

Resetting values

Example: resetting the trip computer "From Start" X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select the function that you wish to reset.

X Press thea button. X Press the: button to select Yes and press thea button to confirm.

You can reset the values of the following functions: RTrip odometer R"From Start" trip computer R"From Reset" trip computer

Navigation system menu

Displaying navigation instructions In the Navi menu, the multifunction display shows navigation instructions.

Menus and submenus 209

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

For more information, see the separate operating instructions. X Switch on COMAND (see the separate operating instructions).

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.

Route guidance not active

: Direction of travel ; Current street

Route guidance active

No change of direction announced

: Distance to the destination ; Distance to the next change of direction = Current street ? Symbol "follow the road's course"

Change of direction announced without a lane recommendation

: Road into which the change of direction leads

; Distance to change of direction and visual distance display

= Change-of-direction icon

When a change of direction has been announced, you will see visual distance display; next to the symbol for change of direction=. This shortens from the bottom to the top of the display as you approach the point of the announced change of direction.

Change of direction announced with a lane recommendation

: Road into which the change of direction leads

; Distance to change of direction and visual distance display

= Lane recommendation ? New lane during a change of direction A Uninterrupted lane B Change-of-direction icon

On multilane roads, the system can display lane recommendation= for the next change of direction. During the change of direction, additional lanes may be displayed. Lane recommendations are only displayed if the relevant data is available on the digital map.

210 Menus and submenus On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Other status indicators of the navigation system RO: you have reached the destination or an intermediate destination. RNew Route... or Calculating Route: calculating a new route ROff Map or Off Mapped Road: the vehicle position is outside the area of the digital map (off-map position). RNo Route: no route could be calculated to the selected destination.

Audio menu

Selecting a radio station

: Waveband ; Station frequency with memory position

i Station; is displayed with the station frequency or station name. The memory position is only displayed along with station; if this has been stored.

X Switch on COMAND and select Radio; see the separate operating instructions.

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.

X To select a stored station: briefly press the9 or: button.

X To select a station from the station list: press and briefly hold the9 or: button.

If no station list is received: X To select a station using the station search: press and briefly hold the9 or: button.

i For information on switching waveband and storing stations; see the separate operating instructions.

i SIRIUS XM satellite radio functions like a normal radio. For more information on satellite radio operation, see the separate operating instructions.

Operating audio devices or media

Display CD/DVD changer (example) : Current CD in the CD/DVD changer ; Current title

Audio data from various audio devices or media can be played, depending on the equipment installed in the vehicle. X Switch on COMAND and select the audio player or medium (see the separate operating instructions).

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.

X To select the next/previous track: briefly press the9 or: button.

X To select a track from the track list (rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9 or: button until desired track; has been reached. If you press and hold9 or:, the rapid scrolling speed is increased. Not all audio drives or data carriers support this function.

If track information is stored on the audio device or medium, the multifunction display will show the number and title of the track. The current track does not appear in audio AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external audio source connected).

Menus and submenus 211

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Video DVD operation

Display CD/DVD changer (example) : Current DVD in the CD/DVD changer ; Current scene X Switch on COMAND and select video DVD; see the separate operating instructions.

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.

X To select the next/previous scene: briefly press the9 or: button.

X To select a scene from the scene list (rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9 or: button until desired scene; has been reached.

Telephone menu

Introduction

G WARNING The driver's attention to the roadmust always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the telephonewhile driving, please use the hands- free device and only use the telephone when road, weather and traffic conditions permit. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a mobile phone while driving a vehicle. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle covers a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second.

X Switch on the mobile phone (see the separate operating instructions).

X Switch on COMAND (see the separate operating instructions).

X Establish a Bluetooth connection to COMAND; see the separate operating instructions.

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.

You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display: RPhone READY or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found a network and is ready to receive. RPhone No Service: there is no network available or the mobile phone is searching for a network.

Accepting a call

Example: incoming call

If someone calls you when you are in the Tel menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display. X Press the6 button on the steering wheel to accept an incoming call.

You can accept a call even if you are not in the Tel menu. Rejecting or ending a call X Press the~ button on the steering wheel.

You can end or reject a call even if you are not in the Tel menu.

212 Menus and submenus On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Dialing a number from the phone book X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.

X Press the9,: ora button to switch to the phone book.

X Press the9 or: button to select the desired name.

or X To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold the9 or: button for longer than one second. Rapid scrolling stops when you release the button or reach the end of the list.

X If only one telephone number is stored for a name: press the6 ora button to start dialing.

or X If there is more than one number for a particular name: press the6 ora button to display the numbers.

X Press the9 or: button to select the number you want to dial.

X Press the6 ora button to start dialing.

or X To exit the telephone book: press the ~ or% button.

Redialing The on-board computer saves the last names or numbers dialed in the redial memory. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.

X Press the6 button to switch to the redial memory.

X Press the9 or: button to select the desired name or number.

X Press the6 ora button to start dialing.

or X To exit the redial memory: press the ~ or% button.

Assistance menu

Introduction

In the DriveAssist menu, you have the following options: Rshow the distance display (Y page 213) Ractivate/deactivate Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist (Y page 213)

Showing the distance display X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select Distance Display.

X Press thea button. The DISTRONIC PLUS distance display appears in the multifunction display (Y page 182).

Activating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select Blind Spot Asst.

X Press thea button. The current selection is displayed.

X To activate/deactivate: press thea button again.

For further information about Blind Spot Assist, see (Y page 185).

Menus and submenus 213

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra nd

di sp la ys

Z

Maintenance menu

Example: service menu

In the Serv. menu, you have the following options: Rcalling up display messages (Y page 220) Rchecking the tire pressure electronically (Y page 321) Rcalling up when a service is due (Y page 287)

Settings menu

Introduction

Example: settings menu

In the Sett. menu, you have the following options: Rchanging the instrument cluster settings (Y page 214) Rchanging the light settings (Y page 215) Rchanging the vehicle settings (Y page 216) Rchanging the convenience settings (Y page 216) Rrestoring the factory settings (Y page 217)

Instrument cluster

Selecting the unit of measurement for distance The Display Unit Speed-/Odometer: function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometers or miles in the multifunction display. You can determine whether the multifunction display shows some messages in miles or kilometers. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Inst. Cluster submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press the: or9 button to select the Display Unit Speed-/Odometer: function. You will see the selected setting: km or miles.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to: RVehicles with instrument cluster in kilometers: digital speedometer in the Trip menu Rthe odometer and the trip odometer Rthe trip computer Rthe current consumption and the range Rthe navigation instructions in the Navi menu Rcruise control RSPEEDTRONIC RDISTRONIC PLUS Rthe service interval display

214 Menus and submenus On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Selecting the permanent display function You can determine whether the multifunction display permanently shows your speed or the outside temperature. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Instr. Cluster submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press the: or9 button to select the Permanent Display: function. You will see the selected setting: Outside Temperature or Speedometer [mph].

X Press thea button to save the setting.

i Speed is displayed in mph.

Lights

Setting the daytime running lamps i This function is not available in Canada. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Lights submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press: or9 to select the Daytime Running Lights function. If the Daytime Running Lights: have been switched on, the cone of light and the W symbol in the multifunction display are shown in red.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

Further information on daytime running lamps (Y page 99).

Surround lighting and exterior lighting delayed switch-off X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Lights submenu.

X Pressa to confirm.

X Press: or9 to select the Surround Lighting function. When the Surround Lighting function is activated, the cone of light in the multifunction display is shown in red.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting temporarily: X Before leaving the vehicle, turn the SmartKey to position 0(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 139). The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is deactivated.

Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is reactivated the next time you start the engine. If you have activated the Surround Lighting function and the light switch is set to, the following functions are activated when it is dark: RSurround lighting: the exterior lighting remains lit for 40 seconds after unlocking with the SmartKey. If you start the engine, the surround lighting is switched off and automatic headlamp mode is activated (Y page 100). RExterior lighting delayed switch-off: the exterior lighting remains lit for 60 seconds after the engine is switched off. If you close all the doors and the trunk lid, the exterior lighting goes off after 15 seconds.

i Depending on your vehicle's equipment, when the surround lighting and delayed switch-off exterior lighting are on, the following light up: RParking lamps RFront fog lamps RLow-beam headlamps RDaytime running lamps RSide marker lamps RSurround lighting in the exterior mirrors

Menus and submenus 215

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off If you activate the Interior Lighting Delay function, the interior lighting remains on for 20 seconds after you remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Lights submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press: or9 to select the Interior Lighting Delay function. When the Interior Lighting Delay function is activated, the vehicle interior is displayed in red in the multifunction display.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

Vehicle

Activating/deactivating the automatic door locking mechanism If you activate the Automatic Door Lock function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a speed of around 9 mph (15 km/h). X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Vehicle submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press: or9 to select the Automatic Door Lock function. When the Automatic Door Lock function is activated, the vehicle doors are displayed in red in the multifunction display.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

For further information on the automatic locking feature, see (Y page 75).

Activating/deactivating the acoustic locking verification signal If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function, an acoustic signal sounds when you lock the vehicle. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press: or9 to select the Vehicle submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press the: or9 button to select the Acoustic Lock function. If the Acoustic Lock function is activated, the& symbol in the multifunction display lights up red.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

Convenience

Activating/deactivating the EASY- ENTRY/EXIT feature G WARNING You must make sure no one can become trapped or injured by the moving steering wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated. To stop steering wheel movement, move steering wheel adjustment lever or press one of the memory position buttons. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver's door and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury.

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Convenience submenu.

X Pressa to confirm.

216 Menus and submenus On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

X Press: or9 to select the Easy Entry/Exit: function. If the Easy Entry/Exit function is activated, the vehicle steering wheel is displayed in red in the multifunction display.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

Further information on the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature (Y page 92).

Switching the fold-in mirrors with the locking feature on/off When you activate the Auto. Mirror Folding function, the exterior mirrors are folded in when the vehicle is locked. If you unlock the vehicle and then open a door, the exterior mirrors fold out again. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Convenience submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press: or9 to select the Auto. Mirror Folding function. If the Auto. Mirror Folding function is activated, the vehicle's exterior mirror is displayed in red in the multifunction display.

X Press thea button to save the setting.

: To fold the exterior mirrors in or out

If you have switched the Auto. Mirror Folding on and you fold the exterior mirrors in using button:, they will not fold out automatically (Y page 93).

You can then only fold out the exteriormirrors using button:.

Restoring the factory settings X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.

X Press the: or9 button to select the Factory Setting submenu.

X Pressa to confirm. The Reset All Settings? message appears.

X Press the: or9 button to select No or Yes.

X Pressa to confirm the selection. If you select Yes, the multifunction display shows a confirmation message.

For safety reasons, the Daytime Running Lights function in the Lights submenu is only reset if the vehicle is stationary.

AMG menu in AMG vehicles

AMG displays

: Digital speedometer ; Gear indicator = Upshift indicator ? Engine oil temperature A Coolant temperature B Status indicator for ECO start/stop

function (Y page 141) X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.

Upshift indicator UP= indicates that the engine has reached the overrevving range when in the manual gearshift program.

Menus and submenus 217

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Upshift indicator UP= fades out other messages until you have shifted up. If the engine oil temperature is below 176 (80 ), the oil temperature is shown in blue. Avoid driving at full engine output during this time.

SETUP

: Drive program (C/SS+/M) ; ESP mode (ON/OFF) = Suspension tuning (SPORT/COMFORT) SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP (Electronic Stability Program) mode and the SPORT handling mode. X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.

X Press the9 button repeatedly until SETUP is displayed.

RACETIMER

Displaying and starting RACETIMER G WARNING The RACETIMER feature is only for use on roads and in conditions where high speed driving is permitted. Racing on public roads is prohibited under all circumstances. The driver is and must always remain responsible for following posted speed limits.

: Lap ; RACETIMER

You can start the RACETIMER when the engine is running or if the SmartKey is in position 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock. X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.

X Press the9 button repeatedly until the RACETIMER is shown.

X To start: press thea button to start the RACETIMER.

Displaying the intermediate time

X Press the= or; button to select Interm. Time.

X Pressa to confirm. The intermediate time is displayed for five seconds.

Starting a new lap

: RACETIMER ; Fastest lap time (best lap) = Lap X Pressa to confirm New Lap.

218 Menus and submenus On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

i It is possible to store a maximum of sixteen laps. The 16th lap can only be completed with Finish Lap.

Stopping the RACETIMER

X Press the% button on the steering wheel.

X Pressa to confirm Yes. The RACETIMER is interrupted if you stop the vehicle and turn the SmartKey to position 1(Y page 139) in the ignition lock. If you turn the SmartKey to position 2 or 3(Y page 139) and then pressa to confirm Start, timing is continued. Resetting the current lap X Stop the RACETIMER (Y page 219). X Press= or; to select Reset Lap. X Pressa to reset the lap time to "0".

Deleting all laps

If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are deleted. You cannot delete individual stored laps. If you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap does not have to be reset.

X Reset the current lap (Y page 219). X Pressa to confirm Reset. Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.

X Press the: button to select Yes and press thea button to confirm. All laps are deleted.

Overall statistics

: RACETIMER overall evaluation ; Total time driven = Average speed ? Distance covered A Maximum speed

This function is shown if you have stored at least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER. X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.

X Press the9 button repeatedly until the overall evaluation is shown.

Lap statistics

: Lap ; Lap time = Average lap speed ? Lap length A Top speed during lap

Menus and submenus 219

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

This function is only available if you have stored at least two laps and have stopped the RACETIMER. X Press= or; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.

X Press the9 button repeatedly until the lap evaluation is shown. Each lap is shown in a separate submenu. The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol:.

X Press the9 or: button to select a different lap evaluation.

Display messages

Introduction

General notes Displaymessages appear in themultifunction display. Display messages with graphic displays may be shown in simplified form in the Operator's Manual and may differ from the messages shown in the multifunction display. Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this Operator's Manual. Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone. When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on: RHOLD function (Y page 188) RParking (Y page 156)

Hiding display messages X Press thea or% button on the steeringwheel to hide the displaymessage. The display message is cleared.

Display messages with a high priority are shown in red. You cannot hide display messages of the highest priority. The multifunction display

shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.

Message memory menu The on-board computer saves certain display messages. You can call up the display messages in themessage memory. X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu. If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 Messages, for example.

X Press the9 or: button to select the entry, e.g. 2 Messages.

X Pressa to confirm. X Press the9 or: button to scroll through the display messages.

When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted, apart from some high- priority displaymessages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.

220 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Safety systems

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

! Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manual

ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP trailer stabilization are temporarily unavailable. BAS and the adaptive brake lights may also have failed. In addition, the , and ! warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. Possible causes are: RSelf-diagnosis is not yet complete. RThe on-board voltage may be insufficient.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above are available again.

If the display message continues to be displayed: X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

! Inoperative See Operator's Manual

ABS, ESP, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP trailer stabilization are unavailable due to a malfunction. BAS and the adaptive brake lights may also have failed. The$ (USA only)/J (Canada only), , and ! warning lamps in the instrument cluster also light up.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase.

Display messages 221

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.

Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manual

ESP, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP trailer stabilization are unavailable due to a malfunction. BAS and the adaptive brake lights may also have failed. In addition, the and warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above are available again.

If the display message continues to be displayed: X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

222 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Inoperative See Operator's Manual

ESP, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP trailer stabilization are unavailable due to a malfunction. BAS and the adaptive brake lights may also have failed. In addition, the and warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

T! Inoperative See Operator's Manual

EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP trailer stabilization are unavailable due to a malfunction. BAS and the adaptive brake lights may also have failed. In addition, the , and ! warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.

F(USA

only)!(Canada only) Release Park. Brake

You are driving with the parking brake applied. A warning tone also sounds. X Release the parking brake.

Display messages 223

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

$(USA

only)J(Canada only) Check Brake Fluid Level

There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir. In addition, the$ (USA only)/J (Canada only) warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.

G WARNING The braking effect may be impaired. There is a risk of an accident. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. X Do not add brake fluid. This does not correct the malfunction.

# Check Brake Pad Wear

The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

G mbrace Inoperative

USA only: one or more main functions of the mbrace system are malfunctioning. Canada only: one or more main functions of the TELE AID system are malfunctioning. X USA only: have the mbrace system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

X Canada only: have the Tele AID system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

6 SRS Malfunction Service Required

There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.

G WARNING The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered. There is an increased risk of injury. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. For further information about SRS, see (Y page 39).

224 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

6 Front Left Malfunction Service RequiredorFront Right Malfunction Service Required

SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.

G WARNING The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered. There is an increased risk of injury. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

6 Rear Left Malfunction Service RequiredorRear Right Malfunction Service Required

SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.

G WARNING The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered. There is an increased risk of injury. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

6 Rear Center Malfunction Service Required

SRS has malfunctioned at the rear center. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.

G WARNING The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered. There is an increased risk of injury. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

6 Left Side Curtain Airbag Malfunction Service Required or Right Side Curtain Airbag Malfunction Service Required

There is a malfunction in the left-hand or right-hand window curtain air bag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.

G WARNING The left or right window curtain air bag may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered. There is an increased risk of injury. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Display messages 225

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Operator's Manual

A special BabySmart-compatible child restraint system is mounted on the front-passenger seat. The 45 indicator lamp also lights up. The front-passenger air bag is therefore disabled. Further information on BabySmart(Y page 44).

Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's Manual

The 45 indicator lamp does not remain lit if a special BabySmart-compatible child restraint system has been installed on the front-passenger seat. The BabySmart system is malfunctioning.

G WARNING The front-passenger front air bag can be triggered unintentionally in the event of an accident. There is a risk of an accident. X Make sure there is nothing between the seat and the child restraint system.

X Check that the child restraint system is installed correctly. X If the 45 indicator lamp does not light up, have the BabySmart system checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop. Do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the air bag deactivation system has been repaired.

Lights i Display messages about LEDs: This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

b Check Left Low Beam or Check Right Low Beam

The left or right-hand low-beam headlamp is defective. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Trailer Left Tail Lamp or Check Trailer Right Tail Lamp

The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself. or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

226 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

b Check Trailer Left Turn Signal or Check Trailer Right Turn Signal

The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself. or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Trailer Brake Lamp

The trailer brake lamp is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself. or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Rear Left Turn Signal or Check Rear Right Turn Signal

The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself (Y page 109).

or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Front Left Turn Signal or Check Front Right Turn Signal

The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself (Y page 109).

or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Left Mirror Turn Signal or Check Right Mirror Turn Signal

The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is defective. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Center Brake Lamp

The high-mounted brake lamp is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Left Brake LamporCheck Right Brake Lamp

The left or right-hand brake lamp is defective. X Replace the bulb (Y page 108).

b Check Left High BeamorCheck Right High Beam

The left or right-hand high beam is defective. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Display messages 227

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

b License Plate Lamp

There is a short circuit in the LED lamps. The LEDs have been switched off. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Left Fog LamporCheck Right Fog Lamp

The left-hand or right-hand front fog lamp is defective. X Replace the bulb (Y page 108).

b Rear Fog Lamp

The rear fog lamp is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself (Y page 109).

or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Front Left Parking Lamp or Check Front Right Parking Lamp

The front left or front right parking or standing lamp is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself (Y page 109).

or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Backup Light

The backup lamp is defective. X Replace the bulb (Y page 108).

b Check Front Left Sidemarker LamporCheck Front Right Sidemarker Lamp

The left or right front side marker lamp is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself (Y page 109).

or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Check Left Tail LamporCheck Right Tail Lamp

The left or right-hand tail lamp is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself (Y page 109).

or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

228 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

b Check Left Daytime Running Light or Check Right Daytime Running Light

The left or right-hand daytime running lamp is defective. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Malfunction See Operator's Manual

The exterior lighting is defective. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Auto Lamp Function Inoperative

The light sensor is defective. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

b Switch Off Lights

The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A warning tone also sounds. X Turn the light switch to.

Engine

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

+ Check Coolant Level See Operator's Manual

The coolant level is too low. X Add coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so (Y page 285).

X Have the coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the coolant needs topping upmore often than usual.

? The fan motor is faulty. X At coolant temperatures below 248 (120), drive to the next qualified specialist workshop.

X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.

Display messages 229

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

? Coolant Too Hot Stop Vehicle Turn Engine Off

The coolant is too hot. A warning tone also sounds.

G WARNING Do not drive when your engine is overheated. This can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. Steam from the overheated engine can also cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the hood. There is a risk of injury. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.

X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice.

X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out and the coolant temperature is below 248 (120 ). Otherwise, the engine could be damaged.

X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display. X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.

Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 248 (120 ).

The poly-V-belt may have torn. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Check the poly-V-belt. If the poly-V-belt is torn: ! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. If the poly-V-belt is not damaged: X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the engine. Otherwise, the engine could be damaged.

X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

230 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

# The battery is not being charged. A warning tone also sounds. Possible causes are: Ra defective alternator Ra torn poly-V-belt Ra malfunction in the electronics X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Open the hood. X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn. If the poly-V-belt is torn: ! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. If the poly-V-belt is not damaged: X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

4 Check Engine Oil At Next Refueling

The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level. A warning tone also sounds. X Check the oil level when next refueling, at the latest (Y page 283).

X If necessary, add engine oil (Y page 284). X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if engine oil needs to be added more often than usual.

! Avoid long journeys with too little engine oil. The engine will otherwise be damaged.

Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http:// www.mbusa.com (USA only).

4 Engine Oil Level Low Stop Vehicle Turn Engine Off

The engine oil level is too low. There is a risk of engine damage. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Add engine oil (Y page 284) and check the oil level (Y page 283).

Display messages 231

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

4 Check Engine Oil Level (Add 1 quart)

AMG vehicles: the engine oil level is too low. X Check the oil level when next refueling, at the latest (Y page 283).

X If necessary, add engine oil (Y page 284). X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if engine oil needs to be added more often than usual.

! Avoid long journeys with too little engine oil. The engine will otherwise be damaged.

Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http:// www.mbusa.com (USA only).

4 Engine Oil Level Cannot Be Measured

The measuring system is malfunctioning. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

8 Fuel Level Low

The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range. X Refuel at the nearest gas station.

C There is only a very small amount of fuel in the fuel tank. X Refuel at the nearest gas station without fail.

8 Gas Cap Loose

The fuel system pressure is too low. The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is leaking. X Check that the fuel filler cap is correctly closed.

If the fuel filler cap is not correctly closed: X Close the fuel filler cap.

If the fuel filler cap is correctly closed: X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

232 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Driving systems

Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

TC Shift Conditions Not Fulfilled Apply Brake/ Parking Brake

The parking brake has not been applied and the brake pedal has not been depressed. The transfer case has canceled the gear change process and is inNeutral. There is no connection between the engine and the drive wheels. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Depress the brake pedal and apply the parking brake. X Shift the automatic transmission to neutral position N. X Make sure all conditions for changing gears are met (Y page 194).

X Repeat the gearshift process.

TC Malfunction Visit WorkshopTo park, apply the parking brake

There is a malfunction in the transfer case. X Do not shift the transfer case. X When parking, secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156).

X Have the vehicle checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

TC Shift Canceled Please Reactivate

The transfer case has not performed the gear change process. X Repeat the gearshift process. X Make sure all conditions for changing gears are met (Y page 194).

TC Shift Condition Not Fulfilled Drive at Max. 25 mph

You have exceeded the maximum speed for the gearshift process. X Drive more slowly. X Repeat the gearshift process.

TC Shift Condition Not Fulfilled Shift to NEUTRAL

You have not met one or more shift conditions. X Shift the automatic transmission to neutral position N. X Repeat the gearshift process.

TC shift condition not fulfilled Drive at Max. 40 mph

You have exceeded the maximum speed for the gearshift process. X Drive more slowly. X Repeat the gearshift process.

LOW RANGE On

The transfer case is in the LOW RANGE off-road position.

HIGH RANGE On

The transfer case is in the HIGH RANGE on-road position.

Display messages 233

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Differential Locks Available Only in LOW RANGE

The LOW RANGE button has been pressed. The transfer case is in the LOW RANGE off-road driving position and a differential lock is engaged. X Disengage the differential locks (Y page 195). X Repeat the gearshift process.

TC-NEUTRAL On

The transfer case is in the Neutral neutral position. A warning tone will also sound when the driver's door is opened and the brake pedal is not depressed. X Close the driver's door. X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Shift the transfer case according to driving conditions (Y page 193).

Differential Lock Preselected ESP Not Available

A differential lock has been engaged. The differential gear has not yet locked the respective differential. The activation indicator lamp (yellow) (Y page 195) of the switch lights up. ESP is unavailable. ABS is still available.

Differential Locks Active ABS and ESP Not Available

A differential lock was engaged and the differential gear has locked the respective differential. The activation indicator lamp (yellow) and function indicator lamp (red) (Y page 195) on the switch light up. ABS and ESP are unavailable.

234 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Blind Spot Assist Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manualor Active Blind Spot Assist Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manual

Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes are: Ryou have established the electrical connection between the trailer and your vehicle. Rthe sensors are dirty. Rfunction is impaired due to heavy rain or snow. Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature range. Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.

The yellow9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors. X When towing a trailer, confirm the display message witha.

If you are driving without a trailer and the display message does not disappear: X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Apply the parking brake. X Clean the sensors (Y page 291). X Restart the engine. If the system detects that the sensors are fully operational, the display message disappears. Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again.

Blind Spot Assist Inoperativeor Active Blind Spot Assist Inoperative

Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is defective. The yellow9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

DISTRONIC PLUS Off

DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 176). If it was deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.

DISTRONIC PLUS Now Available

DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 176).

Display messages 235

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

DISTRONIC PLUS Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manual

DISTRONIC is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes are: Rthe DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator trim is dirty Rfunction is impaired due to heavy rain or snow. Rthe sensors in the bumpers are dirty. Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation. Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range. Rthe transfer case is in the LOW RANGE transmission position. Rthe vehicle is on an uphill or downhill gradient of greater than 22%-25%. Rthe on-board voltage is too low. A warning tone also sounds. If the display message does not disappear: X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Apply the parking brake. X Clean the DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator trim and the bumper (Y page 291).

X Restart the engine. If the system detects that the sensors are fully operational, the display message disappears. DISTRONIC is operational again.

DISTRONIC PLUS Inoperative

DISTRONIC PLUS is defective. BAS (Brake Assist) may also have failed. A warning tone also sounds. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

DISTRONIC PLUS Passive

You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no longer controlling the speed of the vehicle. X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.

DISTRONIC PLUS --- mph

An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled. X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 176).

DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC Inoperative

DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone also sounds. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

236 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Cruise Control and SPEEDTRONIC Inoperative

Cruise control and SPEEDTRONIC are malfunctioning. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Limit --- mph

While depressing the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC cannot be activated.

Cruise Control --- mph

A condition for activating cruise control has not been fulfilled. You have tried to store a speed below 20 mph (30 km/h), for example. X If conditions permit, drive faster than 20 mph (30 km/h) and store the speed.

X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 168).

Tires

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Tire pressure will be displayed after driving a few minutes

The tire pressure monitor is measuring the tire pressure. X Drive on. The tire pressures appear in the multifunction display after you have been driving for a few minutes.

Tire Press. Monitor Inoperative

The tire pressure monitor is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Tire Pressure Monitor Inoperative No Wheel Sensors

The wheels mounted do not have a suitable tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitor is deactivated. X Mount wheels with suitable tire pressure sensors. The tire pressuremonitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.

Display messages 237

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Check Tires The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly. The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display. A warning tone also sounds.

G WARNING With tire pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards: Rthey may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase. Rthey may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tire traction. Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.

There is a risk of an accident. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X If there is a flat tire, inspect the tires (Y page 298). X Check the tire pressure (Y page 319). X If necessary, correct the tire pressure.

Warning Tire Malfunction

The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. The wheel position is shown in the multifunction display.

G WARNING If you drive with a flat tire, there is a risk of the following hazards: RA flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. RYou could lose control of the vehicle. RContinued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build- up and possibly a fire.

There is a risk of an accident. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X If there is a flat tire, inspect the tires (Y page 298).

Correct Tire Pressure

The tire pressure is too low in at least one of the tires, or the tire pressure difference between the wheels is too great. X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 319). X If necessary, correct the tire pressure. X Restart the tire pressure monitor (Y page 321).

238 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

TirePress. Sensor(s) Missing

There is no signal from the tire pressure sensor of one or several wheels. The pressure of the affected tire is not displayed in the multifunction display. X Have the faulty tire pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.

Tire Press. Monitor Currently Unavailable

Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received from the wheel sensors. The tire pressure monitor is temporarily malfunctioning. X Drive on. The tire pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the problem has been solved.

h Tire Pressure Warning Tire Failure

The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. A warning tone also sounds.

G WARNING If you drive with a flat tire, there is a risk of the following hazards: RA flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. RYou could lose control of the vehicle. RContinued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build- up and possibly a fire. There is a risk of an accident.

X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X If there is a flat tire, inspect the tires (Y page 298).

Display messages 239

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

h Check Tire Pressure

The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly.

G WARNING With tire pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards: Rthey may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase. Rthey may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tire traction. Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired. There is a risk of an accident.

X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X If there is a flat tire, inspect the tires (Y page 298). X Check the tire pressure (Y page 319). X If necessary, correct the tire pressure.

h Correct Tire Pressure

The tire pressure is too low in at least one of the tires, or the tire pressure difference between the wheels is too great. X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 319). X If necessary, correct the tire pressure.

Vehicle

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Shift to 'P' or 'N' to Start Engine

You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in position R or D. X Shift the transmission to position P or N.

Auxiliary Battery Malfunction

The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer being charged. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop at the next opportunity. X Until then, set the automatic transmission to position P before you switch off the engine.

X Before leaving the vehicle, apply the parking brake.

240 Display messages On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

A The rear door is open.

G WARNING When the engine is running, exhaust gases can enter the vehicle interior if the rear door is open. There is a risk of poisoning. X Close the rear door.

? The hood is open.

G WARNING The open hood may block your view when the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk of an accident. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Close the hood.

C At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds. X Close all the doors.

D Power Steering Malfunction See Operator's Manual

The power steering is malfunctioning. A warning tone also sounds.

G WARNING You will need to use more force to steer. There is a risk of an accident. X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required. X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified specialist workshop.

X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the nearest qualified specialist workshop.

Phone No Service Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/ receiver range. X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol appears in the multifunction display.

Check Washer Fluid

The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below the minimum. X Add washer fluid (Y page 286).

Display messages 241

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

SmartKey

Display messages Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

Key Does Not Belong to Vehicle

You have put the wrong SmartKey in the ignition lock. X Use the correct SmartKey.

Take Your Key from Ignition

The SmartKey is in the ignition lock. X Remove the SmartKey.

Obtain a New Key

The SmartKey needs to be replaced. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster

Overview of warning and indicator lamps

L Low-beam headlamps(Y page 99)

#! Turn signals (Y page 103) K High-beam headlamps

(Y page 103) N Fog lamps (Y page 101) R Rear fog lamp (Y page 101) Seat belts (Y page 243) $ (USA) Brakes (Y page 244) J (Canada) Brakes (yellow)

(Y page 244) ! ABS (Y page 245) ESP(Y page 247) ESP OFF (Y page 247) 6 SRS (Y page 250) ; Check Engine (Y page 251) 8 Reserve fuel (Y page 251) ? Coolant (Y page 251) Distance warning signal

(Y page 253) h Tire pressure monitor

(Y page 254)

242 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Safety

Seat belts

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

After starting the engine, the red seat belt warning lamp lights up for six seconds.

The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten their seat belts. X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50).

After starting the engine, the red seat belt warning lamp lights up. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up to six seconds.

The driver's seat belt is not fastened. X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). The warning tone ceases.

The red seat belt warning lamp lights up after the engine starts, as soon as the driver's or the front-passenger door is closed.

The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). The warning lamp goes out.

There are objects on the front-passenger seat. X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure place. The warning lamp goes out.

The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent audible warning sounds.

The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. In addition, you are driving faster than 15mph (25 km/h) or you have briefly driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h). X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.

There are objects on the front-passenger seat. In addition, you are driving faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or you have briefly driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h). X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure place. The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone ceases.

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster 243

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Safety systems

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

$ (USA only) J (Canada only) USA only: the red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds. Canada only: the yellow brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds.

G WARNING The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected. There is a risk of an accident. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

$ (USA only) J (Canada only) USA only: the red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds. Canada only: the yellow brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds.

There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.

G WARNING The braking effect may be impaired. There is a risk of an accident. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Do not add brake fluid. Adding more will not remedy the malfunction.

X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

244 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

!

The yellowABSwarning lamp is lit while the engine is running.

ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) is deactivated due to a malfunction. BAS (Brake Assist), ESP (Electronic Stability Program), the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP trailer stabilization, for example, are therefore also deactivated.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will not be available.

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster 245

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

!

The yellowABSwarning lamp is lit while the engine is running.

ABS is temporarily unavailable. BAS, ESP, EBD (electronic brake force distribution), the HOLD function, hill start assist, ESP trailer stabilization and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are therefore also deactivated. Possible causes are: Rself-diagnosis is not yet complete. Rthe on-board voltage may be insufficient.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident. X Carefully drive a suitable distance, making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). The functions mentioned above are available again when the warning lamp goes out.

If the warning lamp is still on: X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

246 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

!

The yellowABSwarning lamp is lit while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds.

EBD is malfunctioning. Therefore, ABS, BAS, ESP, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP trailer stabilization are also not available, for example.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

!

The yellowABSwarning lamp is lit while the engine is running.

You have engaged the differential locks. ABS is deactivated. X Disengage the differential locks. Subsequently ABS is reactivated.

$ (USA only) J (Canada only) !

The yellow brake warning lamp, the yellow ESP and ESP OFF warning lamps and the yellow ABS warning lamp are lit while the engine is running.

ABS and ESP aremalfunctioning. Therefore, BAS, EBD, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP trailer stabilization, for example, are also not available.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster 247

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

The yellow ESP warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion.

ESP or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin. Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated. X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary.

X Ease off the accelerator pedal while the vehicle is in motion. X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions. X Do not deactivate ESP. For exceptions, see: (Y page 62).

The yellow ESP OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.

ESP is deactivated.

G WARNING

If ESP is switched off, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Reactivate ESP. For exceptions, see: (Y page 62).

X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.

If ESP cannot be activated: X Have ESP checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

The yellow ESP and ESP OFF warning lamps are lit while the engine is running.

ESP, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP trailer stabilization are not available due to a malfunction.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

248 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

The yellow ESP and ESP OFF warning lamps are lit while the engine is running.

ESP, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP trailer stabilization are temporarily unavailable. BAS and the adaptive brake lights may also have failed. Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.

G WARNING The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus increase. If ESP is not operational, ESP is unable to stabilize the vehicle. There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident. X Carefully drive a suitable distance, making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). The functions mentioned above are available again when the warning lamp goes out.

If the warning lamp is still on: X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

The yellow ESP OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.

You have engaged the differential locks. ABS, ESP, 4ETS and BAS have been deactivated. X Disengage the differential locks. ESP, 4ETS and BAS are subsequently reactivated.

X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster 249

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

(Canada only) (USA only) The red parking brake warning lamp comes on while the vehicle is moving. A warning tone also sounds.

You are driving with the parking brake applied. X Release the parking brake. The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.

6

The red SRS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.

There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System).

G WARNING The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered. There is an increased risk of injury. X Drive on carefully. X Have SRS checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.

For further information about SRS, see (Y page 39).

250 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Engine

Problem Possible causes/consequences andM Solutions

;

The yellow Check Engine warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.

There may be a malfunction, for example: Rin the engine management Rin the fuel injection system Rin the exhaust system Rin the ignition system Rin the fuel system The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be in emergency mode. X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.

i In some states, you must immediately visit a qualified specialist workshop as soon as the yellowCheck Enginewarning lamp lights up. This is due to the legal requirements in effect in these states. If in doubt, check whether such legal regulations apply in the state in which you are currently driving.

8

The yellow reserve fuel warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.

The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range. X Refuel at the nearest gas station.

8

The yellow reserve fuel warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion. In addition, the; Check Engine warning lamp may light up.

The fuel system pressure is too low. The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is leaking. X Check that the fuel filler cap is correctly closed. X If the fuel filler cap is not correctly closed: close the fuel filler cap.

X If the fuel filler cap is closed: visit a qualified specialist workshop.

?

The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running and the coolant temperature gauge is at the start of the scale.

The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is defective. The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances.

X Apply the parking brake. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster 251

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

?

The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running.

The coolant level is too low.

! Avoidmaking long journeys with too little coolant in the engine cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.

If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning. The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Apply the parking brake. X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.

X Check the coolant level and add coolant, observing the warning notes (Y page 285).

X If you need to add coolant more often than usual, have the engine coolant system checked.

X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice.

X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is below248 (120). Otherwise, the engine could be damaged.

X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.

?

The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running. Awarning tone also sounds.

The coolant temperature has exceeded 248 (120 ). The airflow to the engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too low.

G WARNING The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged. Do not drive when your engine is overheated. This can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. Steam from the overheated engine can also cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the hood. There is a risk of injury.

252 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.

X Check the coolant level and add coolant, observing the warning notes (Y page 285).

X If you need to add coolant more often than usual, have the engine coolant system checked.

X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice.

X At coolant temperatures below 248 (120 ), drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.

X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.

Driving systems

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion.

The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed selected. X Increase the distance.

The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion. A warning tone also sounds.

You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line of travel at too high a speed. X Be prepared to brake immediately. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to brake or take evasive action.

Further information on DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 176).

Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster 253

On -b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Z

Tires

Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions

h

USA only: The yellow tire pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/ malfunction) is lit. Canada only: The yellow tire pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss) is lit.

The tire pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at least one of the tires.

G WARNING With tire pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards: Rthey may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase. Rthey may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tire traction. Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired. There is a risk of an accident.

X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.

X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 156). X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X If there is a flat tire, inspect the tires (Y page 298). X Check the tire pressure (Y page 319). X If necessary, correct the tire pressure.

h

USA only: The yellow tire pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/ malfunction) flashes for approximately one minute and then remains lit.

The tire pressure monitor is faulty.

G WARNING The system is possibly unable to recognize or register low tire pressure. There is a risk of an accident. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display.

X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

254 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On

-b oa rd

co m pu te ra

nd di sp la ys

Useful information ............................ 256 Loading guidelines ............................ 256 Stowage areas .................................. 257 Features ............................................. 262

255

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Loading guidelines

G WARNING Always fasten items being carried as securely as possible using cargo tie-down rings and fasteningmaterials appropriate for the weight and size of the load. In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose itemswill be thrown around inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items are securely fastened in the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when transporting cargo. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the seat backrests. Never drive a vehicle with the tailgate open. Deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death.

Driving, braking and steering characteristics change depending on: Rtype of load Rweight Rthe center of gravity of the load You should therefore load your vehicle as shown in the illustrations. The gross vehicle weight (GVW) is the vehicle weight including fuel, vehicle tool kit, spare wheel, installed accessories, vehicle occupants and luggage/cargo. The gross load limit and the gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR) for your vehicle must never be exceeded. The gross load limit and the GVWR are specified on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar of the driver's door (Y page 342). The load must also be distributed so that the weight on each axle never exceeds the gross axle weight rating (GAWR) for the front and rear axles. The specifications for GVWR and GAWR are on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar of the driver's door (Y page 342). Further information can be found in the "Loading the vehicle" section (Y page 322). Observe the following notes when transporting a load: RPosition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the cargo compartment as possible.

i Transport loads when possible in the cargo compartment. You should only use the cargo compartment enlargement if the load does not fit in the cargo compartment. RAlways place the load against the front or rear seat backrests.

256 Loading guidelines St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

If the rear bench seat is not occupied: X Insert the belt tongue on the outer seat belts into the buckle of opposite seat belt:.

X Secure the load with sufficiently strong and wear-resistant tie downs.

X Pad sharp edges for protection.

Stowage areas

Stowage space

Important safety notes

G WARNING To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when storing objects in the vehicle. Put luggage or cargo in the cargo compartment if possible. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the seat backrests. Keep compartment lids closed. This will help to prevent stored objects from being thrown about and injuring vehicle occupants during Rbraking Rvehicle maneuvers Ran accident

Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 256).

Stowage compartments in the front

Glove box

X Toopen: pull handle: and open glove box flap;.

X To close: fold glove box flap; upwards until it engages.

1 Glove box unlocked 2 Glove box locked X To lock:(Y page 70) insert the mechanical key into the lock and turn it 90 clockwise to position2.

X To unlock:(Y page 70) insert the mechanical key into the lock and turn it 90 counter-clockwise to position1.

i The glove box can only be locked and unlocked using the mechanical key.

Stowage areas 257

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest/in the center console

: Small stowage compartment ; Release button for the armrest

Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest X To open: press button;. X Fold up armrest. i In the stowage compartment, there is a stowage tray.

X To close: fold the armrest down. The armrest engages audibly.

Stowage space in the rear

Stowage pockets G WARNING Storage bags are intended for storing light- weight items only. Heavy objects, objects with sharp edges or fragile objects may not be transported in the storage bag. In an accident, during hard braking, or sudden maneuvers, they could be thrown around inside the vehicle and cause injury to vehicle occupants. Storage bags cannot protect transported goods in the event of an accident.

The stowage pockets are located on the rear side of the front seats.

Stowage nets

G WARNING Stowage nets are only intended for transporting light loads such as road maps, mail, etc. Do not use stowage nets to transport heavy, bulky, sharp-edged or fragile objects. In an accident, during hard braking or during a change of direction, they could be thrown around inside the vehicle and cause injury to vehicle occupants. Stowage nets cannot protect the transported loads in the event of an accident.

The stowage net is in the front-passenger footwell.

Cargo compartment enlargement

Important safety notes

G WARNING Always lock the seat backrest in its upright position when the rear seat bench is occupied, or the extended cargo volume is not in use. Check for secure locking by pushing and pulling on the seat backrest. In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose itemswill be thrown around inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items are securely fastened in the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when transporting cargo.

G WARNING Failure to assure that the seat bench and seat backrests are locked into place could result in an increased chance of injury in an accident. Never place hands under seat or near any moving parts while a seat is being adjusted.

258 Stowage areas St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

For safety reasons, the rear seat bench must only be adjusted when the vehicle is stationary. Never drive a vehicle with the tailgate open. Deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death.

! Ensure that you remove all containers from the cup holder in the rear before folding the seat backrest and the seat cushion of the rear bench seat forwards.

Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 256). The rear bench seat is split symmetrically. The left-hand and right-hand rear seats can be folded down to increase the cargo compartment capacity. The following changes are possible: Rfold the seat backrests forward Rfold the rear bench seat back fully

Folding the seat backrest forward

To fold forward the seat backrests, proceed as follows: X Open the rear doors. This allows you better access to release lever:.

X Remove the center head restraint (Y page 88).

X Pull catch: in the direction of the arrow. The corresponding rear seat backrest is not engaged.

X Fold the backrest forwards. The rear seat backrest engages audibly.

; Backrest folded forward

Folding the seat backrest back ! Make sure that the seat belt does not become trapped when folding the rear seat backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.

X Pull release lever:. The corresponding seat backrest is released.

X Fold backrest; backwards in the direction of the arrow. The seat catch engages audibly.

X Install the head restraint (Y page 88).

Stowage areas 259

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

Rear bench seat

Folding the rear bench seat forward

X Fold rear seat backrest (Y page 259) forwards.

X Pull catch: in the direction of the arrow. The corresponding rear bench seat is released.

X Fold rear bench seat; forwards.

; Rear bench seat folded forward

Folding the rear bench seat into an upright position G WARNING If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat backrest are not engaged they could fold forwards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the event of an accident. RThe vehicle occupant would thereby be pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The seat belt can no longer offer the intended

level of protection and could even cause injuries. RObjects or loads in the trunk/cargo compartment cannot be restrained by the seat backrest.

There is an increased risk of injury. Before every trip, make sure that the seat backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat are engaged.

X Fold the rear bench seat back. The seat catch engages audibly.

X Fold the backrest backwards (Y page 259).

X Install the head restraints (Y page 88).

Securing cargo

Important safety notes Distribute the load on the cargo tie-down rings evenly. Do not tamper with or repair cargo tie-down point, cargo tie down rings or tie downs. Have maintenance work as well as modifications, installations and conversions carried out at a qualified specialist workshop (Y page 24). Observe the following notes on securing loads: RSecure the load using the cargo tie-down rings. RDo not use elastic straps or nets to secure a load, as these are only intended as an anti-slip protection for light loads. RDo not route tie-downs across sharp edges or corners. RPad sharp edges for protection. ROnly use tie downs that have been checked in accordance with applicable standards, e.g. lashing nets or lashing straps. RFill the spaces between the load and the cargo compartment walls and the wheel mountings in a form-locking way. Only use dimensionally stable transportation aids

260 Stowage areas St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

for this, such as chocks, wooden fixings or padding.

Cargo tie-down rings in the cargo compartment

There are four cargo tie down rings: in the cargo compartment mounted at the sides.

Cargo compartment cover

Important safety notes ! When loading the vehicle, make sure that you do not stack the load in the cargo compartment higher than the lower edge of the side windows. Do not place heavy objects on top of the cargo compartment cover.

The cargo compartment cover is located behind the rear bench seat backrest.

Opening and closing the cargo compartment cover

X To open: pull cargo compartment cover: back and clip it into the retainers on the left and right of the rear door.

X To close: unclip cargo compartment cover: and guide it forwards until it is completely rolled up.

Installing/removing the cargo compartment cover

X To remove: make sure that cargo compartment cover; is rolled up.

X Slide catches: on the left-hand and right- hand sides of cargo compartment cover; towards the center of the vehicle.

X Swing cargo compartment cover; up and out.

X To install: slide catches: towards the center of the vehicle.

X Insert cargo compartment cover; into the recesses in the side trim.

X Push down the right-hand and left-hand sides of cargo compartment cover; until it engages.

X Slide catches: in the direction of the side trim.

Roof carrier

G WARNING Do not load items on the roof. It may cause instability during some maneuvers which could result in an accident.

Stowage areas 261

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

The roof is not suited for transporting loads. Do not use the roof rails or other accessories which are mounted on the roof.

Features

Cup holder

Important safety notes

G WARNING In order to help prevent spilling liquids on vehicle occupants and/or vehicle equipment, only use containers that fit into the cup holder. Use lids on open containers and do not fill containers to a height where the contents, especially hot liquids, could spill during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident. Liquids spilled on vehicle occupants may cause serious personal injury. Liquids spilled on vehicle equipment may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. When not in use, keep the cup holder closed. An open cup holder may cause injury to you or others when contacted during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident. Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup holder may come loose during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects thrown around in the vehicle interior may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury.

Cup holder on the center console

X Fold cup holder: all the way up.

Cup holders in the rear compartment ! Ensure that you remove all containers from the cup holder in the rear before folding the seat backrest and the seat cushion of the rear bench seat forwards.

: Cup holders

Sun visors

Overview of sun visors

G WARNING Do not use the vanity mirror while driving. Keep the vanity mirrors in the sun visors closed while the vehicle is in motion. Reflected glare can endanger you and others.

: Sun visor ; Bracket = Mirror cover ? Mirror light

262 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Vanity mirror in the sun visor

: Sun visor ; Bracket = Mirror cover ? Mirror light

Mirror lights? will only function if sun visor: is clipped into bracket;. X Fold down sun visor:. X Fold up mirror cover=. Mirror lights? are switched on automatically.

Glare from the side

: Sun visor ; Bracket = Mirror cover ? Mirror light X Fold down sun visor:. X Pull sun visor: from bracket;. X Swing sun visor: to the side.

Stowage compartment/ashtray

Stowage compartment/ashtray in the center console

: Cover ; Insert

i On new vehicles, insert; is stored in the glove box. Install the insert before using the ashtray.

X To open: press cover: and then release it. The ashtray opens.

X To remove the insert:make sure that the engine is switched off and that the parking brake has been applied to secure the vehicle against rolling away.

X Move the selector lever to N. X Press down cover:. Insert; is released.

X Pull insert; upwards and remove it. X To install the insert: install insert; from above.

X Push insert; down. Insert; audibly engages.

X To close: close cover: fully.

i The ashtray is lit up if the low-beam headlamps are on.

Features 263

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

Ashtray in the rear compartment

X To open: fold cover; out in the direction of the arrow.

X To remove the insert: press retaining lug: and pull insert= upwards and out.

X To install the insert: install insert= from above.

X To close: close cover; fully.

Cigarette lighter

G WARNING When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could: Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle Rbe seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accidentwith vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function

If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned on these parts.

G WARNING Never touch the heating element or sides of the lighter; they are extremely hot. Hold the knob only. Make sure any children traveling with you do not injure themselves or start a fire with the hot cigarette lighter.

! The 12 V socket in the cigarette lighter can be used for accessories (up to a maximum of 180 W), as long as they have the standard socket type for cigarette lighters. Note that the socket in the cigarette lighter can be damaged when connecting accessories, for example by: Rfrequent insertion and removal Rsockets that do not fit correctly A damaged socket can cause the cigarette lighter to stop working.

X Press in cigarette lighter:. Cigarette lighter: will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.

264 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

12 V sockets

General notes ! If you are simultaneously using all three sockets in the vehicle, make sure that you do not exceed the maximum current draw of 45 A. Otherwise, you will overload the fuses.

The sockets can be used for accessories with a maximum current draw of 180 W (15 A) each, e.g. bulbs or chargers for mobile phones. If you use the sockets for long periods when the engine is switched off, the battery may discharge. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.

Socket in the front-passenger footwell

X Lift up the cover of the socket. i The cigarette lighter socket can be also used (Y page 264). This is the case even if the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition lock.

Socket in the rear compartment

The socket is located on the center console in the rear compartment. X Lift up the cover of the socket.

Socket in the cargo compartment

The socket is located in the cargo compartment on the left-hand side, when viewed in the direction of travel, next to the rear door. X Lift up the cover of the socket.

115 V socket

G WARNING The 115 V AC power socket operates on high voltage. Use the 115 V AC power socket in the vehicle with the same caution and care that you would take with power sockets at home. Keep fluids away from the 115 V AC power socket. Do not use liquids or sharp tools to clean the power socket. Keep the cover of the 115 V AC power socket closed

Features 265

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

when not in use. Otherwise, you could suffer an electric shock and be seriously or even fatally injured.

G WARNING Any device that you connect must have a suitable plug and meet U.S. standards. Never pull at a cable to disconnect a plug from a 115VACpower socket. Never use a damaged connection cable. The 115 V AC power socket must never be connected to another 115 V AC power source. Do not use a converter with an earthed plug for the 115 V AC power socket. This could cause serious injury to you and/or other people.

G WARNING If the 115 V AC power socket is damaged or pulled out of the trim, do not use or touch the 115 V AC power socket. The use of a 115 V AC power socket that has been damaged or pulled out of the trim could cause serious injury to you or others.

115 V power socket: provides an AC voltage of 115 V so that small electronic devices can be connected. These devices, such as games consoles, chargers and laptops, should not consume more than a maximum of 150 W altogether.

Requirements for operation of these devices: Rthe 12 V sockets in the rear compartment and the cargo compartment are operational (Y page 265). Rthe plug of the electronic device is plugged into 115 V power socket:. Rthe on-board power supply is within a permissible voltage range. Rthe electronic device's maximum power output does not exceed 150 W.

X Open flap=. X Switch on the ignition. X Insert the plug of the electronic device into 115 V power socket:. Indicator lamp; lights up. If indicator lamp; does not light up, please read the section on malfunctions.

X To turn off: disconnect the plug from 115 V power socket:. Ensure that you do not pull on the cord.

X Close flap=. Possible causes of malfunctions: Rthe on-board power supply is not within a permissible voltage range. Rthe temperature of the DC/AC converter is temporarily too high. Rsome small electronic devices have a constant nominal power of less than 150 W, but a very high switch-on current. In that case, there is a possibility that these devices will not function properly as 115 V socket: is not able to provide a high enough current.

X If indicator lamp; still does not light up, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

mbrace

Important safety notes ! You must have a license agreement to activate the mbrace service. Ensure that your system is activated and ready for use,

266 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

and press the E MB Info call button to register. If one of these steps is not carried out, it may not be possible to activate the system. If you have questions about the activation, contact one of the following telephone hotlines: RUSA: Response Center at 1-888-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367

USA only: shortly after successfully registering with the mbrace service a user ID and password will be sent to you by post. You can use this password to log onto the mbrace area under "Owners Online" at http:// www.mbusa.com. The mbrace system is available if: Rit has been activated and is operational. Activation requires an available mobile phone network, a valid SIM card and a subscription to a security service. Rthe battery is sufficiently charged. Rthe corresponding mobile phone network is available for transmitting data to the Customer Center.

i Determining the location of the vehicle on a map is only possible if there is sufficient GPS reception and the vehicle position can be forwarded to the Customer Center.

The mbrace system To adjust the volume during an mbrace call, proceed as follows: X Press theW orX button on the multifunction steering wheel.

or X Use the COMAND volume control. The mbrace system provides three different services: Rautomatic and manual emergency call RRoadside Assistance call RMB Info call

USA only: you can find further information and a description of all available features under "Owners Online" at http:// www.mbusa.com.

System self-test

G WARNING A malfunction in the system has been detected if one of the following conditions occurs: Rthe indicator lamp in the SOS button does not light up during the system self- diagnosis. Rthe indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance button does not light up during the system self-diagnosis. Rthe indicator lamp in the E information button does not light up during the system self-diagnosis. Rthe indicator lamp in the SOS button, Roadside Assistance button or E information button continues to be lit red after the system self-diagnosis. Rthe Tele Aid inoperative or Tele Aid not activated message appears on the multifunction display after the system self- diagnosis.

If amalfunction is indicated as outlined above, the system may not operate as expected. In the event of an emergency, assistance must be summoned by other means. Have the system checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or contact the following service hotlines: RUSA: Response Center at 1-888-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367

After you have switched on the ignition, the system carries out a self-diagnosis.

Features 267

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

Emergency call

Important safety notes G WARNING If the indicator lamp in the SOS button is flashing continuously and there was no voice connection to the Response Center established, then the mbrace system could not initiate an emergency call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not available). The message Call Failed appears in the multifunction display for approximately 10 seconds. Should this occur, assistance must be summoned by other means.

! You must have a license agreement to activate the mbrace service. Ensure that your system is activated and ready for use, and press the E MB Info call button to register. If one of these steps is not carried out, it may not be possible to activate the system. If you have questions about the activation, contact one of the following telephone hotlines: RUSA: Response Center at 1-888-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367

An emergency call is dialed automatically if an air bag or Emergency Tensioning Device is triggered.

i An automatically dialed mbrace emergency call cannot be canceled.

An emergency call can also be initiated manually. As soon as the emergency call has been initiated, the indicator lamp in the SOS button flashes. The Connecting Call message appears on the multifunction display. COMAND is muted.

Once the connection has been made, the Call Connected message appears in the multifunction display. All important information on the emergency is provided, for example: RCurrent location of the vehicle (as determined by the GPS system) RVehicle model RVehicle color RVehicle identification number A short time after the emergency call is initiated, a voice connection is automatically established between the Response Center and the vehicle occupants. If the vehicle occupants are able to respond, the Response Center will attempt to obtain more detailed information on the emergency.

i If there is no response from the vehicle occupants, an ambulance is immediately sent to the vehicle.

Making an emergency call G WARNING If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in the vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle, vehicle in a dangerous road location), please do not wait for voice contact after you have pressed the SOS button. Carefully leave the vehicle and move to a safe location. The Response Center will automatically contact local emergency officials with the vehicle's approximate location if they receive an automatic SOS signal and cannot make voice contact with the vehicle occupants.

268 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

X To initiate an emergency call manually: press cover: briefly to open.

X Press SOS button; briefly. The indicator lamp in SOS button; flashes until the emergency call is concluded.

X Wait for the voice connection with the Response Center.

X After the emergency call, close cover:.

Roadside Assistance button

X Open the stowage compartment under the armrest (Y page 258).

X Press Roadside Assistance button: for more than two seconds. A call to a Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative is initiated. Indicator lamp; in Roadside Assistance button: flashes while the call is active. The Connecting Callmessage appears in the multifunction display and the COMAND system is muted.

If a connection can be made, the Call Connected message appears in the multifunction display. If a mobile phone network is available and there is sufficient GPS reception, the mbrace system transmits data to the Response Center, for example: RCurrent location of the vehicle RVehicle identification number

RVehicle model RVehicle color

i The COMAND display shows that an mbrace call is active. You can switch to the navigationmenu during the call by pressing the NAVI button on COMAND. Voice output is not available.

A voice connection is established between the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative and the vehicle occupants. The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative either sends a qualified Mercedes-Benz technician or makes arrangements for your vehicle to be transported to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. You may be charged for services such as repair work and/or towing. Further details are available in your mbrace manual. X Describe the type of assistance needed. i If the indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance button: is flashing continuously and no voice connection with the Response center has been established, then the mbrace system has not been able to initiate a Roadside Assistance call (e.g. the relevant mobile phone network is not available). The Call Failed message appears in the multifunction display.

X To end a call: press the~ button on the multifunction steering wheel.

or X Press the corresponding button for ending a phone call on COMAND.

i Sign and drive services1: you are not charged for services such as jump-starting, providing a few gallons of fuel for a fuel tank that has been run dry or changing a faulty tire with the vehicle's own spare wheel.

1 USA only.

Features 269

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

MB Info call button

X Open the stowage compartment under the armrest (Y page 258).

X Press Roadside Assistance button: for more than two seconds. A call to a Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative is initiated. Indicator lamp; in Roadside Assistance button: flashes while the call is active. The Connecting Callmessage appears in the multifunction display and the COMAND system is muted.

If a connection can be made, the Call Connected message appears in the multifunction display. If a mobile phone network is available and there is sufficient GPS reception, the mbrace system transmits data to the Response Center, for example: RCurrent location of the vehicle RVehicle identification number RVehicle model RVehicle color

i The COMAND display shows that an mbrace call is active. You can switch to the navigationmenu during the call by pressing the NAVI button on COMAND. Voice output is not available.

A voice connection between the Response Center and the vehicle occupants is established. You can obtain information on how to operate your vehicle's systems, on the

location of the nearest authorized Mercedes- Benz Center, and on further products and services offered by Mercedes-Benz USA. You can find further information on the mbrace system at http:// www.mbusa.com2 Log in under "Owners Online".

i If the indicator lamp in MB Info call button: is flashing continuously and no voice connection with the Response center has been established, then the mbrace system has not been able to initiate an MB Info call (e.g. the relevant mobile phone network is not available). The Call Failed message appears in the multifunction display.

X To end a call: press the~ button on the multifunction steering wheel.

or X Press the corresponding button for ending a phone call on COMAND.

Call priority When service calls are active, e.g. Roadside Assistance or MB Info calls, an emergency call can still be initiated. In this case, an emergency call has the highest priority and takes precedence over all other active calls. The indicator lamp of the respective button flashes until the call is ended. An emergency call can only be terminated by the Response Center. All other calls can be ended by pressing the~ button on the multifunction steering wheel or the corresponding COMAND button for ending a telephone call.

i When an mbrace call has been initiated, COMAND is muted. The mobile phone is no longer connected to COMAND. However, if you want to use your mobile phone, we recommend that you do this only when the vehicle is stationary and in a safe location.

2 USA only.

270 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Downloading destinations in COMAND Destination Download gives you access to a database with over ten million points of interest (POIs) which can be downloaded onto the navigation system of your vehicle. If you know the destination, you can download the address or obtain the location of points of interest (POIs) or important destinations in the surrounding area. You are prompted to confirm route guidance to the address entered. i Information on the components and operating principles of the COMAND system can be found in the separate COMAND operating instructions.

X Select Yes with the= or; button on COMAND.

X Confirm with the 9 button on COMAND.

The system calculates the route and subsequently starts the route guidance with the address entered.

i If you select No, the address can be stored in the address book.

i The Destination Download function is available if the corresponding mobile phone network is available and data transfer is possible.

Search & Send "Search & Send" is a destination entry service. You can find further information on "Search & Send" in the separate COMAND operating instructions.

Vehicle remote opening If you have unintentionally locked your vehicle (e.g. the SmartKey is inside the vehicle) and a replacement key is not available: X Contact the following service hotlines:

RUSA: Response Center at 1-888-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367

You will be asked for your password. X Return to your vehicle at the time arranged with the Response Center.

X Press the release button on the door handle of the rear door for at least 20 seconds until the indicator lamp in the SOS button (Y page 268) flashes. The Connecting Call message appears on the multifunction display.

Alternatively, the vehicle can be opened via the Internet in the "Owner's Online" section using your identification number and password3.

i Vehicle remote opening is only possible if the corresponding mobile phone network is accessible. The SOS button flashes and the Connecting Callmessage appears in the multifunction display to confirm that the command for vehicle remote unlocking has been received. If the lock cylinder on the rear door is pressed for longer than 20 seconds before receiving authorization for remote unlocking from the Response center, you must wait 15 minutes before you can press the lock cylinder on the rear door again.

Vehicle remote closing The remote closing feature can be used when you have forgotten to lock the vehicle and you are no longer nearby. The vehicle can then be locked by the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center. The vehicle can be remotely locked within four days of the ignition being turned off. X Contact the following service hotlines:

3 USA only.

Features 271

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

RUSA: Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center at 1-800-FOR- MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or 1-888-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367

You will be asked for your PIN. The next time you are inside the vehicle and you switch on the ignition, the Tele Aid Doors Locked Remotely message appears in the multifunction display. USA only: alternatively, the vehicle can be locked via: Rthe Internet, under the "Owners Online" section Rthe telephone application (e.g. iPhone, Blackberry)

To do this, you will need your identification number and password.

i The vehicle remote closing feature is available when the relevant mobile phone network is available and data connection is possible.

Stolen vehicle recovery service If your vehicle has been stolen: X Contact the police. The police will issue an incident report. This report has a number.

X Forward this number to the Response Center together with your PIN. The Response Center will then attempt to covertly contact the mbrace system. The Response Center contacts you and the local law enforcement authority if the vehicle is located. However, only the law enforcement agency is informed of the location of the vehicle.

i If the anti-theft alarm system is active for longer than 30 seconds, mbrace is automatically connected with the Customer Assistance center.

Vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis With the vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis (Vehicle Health Check), the Customer Assistance center can provide improved support for problems with your vehicle. During an existing call, vehicle data is transferred to the Customer Assistance center. The customer service representative can use the received data to decide what kind of assistance is required. You are then, for example, guided to the nearest Mercedes- Benz Service center or a recovery vehicle is called. If vehicle data needs to be transferred during an MB Info call or a Roadside Assistance call, this is initiated by the Customer Assistance center. You will see the Roadside Assistance Connected message in the COMAND display. If the vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis is able to be started, the Request for vehicle diagnosis received. Start vehicle diagnosis? message appears in the display. X Press Yes to confirm the message. X If the Vehicle Diagnosis: Please start ignition message appears: turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.

X If the Please follow the instructions received by phone and move your vehicle into a safe position message appears: follow the instructions of the customer service representative. The message in the display disappears. If you select Cancel, the vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis is canceled completely. The vehicle operating state check begins. Meanwhile, the Vehicle diagnosis activated message appears.

When the check is finished, the Sending vehicle diagnosis data... (Voice connection may be interrupted during data transfer)message appears.

272 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

The vehicle data can now be sent to the Customer Assistance center. X Press OK to confirm the message. The voice connection with the Customer Assistance center is terminated. The Vehicle Diagnosis: Transferring data... message appears. The vehicle data is sent to the Customer Assistance center.

Depending on what the customer service representative agreed with you, the voice connection is re-established after the transfer is complete. If necessary, you will be contacted at a later time by another means, e.g. by e-mail or phone. Further functions of the vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis include, for example: Rtransfer of service data to the Customer Assistance center. If a service is overdue, the COMAND display shows a message about various special offers at your workshop. Rmonthly status information e-mail on oil level, air pressure, maintenance, brakes, etc. If applicable, you will receive information on special offers in the e-mail. USA only: this information can also be called up under "Owners Online" at http:// www.mbusa.com.

Information on the data stored in the vehicle (Y page 25). Information on Roadside Assistance (Y page 22).

Downloading routes Downloading routes allows you to transfer and save predefined routes in the navigation system. To do this, an SD memory card must be inserted into the COMAND system. If no SD memory card is inserted, you must insert the card into the card slot on the COMAND system before saving. A route can be prepared and sent either by a customer service representative or via the

mbrace portal on the Internet. Each route can include up to 20way points. When a route has been received by the navigation system, the 'Route name' has been saved to memory card. Do you want to start route guidance? message appears on the COMAND display. The route is saved to the SD memory card. X To start route guidance: select Yes. An overview of the route is shown in the display. i If you select No, the saved route can be called up later in the navigation menu.

X Select Start. Route guidance is started.

i Downloaded and saved data can be called up again in COMAND. Further information can be found in the "COMAND", "Online and Internet services" and "Download destination/route" sections.

Speed alert You can define the upper speed limit, which must not be exceeded by the vehicle. If this selected speed is exceeded by the vehicle, a message will be sent to the Customer Assistance center. The Customer Assistance center then forwards this information to you. You can select the way in which you receive this information beforehand. Possible options include text message, e-mail or an automated call. The data which is sent to the Customer Assistance center contains the following information: Rthe location where the speed limit was exceeded Rthe time at which the speed limit was exceeded Rthe selected speed limit which was exceeded

Features 273

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

Geo fencing Geo fencing allows you to select areas which the vehicle should not enter or leave. You will be informed if the vehicle crosses the boundaries of the selected areas. You can select the way in which you receive this information beforehand. Possible options include text message, e-mail or an automated call. The area can be determined as either a circle or a polygon with a maximum of ten corners. You can specify up to ten areas simultaneously. Different settings are possible for each area. USA only: these settings can be called up under "Owners Online" at http:// www.mbusa.com. Alternatively, you can trigger an MB Info call and inform the customer service representative that you wish to activate geo fencing. Currently inactive areas can be activated by text message.

Triggering the vehicle alarm With this function, you can trigger the vehicle's panic alarm via text message. An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting flashes. Depending on the setting, the panic alarm lasts five or ten seconds. Afterwards, the alarm switches off.

Brush guard (USA only)

G WARNING The brush guard is designed solely to enhance the appearance of the vehicle and help protect grille and headlamps from minor mishaps, either on or off road. Since the safety characteristics are limited in the event of an accident, brush guard are not intended to prevent injury or damage in the event of an accident. Also observe state and local regulations on installation and use.

Raise and lower the brush guard in an open space with plenty of room.

i If you wish to remove the brush guard, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

Garage door opener

Important safety notes

G WARNING Before programming the integrated remote control to a garage door opener or gate operator, make sure people and objects are out of the way of the device to prevent potential harm or damage. When programming a garage door opener, the door moves up or down. When programming a gate operator, the gate opens or closes. Do not use the integrated remote control with any garage door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. federal safety standards (this includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door that cannot detect an object - signaling the door to stop and reverse - does not meet current U.S. federal safety standards. When programming a garage door opener, park vehicle outside the garage. Do not run the engine while programming the integrated remote control. Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death.

You can use the HomeLink garage door opener integrated into the rear-viewmirror to operate up to three different gate/garage door opener systems.

274 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

i Certain garage door drives are incompatible with the integrated garage door opener. If you have difficulty programming the integrated garage door opener, contact an authorized Mercedes- Benz Center. You can also contact the following service hotlines: RUSA: Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes RCanada: Customer Service at 1-800-387-0100

i USA only: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

i Canada only: This device complies with the RSS-210 Rules of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Programming the remote control

Programming G WARNING Only press the button on the integrated garage door opener if there are no persons or objects present within the sweep of the

garage door. Persons could otherwise be injured as the door moves.

Integrated remote control in the rear-view mirror : Indicator lamp ;=? Transmitter buttons A Garage door remote control B Transmitter button on the garage

door remote control Garage door remote controlA is not part of the garage door opener. i To achieve the best result, insert new batteries in garage door remote control A of your garage door drive before programming.

X Delete the memory of the integrated remote control (Y page 278) before programming it for the first time.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press and hold transmitter button;,= or?. After a short time, indicator lamp: will start flashing. It flashes approximately once per second. i Indicator lamp: flashes immediately the first time that the transmitter button is programmed. If this transmitter button has already been programmed, indicator lamp: will only start flashing at a rate of once a second after 20 seconds have elapsed.

X Continue to hold the transmitter button.

Features 275

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

X Point transmitter buttonA of garage door remote controlB towards the transmitter buttons on the rear-view mirror at a distance of 2 to 12 inches (5 to 30 cm). i The distance between garage door remote controlA and the integrated garage door opener depends on the system of the garage door drive. Several attempts might be necessary. You should test every position for at least 20 seconds before trying another position.

X Keep transmitter buttonB on garage door remote controlA pressed until indicator lamp: starts to flash rapidly. The programming has been successful if indicator lamp: flashes rapidly.

X Release transmitter buttons;,= or? on the integrated remote control and transmitter buttonB on the garage door remote control.

If indicator lamp: goes out after approximately 20 seconds and has not flashed rapidly: X Release transmitter buttons;,= or? on the integrated remote control and transmitter buttonB on the garage door remote control.

X Repeat the procedure for the other transmitter buttons. When doing so, vary the distance between the garage door's remote control and the transmitter buttons in the rear-view mirror. i If the garage door system works with a rolling code, you must synchronize the remote control integrated in the rear-view mirror with the garage door system receiver after programming. You will find further information in the garage door opening system's operating instructions, e.g. the sections on "Synchronizing the transmitter" or "Registering a new transmitter". You can also call the hotline mentioned above.

Synchronizing the rolling code

Integrated remote control in the rear-view mirror : Indicator lamp ;=? Transmitter buttons A Garage door remote control B Transmitter button on the garage

door remote control Your vehicle must be within reach of the garage door or exterior gate drive. Make sure that neither your vehicle nor any persons/ objects are present within the sweep of the door or gate. Observe the safety notes when performing the rolling code synchronization (Y page 274). X Turn the SmartKey to position 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press the programming button of the door or gate drive (see the door or gate drive operating instructions, e.g. under "Programming of additional remote controls"). i Usually, you now have 30 seconds to initiate the next step.

X Press previously programmed button;, = or? of the integrated garage door opener until the door closes. The rolling code synchronization is then complete.

Notes on programming the remote control Canadian radio frequency laws require a "break" (or interruption) of the transmission

276 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

signals after broadcasting for a few seconds. Therefore, these signals may not last long enough for the integrated remote control to recognize the signal during programming. Comparable with Canadian law, American garage door openers also have a built-in "interruption". If you live in Canada or have difficulties programming the garage door opener (regardless of where you live) when using the programming steps, proceed as follows:

Integrated remote control in the rear-view mirror : Indicator lamp ;=? Transmitter buttons A Garage door remote control B Transmitter button on the garage

door remote control X Keep the transmitter button (;,= or?) depressed until the integrated remote control has been set up successfully.

X At the same time, press transmitter button B of the garage door remote control for two seconds, then release it for two seconds, then press it again for two seconds.

X Repeat this sequence on transmitter buttonB of the garage door remote control until the frequency signal has been saved.

X If the setup procedure is successful, indicator lamp: flashes once slowly and goes out after a few seconds.

X Continue with the other programming steps (see above).

Problems when programming

Integrated remote control in the rear-view mirror : Indicator lamp ;=? Transmitter buttons A Garage door remote control B Transmitter button on the garage

door remote control If you have problems when programming the integrated remote control, please note the following: RCheck the transmitter frequency of garage door remote controlA (which can usually be found on the back of the remote control). The integrated remote control is compatible with devices that have units which operate in the frequency range of 280 to 390 MHz. RReplace the batteries in garage door remote controlA. This increases the probability of garage door remote control A sending a strong and more precise signal to the integrated remote control on the rear-view mirror. RWhen programming, hold garage door remote controlA at varying distances and angles from the transmitter button which you are programming. Try various angles at a distance between 2and 12 inches (5to 30 cm) or at the same angle but at varying distances. RIf there is another garage door remote control for the same device, perform the programming steps again using that garage

Features 277

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

door opener. Before performing these steps, make sure that new batteries have been inserted in the garage door remote control. RAlign the antenna cable of the garage door opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.

Opening/closing the garage door

: Indicator lamp ;=? Transmitter buttons A Garage door remote control B Transmitter button on the garage

door remote control Once programmed, the integrated remote control will assume the function of the garage door system's remote control. Please also read the operating instructions for the garage door system. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press transmitter button;,= or? on the integrated remote control in the rear- view mirror that is programmed to operate the garage door. Garage door system with fixed code: indicator lamp: lights up continuously. Garage door system with rolling code: indicator lamp: flashes briefly and then lights up for approximately two seconds. This is repeated for up to 20 seconds. i The transmitter will transmit a signal for as long as the transmitter button is being pressed. The transmission will be halted

after a maximum of 20 seconds and indicator lamp: will flash. Press the transmitter button again, if necessary.

Clearing the remote control memory

: Indicator lamp ;=? Transmitter buttons A Garage door remote control B Transmitter button on the garage

door remote control X Turn the SmartKey to position 2(Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press and hold transmitter buttons; and? for approximately 20 seconds until indicator lamp: flashes rapidly. The memory is cleared.

i You should clear the remote control memory before selling the vehicle.

Floormat on the driver's side

G WARNING Whenever you are using a floormat,make sure there is enough clearance and that the floormat is securely fastened. The floormat should always be securely fastened using the fastening equipment. Before driving off, check that the floormat is securely in place and adjust it if necessary. A loose floormat could slip and hinder proper functioning of the pedals. Do not place several floormats on top of each other as this may impair pedal movement.

278 Features St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

X Slide the seat backwards. X To install: place the floormat in the footwell.

X Press studs: onto retainers;. X To remove: pull the floormat out of retainers;.

X Remove the floormat.

Features 279

St ow

ag e an d fe at ur es

Z

280

Useful information ............................ 282 Engine compartment ........................ 282 Maintenance ...................................... 286 Care .................................................... 288

281

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Engine compartment

Hood

Important safety notes

G WARNING If the hood is unlatched, it may open up when the vehicle is in motion and block your view. There is a risk of an accident. Never unlatch the hood while driving.

G WARNING Certain components in the engine compartment may be very hot, e.g. the drive system and radiator. Working in the engine compartment poses a risk of injury. If possible, let the drive system cool down and only touch the following described components.

G WARNING Opening the hood when the engine is overheated or when there is a fire in the engine compartment could expose you to hot gases or other service products. There is a risk of injury. Let an overheated engine cool down before opening the hood. If there is a fire in the engine compartment, keep the hood closed and contact the fire department.

G WARNING The engine compartment contains moving components. Certain components, such as the radiator fan, may continue to run or start again suddenly when the ignition is off. There is a risk of injury. If you need to do any work inside the engine compartment: Rswitch off the ignition Rnever reach into the area where there is a risk of danger from moving components, such as the fan rotation area Rremove jewelery and watches Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts

G WARNING The engine is equipped with a transistorized ignition system. Because of the high voltage, it is dangerous to touch any components (ignition coils, spark plug sockets, diagnostic socket) of the ignition system: Rwith the engine running Rwhile starting the engine Rwhen the ignition is switched on and the engine is turned manually

G WARNING When the hood is open and the windshield wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury. Always switch off the windshield wipers and the ignition before opening the hood.

! Make sure that the windshield wipers are not folded away from the windshield. You could otherwise damage the windshield wipers or the hood.

Do not touch the following when the ignition is switched on: Rignition coils Rspark plug connectors Rtest socket

282 Engine compartment M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Opening the hood

The release lever on the hood is in the footwell on the left-hand side of the vehicle when viewed in the direction of travel. X Make sure that the windshield wipers are turned off.

X Pull release lever: on the hood. The hood is released.

X Lift the hood slightly. X Push hood catch handle; in the direction of the arrow and lift the hood.

Closing the hood

G WARNING If the hood is unlatched, it may open up when the vehicle is in motion and block your view. There is a risk of an accident. Never unlatch the hood while driving.

X Lower the hood and let it fall from a height of approximately 8 inches (20 cm).

X Check that the hood has engaged properly. If the hood can be raised slightly, it is not properly engaged. Open it again and close it with a little more force.

Engine oil

Notes on the oil level Depending on your driving style, the vehicle consumes up to 0.9 US qt (0.8 liters) of oil per 600 miles (1000 km). The oil consumption may be higher than this when the vehicle is new or if you frequently drive at high engine speeds.

Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick

Example: oil dipstick

When checking the oil level: Rpark the vehicle on a level surface. Rthe engine should be switched off for approximately five minutes if the engine is at normal operating temperature. Rthe engine should be switched off for at least 30 minutes if the engine is not at operating temperature, e.g. if you only start the engine briefly.

X Pull oil dipstick: out of the dipstick guide tube.

X Wipe off oil dipstick:.

Engine compartment 283

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Z

X Slowly slide oil dipstick: into the guide tube to the stop, and take it out again. If the level is between MIN mark= and MAX mark;, the oil level is correct.

X Add oil if necessary.

Checking the oil level using the on- board computer ! Do not add toomuch oil. adding toomuch engine oil can result in damage to the engine or to the catalytic converter. Have excess engine oil siphoned off.

G 65 AMG: the oil level can be checked using the on-board computer only. On all other models, the oil dipstick must be used to check the engine oil level. When checking the oil level: Rpark the vehicle on a level surface. Rthe engine should be switched off for approximately five minutes if the engine is at normal operating temperature.

X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock.

X Press the& or* button on the steering wheel to select the following message:

The measurement takes a few seconds. You will see one of the following messages in the multifunction display: REngine Oil Level OK RAdd 1.0 qt (Canada: 1.0 liter) to reach maximum oil level. RAdd 1.5 qts (Canada: 1.5 liters) to reach maximum oil level. RAdd 2.0 qts. (Canada: 2.0 liters) to reach maximum oil level.

X Add oil if necessary. If the engine is at normal operating temperature and the Engine oil Reduce oil level display appears, too much oil has been added. X Have excess oil siphoned off. If the Switch on ignition to check engine oil level message appears: X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 139).

If the Observe waiting time message appears: X If the engine is at normal operating temperature: repeat the measurement after about five minutes.

X If the engine is not at normal operating temperature: e.g. if the engine was only started briefly, repeat the measurement after approximately 30 minutes.

If the Engine oil level Not when engine on message appears: X Switch off the engine. X If the engine is at normal operating temperature: wait about five minutes before carrying out the measurement.

X If the engine is not at normal operating temperature: e.g. if the engine was only started briefly, wait approximately 30 minutes before carrying out the measurement.

i If you wish to cancel the measurement, press the* or& button on the multifunction steering wheel.

Adding engine oil

H Environmental note When adding oil, take care not to spill any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is harmful to the environment.

! Only use engine oils and oil filters that have been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the

284 Engine compartment M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

engine oils and oil filters tested and approved in accordance with the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service center. Damage to the engine or exhaust system is caused by the following: Rusing engine oils and oil filters that have not been specifically approved for the service system Rreplacing engine oil and oil filters after the interval for replacement specified by the service system has been exceeded Rusing engine oil additives.

! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is above the "max" mark on the dipstick, too much oil has been added. This can lead to damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. Have excess oil siphoned off.

Example: engine oil cap X Turn cap: counter-clockwise and remove it.

X Add the amount of oil required. Observe the specifications in the on-board computer when doing so or fill carefully to the maximum mark on the oil dipstick. Further information on engine oil (Y page 346). i The difference between the minimum mark and the maximum mark on the oil dipstick is approximately 2.1 US qt (2 l).

X Replace cap: on the filler neck and tighten clockwise. Ensure that the cap locks into place securely.

Additional service products

Checking coolant level

G WARNING The engine cooling system is pressurized, particularly when the engine is warm. When opening the cap, you could be scalded by hot coolant spraying out. There is a risk of injury. Let the engine cool down before opening the cap. Wear eye and hand protection when opening the cap. Open the cap slowly half a turn to allow pressure to escape.

X Park the vehicle on a level surface. Only check the coolant level when the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled down.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 139).

X Check the coolant temperature display in the instrument cluster. The coolant temperature must be below 158 (70 ).

X Slowly turn cap: half a turn counter- clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.

Engine compartment 285

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Z

X Turn cap: further counter-clockwise and remove it. If the coolant is at the level of marker bar = in the filler neck when cold, there is enough coolant in coolant expansion tank;. If the coolant level is approximately 0.6 in (1.5 cm) above marker bar= in the filler neck when warm, there is enough coolant in expansion tank;.

X If necessary, add coolant that has been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.

X Replace cap: and turn it clockwise as far as it will go.

For further information on coolant, see (Y page 348).

Adding washer fluid to the windshield washer system/headlamp cleaning system

G WARNING Windshield washer concentrate is highly flammable. If it comes into contact with hot engine components or the exhaust system it could ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury. Make sure that no windshield washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.

Example: washer fluid reservoir X To open: pull cap: upwards by the tab. X Add the premixed washer fluid. X To close: press cap: onto the filler neck until it engages.

Further information on windshield washer fluid/antifreeze (Y page 349).

Brake fluid level ! If you notice that the brake fluid level in the brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the MIN mark or less, check the brake system immediately for leaks. Also check the thickness of the brake linings. Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Do not add brake fluid. This does not correct the error.

Only check the brake fluid level when the vehicle is on a level surface. If the brake fluid level is between MIN mark: and MAX mark; on the brake fluid reservoir, it is correct.

Maintenance

Service interval display

Service messages Information on the type of service and service intervals (see the separate Maintenance Booklet). You can obtain further information from an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at http://www.mbusa.com (USA only). The ASSYST service interval display informs you of the next service due date. If a service due date has been exceeded, you also hear a warning tone.

286 Maintenance M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

The multifunction display shows a service message for several seconds, e.g.: Service A in 99999 Miles Service A Due Now Service A Exceeded By 99999 Miles Maintaining the time-dependent service schedule: X Before disconnecting the battery, note down the service due date displayed.

or: X After reconnecting the battery, subtract the battery disconnection periods from the service date shown on the display. i The service interval display should not be confused with the4 engine oil level display.

The symbol and the letter indicate which type of service is due: Minor service A Major service B The ASSYST service interval display does not take into account any periods of time during which the battery is disconnected.

Hiding a service message X To hide the service message, press the % back button on the multifunction steering wheel (Y page 31)(Y page 207).

Displaying service messages Use the buttons on themultifunction steering wheel. X Switch on the ignition. X PressV orU to select the standard display menu on the steering wheel (Y page 208).

X Select& or* to select the service interval display. The or service symbol and the service due date are displayed.

Points to remember The specifiedmaintenance interval takes only the normal operation of the vehicle into account. Under arduous operating conditions or increased load on the vehicle, maintenance work must be carried out more frequently, for example: Rregular city driving with frequent intermediate stops Rif the vehicle is primarily used to travel short distances Ruse in mountainous terrain or on poor road surfaces Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods

Under these or similar conditions, have, for example, the air filter, engine oil and oil filter replaced or changed more frequently. Under arduous operating conditions, the tires must be checked more often. Further information can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Fuel/water separator

H Environmental note Dispose of service products in an environmentally responsible manner.

! If you continue driving without having the fuel/water separator serviced, this could cause damage to the engine. Any resulting damage is not covered by the warranty.

If the fuel/water separator needs servicing, the following message appears in the multifunction display:

You will also hear a brief warning tone.

Maintenance 287

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Z

X Visit a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.

Care

General notes

G WARNING Many cleaning products can be hazardous. Some are poisonous, others are flammable. Always follow the instructions on the particular container. Always open your vehicle's doors or windows when cleaning the inside. Never use fluids or solvents that are not designed for cleaning your vehicle. Always lock away cleaning products and keep them out of reach of children.

! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any of the following: Rdry, rough or hard cloths Rabrasive cleaning agents Rsolvents Rcleaning agents containing solvents Do not scrub. Do not touch the surfaces or protective films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice scraper. You could otherwise scratch or damage the surfaces and protective film.

! Do not park the vehicle for an extended period straight after cleaning it, particularly after having cleaned the wheels with wheel cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause increased corrosion of the brake discs and brake pads/linings. For this reason, you should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The vehicle can then be parked.

H Environmental note Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.

Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for retaining the quality in the long term. Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes- Benz.

Exterior care

Automatic car wash

G WARNING Braking efficiency is reduced after washing the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident. After the vehicle has been washed, brake carefully while paying attention to the traffic conditions until full braking power is restored.

! Never clean your vehicle in a Touchless Automatic Car Wash as these use special cleaning agents. These cleaning agents can damage the paintwork or plastic parts.

! Make sure that the automatic car wash is suitable for the size of the vehicle. Fold in the exterior mirrors before the vehicle is washed. The exterior mirrors could otherwise be damaged.

! Make sure that the automatic transmission is in positionNwhen washing your vehicle in a tow-through car wash. The vehicle could be damaged if the transmission is in another position.

! Make sure that: Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are closed completely. Rthe blower for the ventilation/heating is switched off (airflow control is turned to position 0/the and buttons are switched off). Rthe windshield wiper switch is at position 0.

The vehicle could otherwise be damaged. You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car wash from the very start.

288 Care M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before cleaning it in an automatic car wash. After using an automatic car wash, wipe off wax from the windshield and the wiper blades. This will prevent smears and reduce wiping noises caused by residue on the windshield.

Washing by hand In some countries, washing by hand is only allowed at specially equipped washing bays. Observe the legal requirements in all countries concerned. When using the vehicle in winter, remove all traces of road salt deposits carefully and as soon as possible. When washing the vehicle underbody, also clean the inside of the wheels. X Do not use hot water and do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight.

X Use a soft sponge to clean. X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.

X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a gentle jet of water.

X Do not point the water jet directly towards the air inlets.

X Use plenty of water and rinse out the sponge frequently.

X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry thoroughly with a chamois.

X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the paintwork.

Power washers

G WARNING The water jet from a circular jet nozzle (dirt blasters) can cause invisible exterior damage to the tires or chassis components. Components damaged in this way may fail unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident. Do not use power washers with circular jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged

tires or chassis components replaced immediately.

! Always maintain a distance of at least 11.8 in (30 cm) between the vehicle and the power washer nozzle. Information about the correct distance is available from the equipment manufacturer. Move the power washer nozzle around when cleaning your vehicle. Do not aim directly at any of the following: Rtires Rdoor gaps, roof gaps, joints, etc. Relectrical components Rbattery Rconnectors Rlights Rseals Rtrim Rventilation slots Damaged seals or electrical components can lead to leaks or failures.

Cleaning the wheels ! Donot use acidicwheel cleaning products to remove brake dust. This could damage wheel bolts and brake components.

! Do not park the vehicle for an extended period straight after cleaning it, particularly after having cleaned the wheels with wheel cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause increased corrosion of the brake discs and brake pads/linings. For this reason, you should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The vehicle can then be parked.

Cleaning the paintwork ! Do not affix: Rstickers Rfilms Rmagnetic plates or similar items

Care 289

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Z

to painted surfaces. You could otherwise damage the paintwork.

Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop. X Remove dirt immediately, where possible, while avoiding rubbing too hard.

X Soak insect remains with insect remover and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.

X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.

X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin, oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or lighter fluid.

X Use tar remover to remove tar stains. X Use silicone remover to remove wax. If water no longer forms "beads" on the paint surface, use the paint care products recommended and approved by Mercedes- Benz. This is the case approximately every three to five months, depending on the climate conditions and the care product used. If dirt has penetrated the paint surface or if the paint has become dull, the paint cleaner recommended and approved by Mercedes- Benz should be used. Do not use these care products in the sun or on the hood while the hood is hot. X Use a suitable touch-up stick, e.g. MB Touch-Up Stick, to correct smaller areas of paint damage quickly and provisionally.

Matte finish care ! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy wheels. Polishing causes the finish to shine.

! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or polishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g. wax. These products are only suitable for high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles

with matte finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas). Always have paintwork repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax treatment under any circumstances.

If your vehicle has a clear matte finish, observe the following instructions in order to avoid damage to the paintwork due to incorrect care. These notes also apply to light alloy wheels with a clear matte finish.

i The vehicle should preferably be washed by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo and plenty of water.

i Use only insect remover and car shampoo from the range of recommended and approved Mercedes-Benz care products.

Cleaning the windows

G WARNING You could become trapped by the windshield wipers if they start moving while cleaning the windshield or wiper blades. There is a risk of injury. Always switch off the windshield wipers and the ignition before cleaning the windshield or wiper blades.

! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products, solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do not touch the insides of the windows with hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the windows.

! Clean the water drainage channels of the windshield and the rear window at regular intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This can lead to corrosion damage and damage to electronic components.

290 Care M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

X Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning product that is recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.

Cleaning wiper blades

G WARNING You could become trapped by the windshield wipers if they start moving while cleaning the windshield or wiper blades. There is a risk of injury. Always switch off the windshield wipers and the ignition before cleaning the windshield or wiper blades.

! Do not pull the wiper blade. Otherwise, the wiper blade could be damaged.

! Do not clean wiper blades too often and do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the graphite coating could be damaged. This could cause wiper noise.

! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding back. The windshield could be damaged if the wiper arm smacks against it suddenly.

X Fold the windshield wiper arms away from the windshield.

X Carefully clean the wiper blades with a damp cloth.

X Fold the windshield wiper arms back again before switching on the ignition.

Cleaning the headlamps ! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths which are suitable for plastic headlamp lenses. Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning cloths could scratch or damage the plastic headlamp lenses.

X Clean the headlamp lenses with a damp sponge and a mild cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning cloths.

Cleaning the sensors ! If you clean the sensors with a power washer, make sure that you keep a distance of at least 11.8 in (30 cm) between the vehicle and the power washer nozzle. Information about the correct distance is available from the equipment manufacturer.

X Clean sensors: of the driving systems with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.

Cleaning the rear view camera ! Do not clean the camera lens and the area around the rear view camera with a power washer.

Care 291

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Z

X Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean camera lens:.

Cleaning chrome parts ! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acid- based cleaning agents such as sanitary cleansers or wheel cleaners.

Impurities combined with the effects of road grit and corrosive environmental factors may cause flash rust to form on the surface. You can restore the original shine of the chrome parts by cleaning them regularly, especially in winter and after washing. X Clean the chrome parts with a chrome care product tested and approved byMercedes- Benz.

Interior care

Cleaning the display ! For cleaning, do not use any of the following: Ralcohol-based thinner or gasoline Rabrasive cleaning agents Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents

These may damage the display surface. Do not put pressure on the display surface when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.

X Before cleaning the display, make sure that it is switched off and has cooled down.

X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfiber cloth and TFT/LCD display cleaner.

X Dry the display surface using a dry microfiber cloth.

Cleaning the plastic trim

G WARNING When cleaning the steering wheel boss and dashboard, do not use cockpit sprays or cleaning agents containing solvents. Cleaning agents containing solvents cause the surface to become porous, and as a result, plastic parts may break away and be thrown around the interior when an air bag is deployed, which may result in severe injuries.

! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces: Rstickers Rfilms Rscented oil bottles or similar items You can otherwise damage the plastic.

! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent or sunscreen to come into contact with the plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality look of the surfaces.

X Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfiber cloth.

X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning products recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz. The surface may change color temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.

Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or selector lever X Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes- Benz.

292 Care M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Cleaning genuine wood and trim strips ! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the surface.

! Do not use chrome polish for trim strips. The trim strips have a chrome look but are mostly made of anodized aluminum and can lose their shine if chrome polish is used. Use a damp, lint-free cloth instead when cleaning the trim strips. If the chrome-plated trim strips are very dirty, you can use a chrome polish. If you are unsure as to whether the trim strips are chrome-plated or not, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

X Wipe the wooden trim and trim strips with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfiber cloth.

X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning products recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.

Cleaning the seat covers

General notes ! Do not use microfiber cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA covers. If used often, these can damage the cover.

i Note that regular care is essential to ensure that the appearance and comfort of the covers is retained over time.

Genuine leather seat covers ! To retain the natural appearance of the leather, observe the following cleaning instructions: RClean genuine leather covers carefully with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth. RMake sure that the leather does not become soaked. It may otherwise become rough and cracked. ROnly use leather care agents that have been tested and approved by Mercedes- Benz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.

Leather is a natural product. It exhibits natural surface characteristics, for example: Rdifferences in the texture Rsigns of stretching and marking Rslight nuances of color These are characteristics of leather and not material defects.

Seat covers of other materials ! Observe the following when cleaning: RClean artificial leather coverswith a cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid). RClean cloth covers with a microfiber cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid). Rub carefully and always wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines. Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and how long it has been there. RClean Alcantara covers with a damp cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines.

Care 293

M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Z

Cleaning the seat belts

G WARNING Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash, they may not be able to provide adequate protection.

! Donot clean the seat belts using chemical cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts by heating at temperatures above 176 (80 ) or in direct sunlight.

X Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.

Cleaning the headliner and carpets X Headliner: if it is very dirty, use a soft brush or dry shampoo.

X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.

294 Care M ai nt en an ce

an d ca re

Useful information ............................ 296 Where will I find...? ........................... 296 Flat tire .............................................. 298 Battery (vehicle) ................................ 299 Jump-starting .................................... 303 Towing and tow-starting .................. 305 Fuses .................................................. 308

295

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Where will I find...?

Warning triangle

Setting up the warning triangle

: Press-stud ; Reflectors = Feet X Fold feet= down and out to the side. X Pull side reflectors; up to form a triangle and lock them at the top using press- stud:.

First-aid kit i Check the expiration date on the first-aid kit at least once a year. Replace the contents if necessary, and replace missing items.

Vehicle tool kit

General notes i When they leave the factory, vehicles are not equipped with the tools needed to change a wheel, such as a jack or lug wrench. Some tools for changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle. To obtain tools approved for your vehicle, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

The vehicle tool kit contains: RVehicle tool kit bag with:

- a fuse extractor - an Allen key, e.g. to operate the sliding roof manually in an emergency

- a pump lever for the vehicle jack - a screwdriver - Lug wrench RJack

Vehicle tool kit

The vehicle tool kit is under the cover in the footwell in front of the rear bench seat. X Fold cover: to the side. X Pull vehicle tool kit; out by the tab.

Jack ! Make sure that, while installing the vehicle jack, there are no cables on the holder, in order to avoid them becoming trapped.

296 Where will I find...? Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

The jack is located under the rear bench seat on the right-hand side when viewed in the direction of travel. X Fold rear bench seat (Y page 260) forwards.

X Open cover:. X Pull bar= upwards and detach from tab?.

X Remove jack;.

Exterior spare wheel bracket

General notes

G WARNING If the spare tire is more than 6 years old or is not the same model as the regular tires, have the spare tire replaced with a new tire at the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center. Never operate the vehicle with more than one spare wheel mounted.

G WARNING The wheel or tire size as well as the tire type of the spare wheel or emergency spare wheel and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Mounting an emergency spare wheel may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of an accident.

To avoid hazardous situations: Radapt your driving style accordingly and drive carefully. Rnever mount more than one spare wheel or emergency spare wheel that differs in size. Ronly use a spare wheel or emergency spare wheel of a different size briefly. Rdo not switch ESP off. Rhave a spare wheel or emergency spare wheel of a different size replaced at the nearest qualified specialist workshop. Observe that the wheel and tire dimensions as well as the tire type must be correct.

You must not exceed the maximum speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) when using spare wheels of differing sizes.

i When changing a wheel, you should also observe the safety notes in the "Flat tire" section (Y page 334).

The spare wheel is on the outer side of the rear door.

Stainless-steel spare hub cap

X Take the screwdriver out of the vehicle tool kit (Y page 296).

X Open the lock on cover ring: with screwdriver= or a similar tool.

X Fold tab; down.

Where will I find...? 297

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

X Pull cover ring: apart and remove it. X Pull off cover panel?.

i When re-installing cover panel?, make sure that retainerA engages in recess B.

Removing the spare wheel The sparewheel is heavy. Take particular note of this when removing the spare wheel.

X Remove wheel nuts:. X Remove the spare wheel.

Mounting the wheel After changing a wheel: X Repair or replace the damaged wheel as soon as possible and secure the spare wheel in place again.

X Secure the damaged wheel on the spare wheel bracket with wheel nuts:. When doing so, make sure that the wheel cannot come loose.

X When re-installing cover panel?, make sure that retainerB engages in recess A(Y page 297).

X Make sure that tab; is below when re- installing cover ring:(Y page 297).

X For safety reasons, regularly check to ensure that the wheel is securely fastened.

Flat tire

Preparing the vehicle X Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and level ground, as far away as possible from traffic.

X Switch on the hazard warning lamps (Y page 104).

X Apply the parking brake. X Bring the front wheels into the straight- ahead position.

X Move the selector lever to position P. X Switch off the engine. X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. The steering wheel lock stays active for as long as the SmartKey is removed.

X All occupants must get out of the vehicle. Make sure that they are not endangered as they do so.

X Make sure that no one is near the danger area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the wheel change should, for example, stand behind the barrier.

298 Flat tire Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.

X Close the driver's door.

Battery (vehicle)

Important safety notes Special tools and expert knowledge are required when working on the battery, e.g. removal and installing. You should therefore have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

G WARNING Work carried out incorrectly on the battery can lead, for example, to a short circuit and thus damage the vehicle electronics. This can lead to function restrictions applying to safety-relevant systems, e.g. the lighting system, ABS (anti-lock braking system) or ESP (Electronic Stability Program). The operating safety of your vehicle may be restricted. You could lose control of the vehicle, for example: Rbraking Rin the event of abrupt steering maneuver and/or when the vehicle's speed is not adapted to the road conditions

There is a risk of an accident. In the event of a short circuit or a similar incident, contact a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Do not drive any further. You should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

If ABS malfunctions, the wheels can lock during braking. This limits the steerability of the vehicle when braking and may increase the braking distance. If ESP malfunctions, the vehicle will not be stabilized if it starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin.

G WARNING Work carried out incorrectly on the battery can, for example, lead to a short circuit and damage your vehicle's electronic system. This can disrupt driving safety systems such as ABS (anti-lock braking system) or ESP (Electronic Stability Program). RIf ABS malfunctions, the wheels can lock during braking. This limits the steerability of the vehicle when braking and the braking distance may increase. There is a risk of accident. RIf ESPmalfunctions, the vehicle will not be stabilized if it starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin. There is a risk of accident.

You should therefore have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.

G WARNING During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion. RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts. RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery. RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting and disconnecting a battery. RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected. RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting the jumper cables. RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.

G WARNING Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation of sparks, which could ignite the highly

Battery (vehicle) 299

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an explosion. Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle body to remove any existing electrostatic build-up.

G WARNING Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek medical attention.

! Have the battery checked regularly at a qualified specialist workshop. Observe the service intervals in the Maintenance Booklet or contact a qualified specialist workshop for more information.

! You should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. In the exceptional case that it is necessary for you to disconnect the battery yourself, make sure that: Ryou switch off the engine and remove the SmartKey. Check that all the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster are off. Otherwise, electronic components, such as the alternator, may be damaged. Ryou first remove the negative terminal clamp and then the positive terminal clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps. Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system may be damaged. Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, the transmission is locked in position P after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You can then no longer move the vehicle.

The battery and the cover of the positive terminal clamp must be installed securely during operation.

H Environmental note Batteries contain dangerous substances. It is against the law to dispose of them with the household rubbish. They must be collected separately and recycled to protect the environment. Dispose of batteries in an environmentally friendly manner. Take discharged batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or a special collection point for used batteries.

In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be sufficiently charged. Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.

Risk of explosion.

Fire, open flames and smoking are prohibited when handling the battery. Avoid creating sparks.

Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing. Wear eye protection.

Keep children away.

Observe this Operator's Manual.

The vehicle battery, like other batteries, can discharge over time if you do not use the vehicle. In this case, have the battery

300 Battery (vehicle) Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop. You can also charge the battery with a charger recommended by Mercedes- Benz. Contact a qualified specialist workshop for further information. Explosive gases are created during charging and jump-starting. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have been tested and approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns should the battery be damaged in the event of an accident. Have the battery condition of charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short trips or if you leave it standing idle for a lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle parked for a long period of time.

i Remove the SmartKey if you park the vehicle and do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little energy, thus conserving battery power.

i If the power supply has been interrupted, e.g. due to a discharged battery, you will have to: Rset the clock. Information on setting the clock can be found in the separate operating instructions. On vehicles with COMAND and a navigation system, the clock is set automatically. Rreset the head restraints on the front seats (Y page 87) Rreset the function for folding the exterior mirrors in/out automatically, by folding the mirrors out once (Y page 93).

Charging the battery

G WARNING During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion. Particularly avoid fire, open flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.

G WARNING Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek medical attention.

G WARNING A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion. Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.

! Only charge the battery using the jump- starting connection point.

! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.

! Only charge the installed battery with a battery charger which has been tested and approved byMercedes-Benz. These battery chargers allow the battery to be charged while still installed in the vehicle.

A battery charger unit specially adapted for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and tested and approved byMercedes-Benz is available as an accessory. Contact an authorized Mercedes- Benz Center for information and availability. Charge the battery in accordance with the operating instructions for the battery charger.

Battery (vehicle) 301

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

The jump-starting connection point is in the engine compartment (Y page 303). X Read the operating instructions for the battery charger.

X Open the hood (Y page 283). X Connect the battery charger to the positive terminal and ground point in the same order as when connecting the donor battery in the jump-starting procedure (Y page 303).

302 Battery (vehicle) Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Jump-starting

G WARNING Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek medical attention.

G WARNING During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion. Particularly avoid fire, open flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.

G WARNING During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion. RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts. RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery. RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting and disconnecting a battery. RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected. RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting the jumper cables. RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.

G WARNING A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion. Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.

G WARNING Non-combusted fuel can collect in the exhaust system and ignite. There is a risk of fire. Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts.

! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter and create a risk of fire. Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. Make sure the jumper cables are not damaged. Make sure the jumper cables are not touching any other metal objects when they are connected to the battery.

Jump-starting 303

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at temperatures around or below freezing point, the discharged battery is likely to be frozen (a commonplace scenario). In this case, do not jump-start the vehicle or recharge the battery. Once the battery has thawed out, its service life may be dramatically reduced. The starting characteristics can be impaired, particularly at low temperatures. It is recommended that you have the thawed out battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Do not start the vehicle using a rapid charging device. If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jumper cables. Observe the following points: RThe battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible, jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device. RVehicles with a gasoline engine: only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust system are cold. RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first. RJump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V. ROnly use jumper cables which have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps. RIf the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little. RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch. Make sure that: Rthe jumper leads are not damaged. Rwhen the jumper cables are connected to the battery, uninsulated sections of the terminal clamp do not come into contact with other metal sections. RThe jumper cables cannot come into contact with parts such as the pulley or the fan. These parts move when the engine is started and while it is running.

X Apply the parking brake. X Move the selector lever to position P. X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g. radio, blower, etc.). X Open the hood (Y page 283).

304 Jump-starting Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Position numberB identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jump- starting device. The jump-start terminal point consists of terminals; and?. X Lift up cover: of positive terminal; in the direction of the arrow. X Connect positive terminal; on your vehicle to positive terminal? of donor batteryB using the jumper cable. beginning with your own battery.

X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed. X Connect negative terminalA of donor batteryB to ground point= of your vehicle using the jumper cable, connecting the jumper cable to donor batteryB first.

X Start the engine. X First, remove the jumper cable from ground point= and negative terminalA, then from positive terminal; and positive terminal?, each time disconnecting from the battery on your own vehicle first.

X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.

i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.

i Jumper cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop.

Towing and tow-starting

Important safety notes

G WARNING The vehicle is brakedwhen the HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,

deactivate HOLD and DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle is to be towed.

! The vehicle can be towed a maximum of 30 miles (50km). The towing speed of 30 mph (50 km/h) must not be exceeded.

Towing and tow-starting 305

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

If the vehicle has to be towed more than 30miles (50km), the entire vehicle must be raised and transported.

! Only secure the tow cable or tow bar to the towing eyes. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.

! Do not tow with sling-type equipment. This could damage the vehicle.

! Do not use the towing eyes for recovery purposes as this could damage the vehicle. If in doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.

! When towing, pull away slowly and smoothly. If the tractive power is too high, the vehicles could be damaged.

! Your vehicles is equipped with an automatic transmission. Therefore, you must not have the vehicle tow-started. The transmission may otherwise be damaged.

G WARNING If the weight of the vehicle to be towed or tow- started is greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle: Rthe towing eye could detach itself Rthe vehicle/trailer combination could rollover.

There is a risk of an accident. When towing or tow-starting another vehicle, its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.

Information on your vehicle's gross vehicle weight rating can be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 342). It is better to have the vehicle transported than to have it towed. If the transfer case can be shifted into neutral N, you can tow the vehicle.

If the transfer case cannot be shifted into neutral N, you can tow the vehicle with one axle raised. Please bear the following in mind: Rremove the propeller shaft between the transfer case and the rolling axle. Rturn the SmartKey to position 1 in the ignition lock (Y page 139).

The battery must be connected and charged. Otherwise, you: Rcannot turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 2(Y page 139) Rcannot shift the automatic transmission to position N i Deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 75). You could otherwise be locked out when pushing or towing the vehicle.

Towing eyes

Towing eyes, front

: Towing eyes, front

Towing eye, rear

306 Towing and tow-starting Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Rear towing eye: is located under the bumper, on the left-hand side when viewed in the direction of travel.

Towing a vehicle with both axles on the ground It is important that you observe the safety instructions when towing away your vehicle (Y page 305). X Switch on the hazard warning lamps (Y page 104). i In order to signal a change of direction when towing the vehicle with the hazard warning lamps switched on, use the combination switch as usual. In this case, only the turn signals for the desired direction flash. When you reset the combination switch, the hazard warning lamps start flashing again.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 139).

X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed.

X Shift the transfer case to neutral(Y page 195).

X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.

X Release the brake pedal. X Release the parking brake (Y page 157).

i The transmission can only change gear if the battery has sufficient charge. If you cannot move the selector lever to N, the propeller shafts to the driven axles must be removed.

Transporting the vehicle ! You may only secure the vehicle by the wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as axle or steering components. Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged.

Use the towing eyes to pull the vehicle if it needs to be transported on a trailer or transporter (Y page 306). X Apply the parking brake. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 139).

X Move the selector lever to N. X Shift the transfer case to neutral (Y page 195).

X Secure the towing cable to the towing eyes (Y page 306).

X Make sure that the vehicle cannot roll away.

X Release the parking brake. X Load the vehicle onto the transporter.

As soon as the vehicle has been loaded: X Apply the parking brake. X Shift the automatic transmission to position P.

X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock (Y page 139) and remove it.

X Secure the vehicle.

Recovering a vehicle that has become stuck ! When recovering a vehicle that has become stuck, pull it as smoothly and evenly as possible. Excessive tractive power could damage the vehicles.

If the drive wheels have become stuck in loose or muddy ground, pull the vehicle out with extreme caution, especially so if the vehicle is loaded. Never attempt to recover a stuck vehicle with a trailer attached. Pull out the vehicle backwards, if possible using the tracks it made when it became stuck.

Towing and tow-starting 307

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

Towing in the event of malfunctions

General notes ! If you are removing the propeller shaft, use M10 nuts as spacers on the M8 bolts and secure them with M8 nuts. New self-locking nuts must be used when the propeller shafts are refitted.

X Observe the safety notes as you do so (Y page 305).

i Consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Engine damage, gear damage or electrical malfunctions X Move the selector lever to position N(Y page 145).

X Shift the transfer case to neutral(Y page 195).

In the event of damage to the transfer case Have the propeller shafts between the axles and the transfer case removed.

In the event of damage to the front axle Have the propeller shaft between the rear axle and the transfer case removed. Have the vehicle towed with the front axle raised.

In the event of damage to the rear axle Have the propeller shaft between the front axle and the transfer case removed. Have the vehicle towed with the rear axle raised and with wheel rollers under the front axle.

Tow-starting (emergency engine starting) ! Vehicles with automatic transmission must not be tow-started. You could otherwise damage the automatic transmission.

You can find information on "Jump-starting" under (Y page 303).

Fuses

Important safety notes

G WARNING If you manipulate or bridge a faulty fuse or if you replace it with a fuse with a higher amperage, the electric cables could be overloaded. This could result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident and injury. Always replace faulty fuses with the specified new fuses having the correct amperage.

! Only use fuses that have been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the correct fuse rating for the system concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.

The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions stop operating. Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of the same rating, which you can recognize by the color and value. The fuse ratings are listed in the fuse allocation chart.

i If a fuse has blown, contact a breakdown service or an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

If a newly inserted fuse also blows, have the cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

308 Fuses Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Before changing a fuse X Park the vehicle and apply the parking brake.

X Switch off all electrical consumers. X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster must be off.

The fuses are located in various fuse boxes: RMain fuse box on the driver's side of the dashboard RFuse box in the front-passenger footwell RFuse box in the transmission tunnel RFuse box in the battery case RFuse box in the cargo compartment The fuse allocation chart and the spare fuses are in the main fuse box on the dashboard (Y page 309). You will find the fuse removal device in the vehicle tool kit (Y page 296).

Dashboard fuse box ! Do not use a pointed object such as a screwdriver to open the cover in the dashboard. You could damage the dashboard or the cover.

! Make sure that no moisture can enter the fuse box when the cover is open.

! When closing the cover, make sure that it is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair the operation of the fuses.

X Open the front-passenger door. X To open: pull cover: outwards in the direction of the arrow and remove it.

X To close: clip in cover: on the front of the dashboard.

X Fold cover: inwards until it engages.

Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell ! Make sure that no moisture can enter the fuse box when the cover is open.

! When closing the cover, make sure that it is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair the operation of the fuses.

X Unscrew screws:. X Lift up cover; in the direction of the arrow.

Fuses 309

Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Z

= Fuse box

Fuse box in the transmission tunnel ! Make sure that no moisture can enter the fuse box when the cover is open.

! When closing the cover, make sure that it is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair the operation of the fuses.

X Fold down the cup holder on the center console (Y page 262).

X Adjust the front-passenger seat to its foremost position (Y page 86).

X To open: remove screws:. X Remove cover; in the direction of the arrow.

X To close: clip in cover;. X Install cover; with screws:.

Fuse box in the battery case The fuses in the battery case do not usually need to be replaced. If a fuse change is necessary, consult a qualified specialist workshop.

Fuse box in the cargo compartment ! Make sure that no moisture can enter the fuse box when the cover is open.

! When closing the cover, make sure that it is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair the operation of the fuses.

The fuse box is located under a cover on the left in the cargo compartment.

310 Fuses Br ea kd ow

n as si st an ce

Useful information ............................ 312 Important safety notes .................... 312 Operation ........................................... 313 Winter operation ............................... 314 Tire pressure ..................................... 316 Loading the vehicle .......................... 322 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards .......................................... 326 Tire labeling ....................................... 328 Changing a wheel ............................. 334 Wheel and tire combinations ........... 338

311

W he el s an d tir es

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Important safety notes

G WARNING Replace rims or tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown on the original part. For further information contact an authorizedMercedes-BenzCenter. If incorrectly sized rims and tires are mounted, the wheel brakes or suspension components can be damaged. Also, the operating clearance of the wheels and the tires may no longer be correct.

G WARNING Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread is worn to minimum tread depth, or if the tires have sustained damage, replace them. When replacing rims, only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for the particular rim type. Failure to do so can result in the bolts loosening and possibly an accident. Retreaded tires are not tested or recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous damage cannot always be recognized on retreads. The operating safety of the vehicle cannot be assured when such tires are used.

G WARNING If you notice sudden significant vibrations or unusual handling performance or if you suspect that damage has occurred to the vehicle, you should activate the hazard warning lamps, gently reduce speed and carefully head for an area that is located at a safe distance from the road. Check the tires and the underside of the vehicle for damage. If the vehicle seems unsafe, have the vehicle towed away to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or tire dealer to be repaired.

G WARNING Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You might lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build- up and possibly a fire.

G Warning A flat tire severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident. do not drive with a flat tire. Immediately replace the flat tire with your spare wheel, or consult a qualified specialist workshop.

Consult an authorizedMercedes-Benz Center if you require information on approved and recommended tires and wheels for summer and winter operation. Advice on purchasing and caring for tires is also available there. Accessories that are not approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being used correctly can impair the operating safety. Before purchasing and using non-approved accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and ask about: Rsuitability Rlegal stipulations Rfactory recommendations

312 Important safety notes W he el s an d tir es

Information on the dimensions and types of wheels and tires for your vehicle can be found in the "Wheel/tire combinations" section (Y page 338). Information on air pressure for the tires on your vehicle can be found: Ron the tire pressure label on the fuel filler flap Rin the "Tire pressure" section

i Further information on wheels and tires can be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop.

Operation

Notes on driving If the vehicle is heavily loaded, check the tire pressures and correct them if necessary. When parking your vehicle, make sure that the tires do not get deformed by the curb or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive over curbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try to do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tires, particularly the sidewalls, may be damaged.

Regular checking of wheels and tires

G WARNING Regularly check the tires for damage. Damaged tires can cause tire inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of your vehicle. Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread is worn to minimum tread depth, or if the tires have sustained damage, replace them.

RRegularly check the wheels and tires of your vehicle for damage at least once a month, as well as after driving off-road or on rough roads. Damage includes bulges and deformation on tires, cuts, punctures, cracks or severe corrosion on wheels, for

example. Damaged wheels can cause a loss of tire pressure. RRegularly check the tire tread depth and the condition of the tread across the whole width of the tire (Y page 313). In order to inspect the inner side of the tire surface, turn the steering wheel to full lock. RAll wheels must have a valve cap to protect the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not install anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or a valve cap approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle. Do not install anything onto the valve, such as tire pressure monitoring systems. RYou should regularly check the pressure of all your tires including the spare wheel, particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tire pressure as necessary (Y page 321).

The service life of tires depends, among other things, on the following factors: Rdriving style Rtire pressure Rdistance covered

Tire tread

G WARNING Although the applicable federal motor vehicle safety laws consider a tire to be worn when the treadwear indicators (TWI) become visible at approximately inches (1.6 mm), we recommend that you do not allow your tires to wear down to that level. As tread depth approaches inches (3 mm) the adhesion properties on a wet road are sharply reduced. Depending upon the weather and/or road surface (conditions), the tire traction varies widely.

Operation 313

W he el s an d tir es

Z

Marking: shows the tread wear indicator (TWI). The arrow indicates the placement of the tire tread. Do not drive with tires which have too little tread depth. tire traction onwet road surfaces decreases significantly when the tread depth is less than 1/8 in (3 mm). Treadwear indicators (TWI) are required by law. Six indicators are positioned over the tire tread. They are visible once the tread depth is approximately 1/16 in (1.6mm). If this is the case, the tire is so worn that it must be replaced. The recommended tread depth for summer tires is at least 1/8 in (3 mm). The recommended tread depth for winter tires is at least 1/6 in (4 mm).

Selecting, mounting and replacing tires ROnly mount tires and wheels of the same type and make. ROnly mount approved tires of the correct size onto the wheels. RTires are supplied with a protective layer from the factory. Break in new tires at moderate speeds for the first 60 miles (100 km). They only reach their full performance after this distance.

RDo not drive with tires which have too little tread depth, as this significantly reduces the traction on wet roads (hydroplaning). RReplace the tires after six years at the latest, regardless of wear. This also applies to the spare wheel.

Winter operation

General notes Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified specialist workshop at the onset of winter. Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel" section (Y page 334).

Driving with summer tires At temperatures below 45 (+7), summer tires lose elasticity significantly, and therefore traction and braking power as well. Change the tires on your vehicle to M+S tires. Using summer tires at very cold temperatures could cause cracks to form, thereby damaging the tires permanently. Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility for this type of damage.

M+S tires

G WARNING M+S tires with a tire tread depth of less than in (4 mm) are not suitable for use in winter and do not provide sufficient traction. There is a risk of an accident. M+S tires with a tread depth of less than in (4 mm) must be replaced immediately.

G WARNING The spare wheel and M+S tires have different tire characteristics. Driving characteristics can be severely impaired when youmount the spare wheel. There is a risk of an accident. You should therefore adapt your driving style and drive carefully. Have the spare wheel

314 Winter operation W he el s an d tir es

replaced with a new wheel with an M+S tire at the nearest qualified specialist workshop.

At temperatures below 45 (+7 ), use all- season tires or winter tires. Both types of tire are identified by the M+S marking. Not all tires with theM+Smarking provide the driving characteristics of winter tires. In addition to theM+Smarking, winter tires also have thei snowflake symbol on the tire wall. Tires with this marking fulfill the requirements of the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber Association of Canada (RAC) regarding snow traction, and were specially developed for driving on snow. Only these tires will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP to function optimally in winter, since these tires have been designed specifically for driving on snow. UseM+S tires of the samemake and tread on all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics. Always observe the maximum permissible speed specified for the M+S tires you have mounted. When you have mounted the M+S tires: X Check the tire pressures (Y page 316). X Restart the tire pressure monitor (Y page 321).

i You can obtain information about winter tires that have been approved by Mercedes-Benz especially for your vehicle at any Mercedes-Benz Service center.

i For further information about tires, see (Y page 340).

Snow chains ! Information about the use of snow chain compatible AMG winter tires is applicable for AMG tires. Use of snow chains is only permissible with these tires.

! On some tire sizes there is not enough space for snow chains. To avoid damage to the vehicle or tires, observe the "Wheel and tire combinations" section under "Tires and wheels".

! If snow chains are mounted on the front wheels, the snow chains could grind against the bodywork or components of the chassis. This could result in damage to the vehicle or the tires.

For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that have been specially approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or are of a corresponding standard of quality. ROnly use snow chains when driving on roads completely covered by snow. Remove the snow chains as soon as possible when you come to a road that is not snow-covered. RLocal regulations may restrict the use of snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to mount snow chains. RDo not exceed the maximum permissible speed of 30 mph (50 km/h).

If you intend to mount snow chains, please bear the following points in mind: RSnow chains cannot be mounted on all wheel/tire combinations (Y page 338). RMount snow chains only in pairs and only on the rear wheels. Observe the manufacturer's mounting instructions.

i You can deactivate ESP(Y page 62) when pulling away with snow chains installed. You can thereby allow the wheels to spin in a controlledmanner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting action).

Winter operation 315

W he el s an d tir es

Z

Tire pressure

Tire pressure specifications

Important safety notes

G WARNING Underinflated or overinflated tires pose the following risks: Rthe tires may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase. Rthe tires may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tire traction. Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.

There is a risk of an accident. Follow recommended tire inflation pressures and check the pressure of all the tires including the spare wheel: Rmonthly, at least Rif the load changes Rbefore beginning a long journey Runder different operating conditions, e.g. off-road driving

If necessary, correct the tire pressure.

i The specifications on the sample Tire and Loading Information placard and tire pressure tables are examples. Tire pressure specifications are vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data shown here. The tire pressure specifications that are valid for your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard and tire pressure table on the vehicle.

General notes The recommended tire pressures for the tires mounted at the factory can be found on the labels described here. Operation with a trailer: the applicable value for the rear tires is the maximum tire pressure value stated in the table inside the fuel filler flap.

Further information on tire pressures can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop.

Tire and Loading Information placard

: Recommended tire pressures

The Tire and Loading Information placard is on the B-pillar on the driver's side (Y page 322). The Tire and Loading Information placard contains the recommended tire pressures for cold tires. The recommended tire pressures are valid for the maximum permissible load and up to the maximum permissible vehicle speed.

Tire pressure table

Example: tire pressure table for all tires permitted for this vehicle by the factory

The tire pressure table is on the inside of the fuel filler flap. The tire pressure table contains the recommended pressures for cold tires for various operating conditions, i.e. differing load and speed conditions.

316 Tire pressure W he el s an d tir es

Example: tire pressure table with tire dimensions

If a tire size precedes a tire pressure, the tire pressure information following is only valid for that tire size. The load conditions "partially laden" and "fully laden" are defined in the table for different numbers of occupants and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may differ.

Some tire pressure tables only show the rim diameter instead of the complete tire size, e.g. R16. The rim diameter is part of the tire size and can be found on the tire sidewall (Y page 328). If the tire pressures have been set to the lower values for lighter loads and/or lower road speeds, the pressures should be reset to the higher values: Rif you want to drive with an increased load and/or Rif you want to drive at higher road speeds.

i The tire pressures for increased loads and/or higher road speeds, shown in the tire pressure table, may have a negative effect on driving comfort.

If the tire pressure is not set correctly, this can lead to an excessive build up of heat and a sudden loss of pressure. For more information, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

Important notes on tire pressure

G WARNING If the tire pressure drops repeatedly, the wheel, valve or tire may be damaged. Tire pressure that is too low may result in a tire blow-out. There is a risk of an accident. RCheck the tire for foreign objects. RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the valve is leaking.

If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.

G WARNING If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tire valves, the tire valves may be overloaded and malfunction, which can cause tire pressure loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tire pressure monitors keep the tire valve open. This can also result in tire pressure loss. There is a risk of an accident. Only screw the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle onto the tire valve.

Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the tire pressure. The outer appearance of a tire does not permit any reliable conclusion about the tire pressure. On vehicles equipped with the electronic tire pressure monitoring system, the tire pressure can be checked using the on-board computer. The tire temperature and pressure increase when the vehicle is in motion. This is dependent on the driving speed and the load. Therefore, you should only correct tire pressures when the tires are cold.

Tire pressure 317

W he el s an d tir es

Z

The tires are cold: Rif the vehicle has been parked without direct sunlight on the tires for at least three hours and Rif the vehicle has been driven for less than 1 mile (1.6 km).

The tire temperature changes depending on the outside temperature, the vehicle speed and the tire load. If the tire temperature changes by 18 (10 ), the tire pressure changes by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/ 1.5 psi). Take this into account when checking the pressure of warm tires. Only correct the tire pressure if it is too low for the current operating conditions. If you check the tire pressure when the tires are warm, the resulting value will be higher than if the tires were cold. This is normal. Do not reduce the tire pressure to the value specified for cold tires. The tire pressure would otherwise be too low. Observe the recommended tire pressures for cold tires: Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side Rin the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap

Observe the following for the tire pressure on the spare wheel: Rthe tire and loading information table on the B-pillar on the driver's side. Rthe tire pressure sticker on the inside of the fuel filler flap.

Underinflated or overinflated tires

Underinflation

G WARNING Tires with pressure that is too low can overheat and burst as a consequence. In addition, they also suffer from excessive and/ or irregular wear, which can severely impair the braking properties and the driving characteristics. There is a risk of an accident.

Avoid tire pressures that are too low in all the tires, including the spare wheel.

Underinflated tires may: Roverheat, leading to tire defects Rhave an adverse effect on handling characteristics Rwear quickly and unevenly Rhave an adverse effect on fuel consumption

Overinflation

G WARNING Tires with excessively high pressure can burst because they are damaged more easily by road debris, potholes etc. In addition, they also suffer from irregular wear, which can severely impair the braking properties and the driving characteristics. There is a risk of an accident. Avoid tire pressures that are too high in all the tires, including the spare wheel.

Overinflated tires may: Rincrease the braking distance Rhave an adverse effect on handling characteristics Rwear quickly and unevenly Rhave an adverse effect on ride comfort Rbe more susceptible to damage

Maximum tire pressures

: Example: maximum permissible tire pressure

318 Tire pressure W he el s an d tir es

Never exceed the maximum permissible tire inflation pressure. Always observe the recommended tire pressure for your vehicle when adjusting the tire pressure (Y page 332).

i The actual values for tires are vehicle- specific and may deviate from the values in the illustration.

Checking the tire pressures

Important safety notes Observe the notes on tire pressure (Y page 316). Information on air pressure for the tires on your vehicle can be found: Ron the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar (Y page 316) Ron the tire pressure label on the fuel filler flap (Y page 316) Rin the "Tire pressure information" section Rin the "Tire pressure information" section (Y page 316)

Checking tire pressures manually To determine and set the correct tire pressure, proceed as follows: X Remove the valve cap of the tire that is to be checked.

X Press the tire pressure gauge securely onto the valve.

X Read the tire pressure and compare it with the recommended value on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side of your vehicle (Y page 316).

X The tire pressure is too low: increase the tire pressure to the recommended value.

X The tire pressure is too high: press down the metal pin in the valve using the tip of a pen, for example. Air is released from the tire.

X Check the tire pressure again with the tire pressure gauge.

X Screw the valve cap onto the valve. X Repeat these steps for the other tires.

Tire pressure monitor

Important safety notes

G WARNING Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked at least once a month when cold and inflated to the pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar or the tire pressure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap. If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard or the tire pressure label, you should determine the proper tire pressure for those tires. As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equippedwith a tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires are significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, andmay affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. USA only: Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate if the system is not operating properly. The TPMS

Tire pressure 319

W he el s an d tir es

Z

malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the warning lamp will flash for approximately a minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will be repeated every time the vehicle is started as long as the malfunction exists. When themalfunction indicator is illuminated, the systemmay not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of incompatible replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

It is the driver's responsibility to set the tire pressure to the recommended cold tire pressure suitable for the operating situation (Y page 316). Note that the correct tire pressure for the current operating situation must first be taught-in to the tire pressure monitor. If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the warning threshold for the warning message is aligned to the reference values taught-in. Restart the tire pressure monitor after adjusting to the cold tire pressure (Y page 321). The current pressures are saved as new reference values. As a result, a warning message will appear if the tire pressure drops significantly. The tire pressure monitor does not warn you of an incorrectly set tire pressure. Observe the notes on the recommended tire pressure (Y page 316). The tire pressure monitor is not able to warn you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the tire is penetrated by a foreign object. In the event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid abrupt steering maneuvers.

If a tire pressure monitor system is installed, the vehicle's wheels have sensors installed thatmonitor the tire pressures in all four tires. The tire pressure monitor warns you if the pressure drops in one ormore of the tires. The tire pressure monitor only functions if the correct wheel electronics units are installed on each wheel. The tire pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating pressure loss/malfunctions (USA) or pressure loss (Canada). Whether the warning lamp flashes or lights up indicates whether a tire pressure is too low or the tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning: Rif the warning lamp is lit continuously, the tire pressure on one or more tires is significantly too low. The tire pressure monitor is not malfunctioning. RUSA only: if the warning lamp flashes for around a minute and then remains lit constantly, the tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning.

Information on tire pressures is displayed in the multifunction display. After a fewminutes of driving, the current tire pressure of each tire is shown in the multifunction display. USA only: if there is a malfunction with the tire pressure monitor it can take more than ten minutes until the malfunction is shown by the tire pressure warning lamp flashing for approximately one minute and then lighting up continuously. When the malfunction has been rectified, the tire pressure warning lamp goes out after a few minutes of driving. The tire pressure values indicated by the on- board computer may differ from those measured at a gas station with a pressure gauge. The tire pressures shown by the on- board computer refer to those measured at sea level. At high altitudes, the tire pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge are higher than those shown by the on-board computer. In this case, do not reduce the tire pressures.

320 Tire pressure W he el s an d tir es

The operation of the tire pressuremonitor can be affected by interference from radio transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being operated in or near the vehicle.

i USA only: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

i Canada only: This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Checking tire pressure electronically X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select Tire Pressure.

X Press buttona. The current tire pressure for eachwheelwill be displayed in the multifunction display.

If the vehicle has been parked for over 20 minutes, the message Tire pressure

will be displayed after driving a few minutes appears. After a teach-in period, the tire pressure monitor automatically recognizes newwheels or new sensors. As long as a clear allocation of the tire pressure values to the individual wheels is not possible, the Tire Pressure Monitor Active display message is shown instead of the tire pressure display. The tire pressures are already being monitored.

i If a spare wheel is mounted, the system may continue to show the tire pressure of the wheel that has been removed for a few minutes. If this occurs, note that the value displayed for the position where the spare wheel is mounted is not the same as the spare wheel's current tire pressure.

Tire pressure monitor warning messages If the tire pressure monitor detects a significant pressure loss on one ormore tires, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display. A warning tone also sounds and the tire pressure warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster. Each tire that is affected by a significant loss of pressure is highlighted in the pressure display. X If the Correct Tire PressureCorrect Tire Pressure message appears in the multifunction display, check the tire pressure on all four wheels and correct it if necessary.

i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are interchanged, the tire pressures may be displayed for the wrong positions for a short time. This is rectified after a few minutes of driving, and the tire pressures are displayed for the correct positions.

Restarting the tire pressure monitor When you restart the tire pressure monitor, all existingwarningmessages are deleted and the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses

Tire pressure 321

W he el s an d tir es

Z

the currently set tire pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the tire pressure monitor will automatically detect the new reference values after you have changed the tire pressure. However, you can also define reference values manually as described here. X Set the tire pressure to the value recommended for the corresponding driving situation on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's side B-pillar (Y page 316). Additional tire pressure values for different loads can also be found on the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap (Y page 316).

X Make sure that the tire pressure is correct on all four wheels.

X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 (Y page 139) in the ignition lock.

X Press the= or; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.

X Press the9 or: button to select Tire Pressure.

X Press thea button. The multifunction display shows the current tire pressure for the individual tires or the Tire pressure will be displayed after driving a few minutes message.

X Press the: button. The Use Current Pressures as New Reference Values message appears in the multifunction display.

If you wish to confirm the restart: X Press thea button. The Tire Press. Monitor Restarted message appears in the multifunction display. After driving for a few minutes, the system checks whether the current tire pressures are within the specified range. The new tire pressures are then accepted as reference values and monitored.

If you wish to cancel the restart: X Press the% button. The tire pressure values stored at the last restart will continue to be monitored.

Loading the vehicle

Instruction labels for tires and loads

G WARNING Overloaded tires can overheat, causing a blowout. Overloaded tires can also impair the steering and driving characteristics and lead to brake failure. There is a risk of accident. Observe the load rating of the tires. The load rating must be at least half of the GAWR of your vehicle. Never overload the tires by exceeding the maximum load.

: B-pillar, driver's side

Two instruction labels on your vehicle show the maximum possible load. (1) The Tire and Loading Information placard

is on the B-pillar on the driver's side. The Tire and Loading Information placard shows themaximum permissible number of occupants and the maximum permissible vehicle load. It also contains details of the tire sizes and corresponding pressures for tires mounted at the factory.

(2) The vehicle identification plate is on the B-pillar on the driver's side. The vehicle identification plate informs you of the gross vehicle weight rating. It is made up

322 Loading the vehicle W he el s an d tir es

of the vehicle weight, all vehicle occupants, the fuel and the cargo. You can also find information about the maximum gross axle weight rating on the front and rear axle. The maximum gross axle weight rating is the maximum weight that can be carried by one axle (front or rear axle). Never exceed the maximum load or the maximum gross axle weight rating for the front or rear axle.

Maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating

X Specification for maximum gross vehicle weight: is listed in the Tire and Loading Information placard: "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kilograms or XXX lbs."

The gross weight of all vehicle occupants, cargo, luggage and trailer load/noseweight (if applicable) must not exceed the specified value.

i The specifications shown on the Tire and Loading Information placard in the illustration are examples. The maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating is vehicle-specific and may differ from that in the illustration. You can find the valid maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating for your vehicle on the Tire and Loading Information placard.

Number of seats

Maximum number of seats: indicates the maximum number of occupants allowed to travel in the vehicle. This information can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard.

i The specifications shown on the Tire and Loading Information placard in the illustration are examples. The number of seats is vehicle-specific and can differ from the details shown. The number of seats in your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard.

Determining the correct load limit

Step-by-step instructions The following steps have been developed as required of all manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the "National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966". X Step 1: Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicles Tire and Loading Information placard.

X Step 2: Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

X Step 3: Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or XXX lbs.

Loading the vehicle 323

W he el s an d tir es

Z

X Step 4: The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the "XXX" amount equals 1400 lbs and there will be five 150- pound passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).

X Step 5:Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.

X Step 6 (if applicable): If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. This reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle (Y page 352).

324 Loading the vehicle W he el s an d tir es

Example: steps 1 to 3 The following table shows examples on how to calculate total and cargo load capacities with varying seating configurations and number and size of occupants. The following examples use a maximum load of 1500 lbs (680 kg). This is for illustration purposes only.Make sure you are using the actual load limit for your vehicle stated on your vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard (Y page 322). The higher the weight of all the occupants, the smaller the maximum load for luggage. Additional information when towing a trailer (Y page 352). Step 1

Example 1 Example 2 Example 3

Combined maximum weight of occupants and cargo (data from the Tire and Loading Information placard)

1500 lbs (680 kg) 1500 lbs (680 kg) 1500 lbs (680 kg)

Step 2

Example 1 Example 2 Example 3

Number of people in the vehicle (driver and occupants)

5 3 1

Distribution of the occupants

Front: 2 Rear: 3

Front: 1 Rear: 2

Front: 1

Weight of the occupants

Occupant 1: 150 lbs (68 kg) Occupant 2: 180 lbs (82 kg) Occupant 3: 160 lbs (73 kg) Occupant 4: 140 lbs (63 kg) Occupant 5: 120 lbs (54 kg)

Occupant 1: 200 lbs (91 kg) Occupant 2: 190 lbs (86 kg) Occupant 3: 150 lbs (68 kg)

Occupant 1: 150 lbs (68 kg)

Gross weight of all occupants

750 lbs (340 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg)

Loading the vehicle 325

W he el s an d tir es

Z

Step 3

Example 1 Example 2 Example 3

Permissible load (maximum gross vehicle weight rating from the Tire and Loading Information placard minus the gross weight of all occupants)

1500 lbs (680 kg) 750 lbs (340 kg) = 750 lbs (340 kg)

1500 lbs (680 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg) = 960 lbs (435 kg)

1500 lbs (680 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg) = 1350 lbs (612 kg)

Vehicle identification plate Even if you have calculated the total load carefully, you should still make sure that the gross vehicle weight rating and the gross axle weight rating are not exceeded. Details can be found on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side of the vehicle (Y page 322). Permissible gross vehicle weight: the gross weight of the vehicle, all passengers, load and trailer load/noseweight (if applicable) must not exceed the permissible gross vehicle weight. Gross axle weight rating: the maximum permissible weight that can be carried by one axle (front or rear axle). To ensure that your vehicle does not exceed the maximum permissible values (gross vehicle weight and maximum gross axle weight rating), have your loaded vehicle (including driver, occupants, cargo, and full trailer load if applicable) weighed on a suitable vehicle weighbridge.

Trailer load/noseweight The trailer load/noseweight affects the gross weight of the vehicle. If a trailer is attached, the trailer load/noseweight is included in the load along with occupants and luggage. The trailer load/noseweight is usually

approximately 10% of the gross weight of the trailer and its load. Only use a trailer tow hitch that has been approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Comply with the manufacturer's operating instructions for operation, care and maintenance.

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards

Overview of Tire Quality Grading Standards

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards are U.S. government specifications. Their purpose is to provide drivers with uniform reliable information on tire performance data. Tire manufacturers have to grade tires using three performance factors:: tread wear grade,; traction grade and= temperature grade. These regulations do not apply to

326 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards W he el s an d tir es

Canada. Nevertheless, all tires sold in North America are provided with the corresponding quality grading markings on the sidewall of the tire. Where applicable, the tire grading information can be found on the tire sidewall between the tread shoulder and maximum tire width. Example: RTreadwear grade: 200 RTraction grade: AA RTemperature grade: A All passenger car tires must conform to the statutory safety requirements in addition to these grades.

i The actual values for tires are vehicle- specific and may deviate from the values in the illustration.

Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on thewear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified U.S. government course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well on the government test track as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm, due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate conditions.

Traction

G WARNING The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.

! Avoid wheelspin. This can lead to damage to the drive train.

The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on a wet surface as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. The safe speed on a wet, snow covered or icy road is always lower than on dry road surfaces. You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing point. Mercedes-Benz recommends a minimum tread depth of in (4 mm) on all four winter tires. Observe the legally required minimum tire tread depth (Y page 313).Winter tires can reduce the braking distance on snow-covered surfaces in comparison with summer tires. The braking distance is still much further than on surfaces that are not icy or covered with snow. Take appropriate care when driving. Further information on winter tires (M+S tires) (Y page 314).

Temperature

G WARNING The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause excessive heat build-up and possible tire failure.

The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C. These represent the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause thematerial of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards 327

W he el s an d tir es

Z

excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

Tire labeling

Overview of tire labeling

: Uniform tire Quality Grading Standard (Y page 332)

; DOT tire Identification Number (Y page 331)

= Maximum tire load (Y page 331) ? Maximum tire pressures (Y page 318) A Manufacturer B Tire material (Y page 331) C Tire size designation, load-bearing

capacity and speed rating (Y page 328) D Load identification (Y page 330) E Tire name

The markings described above are on the tire in addition to the tire name (sales designation) and the manufacturer's name.

i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.

Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity and speed rating

G WARNING Exceeding the stated tire load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could lead to tire damage or the tire bursting. There is a risk of accident. Therefore, only use tire types and sizes approved for your vehicle model. Observe the tire load rating and speed rating required for your vehicle.

: Tire width ; Height-width ratio in percentage = Tire code ? Rim diameter A Load bearing index B Speed rating

General: depending on the manufacturer's standards, a letter is imprinted into the tire wall before the size description. If there is no letter preceding the size description (as shown above): these are passenger vehicle tires according to European manufacturing standards. If "P" precedes the size description: passenger vehicle tires according to U.S. manufacturing standards.

328 Tire labeling W he el s an d tir es

If "P" precedes the size description: light truck tires according to U.S. manufacturing standards. If "T" precedes the size description: these are compact emergency spare wheels at high tire pressure, to be used only temporarily in an emergency. Tire width: tire width: shows the nominal tire width in millimeters. Height-width ratio: height-width ratio; is the ratio between tire height and tire width. The aspect ratio is calculated by dividing the tire width by the tire height. The resulting quotient is given as a percentage. Tire code: tire code= shows the tire type. "R" represents radial tires; "D" represents diagonal tires; "B" represents diagonal radial tires. Optionally, tires with a maximum speed of over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in the size description, depending on the manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR 18). Rim diameter: rim diameter? is the diameter of the bead seat, not the diameter of the rim flange. The rim diameter is specified in inches (in). Load bearing index:B load bearing index A (also load index) is a numerical code that specifies the maximum load-bearing capacity of a tire. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit. The maximum permissible load can be found on the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side (Y page 322). Example: Load-bearing index 91 indicates a maximum load of 1356 lbs (615 kg) that the tires can bear. For further information on themaximum tire load in kilograms and pounds, see (Y page 331). For further information on the load bearing index, see "Load index" (Y page 330).

Speed rating: speed ratingB specifies the approved maximum speed of the tire.

i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.

Regardless of the speed rating, always observe the speed limits. Drive carefully and adapt your driving style to the traffic conditions.

i Since 2009, tires in Europe which correspond to the noise limitations of Directive ECE-R 117 show an >>S<< (Sound) mark. This identification follows the type approval number and has no connection with the speed rating.

Summer tires

Index Speed rating

Q up to 100 mph (160 km/h)

R up to 106 mph (170 km/h)

S up to 112 mph (180 km/h)

T up to 118 mph (190 km/h)

H up to 130 mph (210 km/h)

V up to 149 mph (240 km/h)

W up to 168 mph (270 km/h)

Y up to 186 mph (300 km/h)

ZR...Y up to 186 mph (300 km/h)

ZR...(..Y) over 186 mph (300 km/h)

ZR over 149 mph (240 km/h)

ROptionally, tires with a maximum speed of over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in the size description, depending on the manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR18). The service specification is made up of load-bearing indexA and speed rating B. RIf the size description of your tire includes "ZR" and there are no service

Tire labeling 329

W he el s an d tir es

Z

specifications, ask the tire manufacturer in order to find out the maximum speed. If a service specification is available, the maximum speed is limited according to the speed rating in the service specification. Example: 245/40 ZR 18 97 Y. In this example, "97 Y" is the service specification. The letter "Y" represents the speed rating and the maximum speed of the tire is limited to 186 mph(300 km/h). RThe size description for all tires with maximum speeds of over 186 mph (300 km/h) must include "ZR" and the service specification must be given in parentheses. Example: 275/40 ZR 18 (99 Y). The speed rating "(Y)" indicates that the maximum speed of the tire is over 186 mph (300 km/h). Ask the tire manufacturer about the maximum speed.

All-weather tires and winter tires

Index Speed rating

Q M+S4 up to 100 mph (160 km/h)

T M+S4 up to 118 mph (190 km/h)

H M+S4 up to 130 mph (210 km/h)

V M+S4 up to 149 mph (240 km/h)

i Not all tires with theM+Smarking provide the driving characteristics of winter tires. In addition to theM+Smarking, winter tires also have thei snowflake symbol on the tire wall. Tires with this marking fulfill the requirements of the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber Association of Canada (RAC). These tires have been developed specifically for driving on snow.

When the electronic speed limiter is set, your vehicle is prevented from exceeding 130mph (210 km/h).

The speed rating of tires mounted at the factory may be higher than the maximum speed that the electronic speed limiter permits. Make sure that your tires have the required speed rating, e.g. when buying new tires. The required speed rating for your vehicle can be found in the "Tires" section (Y page 340). Further information about reading tire data can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop.

Load index

In addition to the load bearing index, load rating: may be imprinted after the letters that identify speed ratingB on the sidewall of the tire (Y page 328). RIf no specification is given: no text (as in the example above), represents a standard load (SL) tire RXL or Extra Load: represents a reinforced tire RLight Load: represents a light load tire RC, D, E: represents a load range that depends on the maximum load that the tire can carry at a certain pressure

i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.

4 Or M+Si for winter tires.

330 Tire labeling W he el s an d tir es

Maximum load rating

Maximum tire load: is the maximum permissible weight for which the tire is approved. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit. The maximum permissible load can be found on the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side (Y page 322).

i The actual values for tires are vehicle- specific and may deviate from the values in the illustration.

DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) U.S. tire regulations prescribe that every manufacturer of new tires or retreader has to imprint a TIN in or on the sidewall of each tire produced.

The TIN is a unique identification number. The TIN enables tire manufacturers to inform purchasers of recalls and other safety-

relevant matters. It makes it possible for the purchaser to easily identify the affected tires. The TIN is made up of manufacturer identification code;, tire size=, tire type code? and manufacturing dateA. DOT (Department of Transportation): tire symbol: indicates that the tire complies with the requirements of theU.S. Department of Transportation. Manufacturer identification code: manufacturer identification code; provides details on the tire manufacturer. New tires have a code with two symbols. Retreaded tires have a code with four symbols. For further information about retreaded tires, see (Y page 312). Tire size: identifier= describes the tire size. Tire type code: tire type code? can be used by the manufacturer as a code to describe specific characteristics of the tire. Date of manufacture: date of manufacture A provides information about the age of a tire. The first and second positions represent the week of manufacture, starting with "01" for the first calendar week. Positions three and four represent the year of manufacture. For example, a tire that is marked with "3208", was manufactured in week 32 in 2008.

i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.

Tire characteristics

Tire labeling 331

W he el s an d tir es

Z

This information describes the type of tire cord and the number of layers in sidewall: and under tire tread;.

i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.

Definition of terms for tires and loading

Tire ply composition and material used Describes the number of layers or the number of rubber-coated belts in the tread and the sidewall of the tire. These are made of steel, nylon, polyester and other materials.

Bar Metric unit for tire pressure. 14.5038 pounds per square inch (psi) and 100 kilopascals (kPa) are the equivalent of 1 bar.

DOT (Department of Transportation) DOT marked tires fulfill the requirements of the United States Department of Transportation.

Normal occupant weight The number of occupants for which the vehicle is designed multiplied by 68 kilograms (150 lbs).

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards A uniform standard to grade the quality of tireswith regards to tread quality, tire traction and temperature characteristics. Ratings are determined by tire manufacturers using U.S. government testing procedures. The ratings are molded into the sidewall of the tire.

Recommended tire pressure The recommended tire pressure applies to the tires mounted at the factory.

The Tire and Loading Information placard contains the recommended tire pressures for cold tires on a fully loaded vehicle and for the maximum permissible vehicle speed. The tire pressure table contains the recommended pressures for cold tires for various operating conditions, i.e. differing load and speed conditions.

Increased vehicle weight due to optional equipment This is the combined weight of all standard and optional equipment available for the vehicle, regardless of whether it is actually installed on the vehicle or not.

Rim This is the part of the wheel on which the tire is mounted.

GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) The GAWR is the maximum gross axle weight rating. The actual load on an axle must never exceed the gross axle weight rating. The gross axle weight rating can be found on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side.

Speed rating The speed rating is part of the tire identification. It specifies the speed range for which the tire is approved.

GTW (Gross Trailer Weight) The GTW is the weight of a trailer including the weight of the load, luggage, accessories etc. on the trailer.

GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) The gross vehicle weight includes the weight of the vehicle including fuel, tools, the spare wheel, accessories installed, occupants, luggage and the drawbar noseweight, if applicable. The gross vehicle weight must not

332 Tire labeling W he el s an d tir es

exceed the gross vehicle weight rating GVWR as specified on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side.

GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) The GVWR is the maximum permissible gross weight of a fully loaded vehicle (the weight of the vehicle including all accessories, occupants, fuel, luggage and the drawbar noseweight, if applicable). The gross vehicle weight rating is specified on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side.

Maximum loaded vehicle weight The maximum weight is the sum of: Rthe curb weight of the vehicle Rthe weight of the accessories Rthe load limit Rthe weight of the factory installed optional equipment

Kilopascal (kPa) Metric unit for tire pressure. 6.9 kPa corresponds to 1 psi. Another unit for tire pressure is bar. 100 kilopascals (kPa) are the equivalent of 1 bar.

Load index In addition to the load-bearing index, the load index may also be imprinted on the sidewall of the tire. This specifies the load-bearing capacity more precisely.

Curb weight The weight of a vehicle with standard equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil and coolant. It also includes the air- conditioning system and optional equipment if these are installed in the vehicle, but does not include passengers or luggage.

Maximum load rating The maximum tire load is the maximum permissible weight in kilograms or lbs for which a tire is approved.

Maximum permissible tire pressure Maximum permissible tire pressure for one tire.

Maximum load on one tire Maximum load on one tire. This is calculated by dividing themaximum axle load of one axle by two.

PSI (pounds per square inch) A standard unit of measure for tire pressure.

Aspect ratio Relationship between tire height and tire width in percent.

Tire pressure This is pressure inside the tire applying an outward force to each square inch of the tire's surface. The tire pressure is specified in pounds per square inch (psi), in kilopascal (kPa) or in bar. The tire pressure should only be corrected when the tires are cold.

Cold tire pressure The tires are cold: Rif the vehicle has been parked without direct sunlight on the tires for at least three hours and Rif the vehicle has not been driven further than 1 mile (1.6 km)

Tread The part of the tire that comes into contact with the road.

Tire labeling 333

W he el s an d tir es

Z

Bead The tire bead ensures that the tire sits securely on the wheel. There are several steel wires in the bead to prevent the tire from coming loose from the wheel rim.

Sidewall The part of the tire between the tread and the bead.

Weight of optional extras The combined weight of those optional extras that weigh more than the replaced standard parts and more than 2.3 kg (5 lbs). These optional extras, such as high-performance brakes, level control, a roof rack or a high- performance battery, are not included in the curb weight and the weight of the accessories.

TIN (Tire Identification Number) This is a unique identifier which can be used by a tire manufacturer to identify tires, for example for a product recall, and thus identify the purchasers. The TIN is made up of the manufacturer's identity code, tire size, tire type code and the manufacturing date.

Load bearing index The load bearing index (also load index) is a code that contains themaximum load bearing capacity of a tire.

Traction Traction is the result of friction between the tires and the road surface.

TWR (Tongue Weight Rating) The TWR specifies the maximum permissible weight that the ball coupling of the trailer tow hitch can support.

Treadwear indicators Narrow bars (tread wear bars) that are distributed over the tire tread. If the tire tread is level with the bars, the wear limit of in (1.6 mm) has been reached.

Occupant distribution The distribution of occupants in a vehicle at their designated seating positions.

Total load limit Nominal load and luggage load plus 150 lbs (68 kg) multiplied by the number of seats in the vehicle.

Changing a wheel

Flat tire The "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 298) contains information and notes on how to deal with a flat tire.

Rotating the wheels

G WARNING Rotate front and rear wheels only if the tires are of the same dimension. If your vehicle is equipped with mixed-size tires (different tire dimensions front vs. rear), tire rotation is not possible.

G WARNING Have the tightening torque checked after changing a wheel. The wheels could come loose if they are not tightened to a torque of 96 lb-ft (130 Nm). Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for your vehicle's rims.

! On vehicles equipped with a tire pressure monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.

334 Changing a wheel W he el s an d tir es

Tire-mounting tools should not be used near the valve. This could damage the electronic components. Only have tires changed at a qualified specialist workshop.

Rotating front and rear wheels of differing dimensions can render the general operating permit invalid. Always pay attention to the instructions and safety notices in the section on "Changing a wheel and mounting a spare wheel" (Y page 335). The wear patterns on the front and rear tires differ, depending on the operating conditions. Rotate the wheels before a clear wear pattern has formed on the tires. Front tires typically wear more on the shoulders and the rear tires in the center. If your vehicle's tire configuration allows, you can rotate the wheels according to the intervals in the tire manufacturer's warranty book in your vehicle documents. If no warranty book is available, the tires should be rotated every 3,000 to 6,000 miles(5,000 to 10,000 km), or earlier if tire wear requires. Do not change the direction of wheel rotation. Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel is rotated. Check the tire pressure and reactivate the tire pressure monitor (Y page 319) if necessary.

Direction of rotation Tires with a specified direction of rotation have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk of hydroplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is observed. An arrow on the sidewall of the tire indicates its correct direction of rotation. You may mount the spare wheel against the direction of rotation. Adhere to the time restriction on use as well as the speed limitation specified on the spare wheel.

Storing wheels Store tires that are not being used in a cool, dry and preferably dark place. Protect the tires from oil, grease, gasoline and diesel.

Cleaning the wheels

G WARNING The water jet from a circular jet nozzle (dirt blasters) can cause invisible exterior damage to the tires or chassis components. Components damaged in this way may fail unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident. Do not use power washers with circular jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tires or chassis components replaced immediately.

Mounting a wheel

Preparing the vehicle

G WARNING You must remove the spare wheel from the spare wheel carrier before lifting the vehicle. Otherwise the vehicle could fall off the jack and injure you or others.

X Prepare the vehicle as described (Y page 298).

X Remove the vehicle tool kit and the jack (Y page 296).

X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away.

X Remove the spare wheel from the spare wheel bracket (Y page 297).

i Vehicles without a spare wheel or emergency spare wheel are not equipped with a tire-change tool kit at the factory. For more information on which tools are required to perform awheel change on your vehicle e.g. lug wrench or jack, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Changing a wheel 335

W he el s an d tir es

Z

Securing the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away X On level ground: place chocks or other suitable items under the front and rear of the wheel that is diagonally opposite the wheel you wish to change.

X On downhill gradients: place chocks or other suitable items in front of the wheels of the front and rear axle.

Raising the vehicle

G WARNING If you do not position the jack correctly at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the jack could tip over with the vehicle raised. There is a risk of injury. Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack must be positioned vertically, directly under the jacking point of the vehicle.

! The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the vehicle at the jacking points. Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged.

The following must be observed when raising the vehicle: Rto raise the vehicle, only use the vehicle- specific jack that has been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. If used incorrectly, the jack could tip over with the vehicle raised. Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold the vehicle for a short time while a wheel is being changed. It is not suited for performing maintenance work under the vehicle. Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and downhill slopes. Rbefore raising the vehicle, secure it from rolling away by applying the parking brake and inserting wheel chocks. Never disengage the parking brake while the vehicle is raised.

Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a large, load-bearing underlay must be used. On a slippery surface, a non-slip underlay must be used, e.g. rubber mats. Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the jack will not be able to achieve its load- bearing capacity due to the restricted height. Rmake sure that the distance between the underside of the tires and the ground does not exceed 1.2 in (3 cm). Rnever place your hands and feet under the raised vehicle. Rnever lie under the raised vehicle. Rnever start the engine when the vehicle is raised. Rnever open or close a door or the tailgate when the vehicle is raised. Rmake sure that no persons are present in the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.

X Using lug wrench:, loosen the bolts on the wheel you wish to change by about one full turn. Do not unscrew the wheel bolts completely.

336 Changing a wheel W he el s an d tir es

Pump lever;

X Assemble the pump lever for the jack. It can be found with the vehicle tool kit (Y page 296).

X Turn pressure release screw= clockwise as far as it will go using notch; on the pump lever. Pressure release screw= is closed. i Do not turn pressure release screw= by more than one to two revolutions. Otherwise, hydraulic fluid could escape.

X Set jack: on solid ground. X Position jack: on the axle carrier tube; of the front or rear axle. Jack: must always stand vertically, even on slopes. Make sure that jack: is correctly positioned under axle carrier tube;. The front or rear axle must sit securely in the recess of jack:.

X Raise the vehicle by pumping in the direction of the arrow until the tire is 1.2 in (3 cm) off the ground at the most.

Removing a wheel ! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on a dirty surface. The bolt and wheel hub threads could otherwise be damaged when you screw them in.

X Unscrew the wheel bolts. X Remove the wheel.

Mounting a new wheel

G WARNING Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or rusted. Never oil or grease wheel bolts. This could cause the bolts to loosen in the wheel hub.

G WARNING Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or rusted. Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts. Damaged wheel hub threads should be repaired immediately. Do not continue to drive under these circumstances! Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call Roadside Assistance. Incorrect wheel bolts or improperly tightened wheel bolts can cause the wheel to come off. This could cause an accident. Make sure to use the correct wheel bolts.

Changing a wheel 337

W he el s an d tir es

Z

G WARNING Only use genuineMercedes-Benz wheel bolts. Other wheel bolts may come loose. Do not tighten the wheel bolts when the vehicle is raised. Otherwise, the vehicle could fall off the jack.

! To prevent damage to the paintwork, hold the wheel securely against the wheel hub while screwing in the first wheel bolt.

Always pay attention to the instructions and safety notes in the "Changing a wheel" section (Y page 334). X Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact surfaces.

X Place the new wheel on the wheel hub and push it on.

X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.

Lowering the vehicle

G WARNING The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts and bolts are not tightened to the specified tightening torque. There is a risk of accident. Have the tightening torque immediately checked at a qualified specialist workshop after a wheel is changed.

X Open the pressure release screw on the jack using the pump lever (Y page 336) by approximately one turn.

X Lower the vehicle until it is once again standing firmly on the ground.

X Place the jack to one side. X Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (: toA). The specified tightening torque is 96 lb-ft (130 Nm).

X Disassemble the pump lever. X Push the jack piston back in and close the drain plug.

X Use the bolts to secure the faulty wheel to the spare wheel bracket (Y page 297).

X Stow the jack and the vehicle tools in the vehicle again.

X Check the tire pressure of the newly installed wheel and adjust it if necessary. A table with the tire pressures for your vehicle can be found on the B-pillar on the driver's side.

Wheel and tire combinations

General notes

G WARNING Replace rims or tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown on the original part. For further information contact an authorizedMercedes-BenzCenter. If incorrectly sized rims and tires are mounted, the wheel brakes or suspension components can be damaged. Also, the operating clearance of the wheels and the tires may no longer be correct.

G WARNING Replace rims or tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown on the original part. For further information contact an authorizedMercedes-BenzCenter. If incorrectly sized rims and tires are mounted, the wheel brakes or suspension components can be damaged. Also, the operating clearance of the wheels and the tires may no longer be correct.

338 Wheel and tire combinations W he el s an d tir es

G WARNING If you notice sudden significant vibrations or unusual handling performance or if you suspect that damage has occurred to the vehicle, you should activate the hazard warning lamps, gently reduce speed and carefully head for an area that is located at a safe distance from the road. Check the tires and the underside of the vehicle for damage. If the vehicle seems unsafe, have the vehicle towed away to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or tire dealer to be repaired.

G WARNING Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You might lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build- up and possibly a fire.

! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use tires, wheels and accessories which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle. These tires have been specially adapted for use with the driving safety systems, such as ABS or ESP. Only use tires, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle noise emissions or fuel consumption, may otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tire dimension variations could cause the tires to come into contact with the bodywork and axle components. This could result in damage to the tires or the vehicle. Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for damage resulting from the use of tires, wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved. Further information about wheels, tires and approved combinations can be obtained

from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

i The recommended pressures for various operating conditions can be found: Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard with the recommended tire pressures on the B-pillar on the driver's side Rin the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap

Observe the notes on recommended tire pressure under various operating conditions. Check tire pressures regularly, and only when the tires are cold. Comply with the maintenance recommendations of the tire manufacturer in the vehicle document wallet.

Further information on recommended tire pressures as well as tire pressures for specific driving situations, see (Y page 332).

i Notes on the vehicle equipment always equip the vehicle with: Rtires of the same size on a given axle (left/right) Rtires of the same type on your vehicle at a given time (summer tires, winter tires, all-weather tires, all-terrain tires)

i The following pages contain information on approved wheels and tire sizes for equipping your vehicle with winter tires. Winter tires are not available at the factory as standard equipment or optional extras. If you want to equip your vehicle with approved winter tires, it may be necessary to obtain wheel rims in the corresponding size. The size of the approved winter tires may differ from the standard tires. This is dependent on the model and the equipment installed at the factory. The tires and wheel rims, as well as further information, can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop.

Wheel and tire combinations 339

W he el s an d tir es

Z

The tire and wheel combinations listed in the tables below apply to the following models:

V1 G 550

V2 G 63 AMG

i Not all wheel and tire combinations are available at the factory for all countries.

Tires

G 550

All-weather tires

Tires (radial tires) Alloy wheels

265/60 R18 110V M+S

7.5 J x 18 H2 Wheel offset: 1.69 in(43 mm)

i You can obtain information about tires and tire dimensions that are not listed here at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Spare wheel All-weather tires

Tires (radial tires) Alloy wheels

265/60 R18 110V M+S

7.5 J x 18 H2 Wheel offset: 1.69 in (43 mm)

i You can obtain information about tires and tire dimensions that are not listed here at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

G 63 AMG

Summer tires

Tires Alloy wheels

275/50 R20 113W XL Use of snow chains not permitted.

9.5J x 20 H2 ET 50

i You can obtain information about tires and tire dimensions that are not listed here at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Winter tires

Tires Alloy wheels

265/55 R19 109H M+S

9.5J x 19 H2 ET 50

i You can obtain information about tires and tire dimensions that are not listed here at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

Spare wheel ! The spare wheel must be inflated to the maximum tire pressure given in the table on the inside of the fuel filler flap.

Tires Alloy wheels

265/55 R19 109H M+S

9.5J x 19 H2 ET 50

i You can obtain information about tires and tire dimensions that are not listed here at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.

340 Wheel and tire combinations W he el s an d tir es

Useful information ............................ 342 Identification plates ......................... 342 Service products and filling capaci- ties ..................................................... 343 Vehicle data ...................................... 350 Vehicle data for off-road driving ..... 350 Trailer tow hitch ................................ 351

341

Te ch ni ca ld at a

Useful information

i This Operator's Manual describes all models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safety- related systems and functions.

i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).

Identification plates

Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN) and paint code number

X Open the driver's door. You will see vehicle identification plate:.

Example: vehicle identification plate (USA only) ; VIN = Paint code

Example: vehicle identification plate (Canada only) ; VIN = Paint code

i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is used only as an example. This data is different for every vehicle and can deviate from the data shown here. The correct data for your vehicle can be found on the vehicle identification plate that is mounted on your vehicle.

342 Identification plates Te ch ni ca ld at a

Vehicle identification number (VIN)

: VIN (stamped into the chassis on the right-hand side, when viewed in the direction of travel)

: VIN (on the lower edge of the windshield)

The VIN can be found in the following locations: Ron the vehicle identification plate (Y page 342) Rstamped into the chassis on the right-hand side (when viewed in the direction of travel) Ron the lower edge of the windshield

Engine number

Example: G 550 : Plate with information on emissions

testing, including the confirmation of the emission standards at U.S. federal level as well as for California

; Engine number (stamped into the crankcase)

Service products and filling capacities

Important safety notes

G WARNING Service products may be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury. Comply with instructions on the use, storage and disposal of service products on the labels of the respective original containers. Always store service products sealed in their original containers. Always keep service products out of the reach of children.

H Environmental note Dispose of service products in an environmentally responsible manner.

Service products include the following: RFuels RLubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil) RCoolant RBrake fluid

Service products and filling capacities 343

Te ch ni ca ld at a

Z

RWindshield washer fluid RClimate control system refrigerant Components and service products must be matched. You should therefore only use products that have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Information on tested and approved products can be obtained at an authorized Mercedes- Benz Center or on the Internet at http:// bevo.mercedes-benz.com. You can recognize service products approved by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscription on the containers: RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51) RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51) Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in accordance with an MB Sheet number (e.g. MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been approved by Mercedes-Benz.

Fuel

Important safety notes

G WARNING Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion. You must avoid fire, open flames, creating sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before refueling.

G WARNING Fuel is poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury. You must make sure that fuel does not come into contact with your skin, eyes or clothing and that it is not swallowed. Do not inhale fuel vapors. Keep fuel away from children.

If you or others come into contact with fuel, observe the following: RWash away fuel from skin immediately using soap and water. RIf fuel comes into contact with your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water. Seek medical assistance without delay. RIf fuel is swallowed, seek medical assistance without delay. Do not induce vomiting. RImmediately change out of clothing which has come into contact with fuel.

Tank capacity

Total capacity

All models 25.4 US gal (96.0 l)

Of which reserve

All models Approx. 3.7 US gal (14.0 l)

Gasoline (EN 228)

Fuel grade ! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a gasoline engine. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage to the fuel system and engine.

! You should only refuel with unleaded premium-grade gasoline as this avoids damaging the catalytic converter. If engine running problems are apparent, have the cause checked immediately and repaired. Excess unburned fuel can otherwise enter the catalytic converter, leading to overheating and possibly causing a fire.

344 Service products and filling capacities Te ch ni ca ld at a

! To ensure the longevity and full performance of the engine, only premium- grade unleaded gasoline may be used. If there is no premium-grade unleaded gasoline available and regular unleaded gasoline must be used, please observe the following precautions: Ronly fill the fuel tank to half full with regular unleaded gasoline and fill the rest with premium-grade unleaded gasoline as soon as possible. Rdo not drive at the maximum speed. Ravoid sudden acceleration. Rif the vehicle is carrying a light load, e.g. two passengers without luggage, do not allow the engine to rev above 3000 rpm. Rif the vehicle is fully loaded or is being operated in mountainous terrain, do not depress the accelerator pedal further than of the pedal travel.

! Use a filter when refueling from a fuel can. Otherwise, the fuel lines and/or injection system could be blocked by particles from the fuel can.

Only refuel using premium-grade unleaded gasoline with a minimum octane rating of 91. Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) and/or unleaded gasolinewith additives can be used. The concentration of additives in the fuel, however, must not exceed 10%, e.g.: REthanol RTAME RETBE RIPA RTBA For MTBE, the concentration should not exceed 15%. The concentration of methanol in gasoline, including other additives, must not exceed 3%. Usingmixtures ofmethanol and ethanol is not permitted. Gasohol, a mixture of 10% ethanol and 90% unleaded gasoline, may be used.

All of these mix fuels must fulfill the fuel requirements, e.g.: Rknock resistance Rboiling point Rvapor pressure Youwill usually find information about the fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the label on the pump, ask the staff for assistance.

i For further information, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or on the Internet at http://www.mbusa.com (USA only).

Information on refueling (Y page 153).

AMG vehicles ! Only refuel using super-grade unleaded gasoline with at least 98 RON/88 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification. You could otherwise impair engine output or damage the engine.

! Premium-grade unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 95 RON/85 MON may be used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available. This may reduce engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Do not drive at full throttle.

! Regular unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON may also be used as an emergency measure if the recommended fuel is not available. Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel consumption, and the engine power output is noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full throttle. If only regular unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON or lower is available, you must have the vehicle adapted to this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.

Service products and filling capacities 345

Te ch ni ca ld at a

Z

Additives ! Do not refuel with low-grade fuel and do not use fuel additives that are not tested and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Damage to or malfunctions of the fuel system may otherwise occur.

One of the main problems of poor fuel quality is the forming of deposits that are created during the gasoline combustion process. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use branded fuels that have additives. If you use fuels without these additives over a longer period of time, carbon deposits may build up. These deposits form at the inlet valves and in the combustion chamber in particular. This could lead to engine problems, e.g.: Rlonger engine warm-up phase Runeven idle Rengine noise Rmisfiring Rloss of power Carbon deposits may form if the availability of gasoline with relevant additives is insufficient (in certain regions). In this case, Mercedes-Benz recommends additives approved for use in Mercedes-Benz vehicles; see http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. For a list of approved products, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Comply with the instructions for use on the product label. Do not mix other fuel additives with fuel. This causes unnecessary costs and could damage the engine.

Notes on fuel consumption

H Environmental note CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to fuel consumption and therefore depend on:

Refficient use of the fuel by the engine Rdriving style Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences, road conditions or traffic flow

You can minimize your vehicle's CO2

emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.

The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in the following situations: Rat very low outside temperatures Rin city traffic Ron short journeys Rin mountainous terrain Rwhen towing a trailer

Engine oil

General notes ! Never use engine oil or an oil filter of a specification other than is necessary to fulfill the prescribed service intervals. Do not change the engine oil or oil filter in order to achieve longer replacement intervals than those prescribed. You could otherwise cause engine damage or damage to the exhaust gas aftertreatment. Follow the instructions in the service interval display regarding the oil change. Otherwise, youmay damage the engine and the exhaust gas aftertreatment.

The engine oils are matched to the performance of Mercedes-Benz engines and service intervals. For this reason, only use engine oils and oil filters that are approved for vehicles with a service system. For a list of approved engine oils and oil filters, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or go to the Internet site http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com (USA only). The table shows which engine oils have been approved for your vehicle.

346 Service products and filling capacities Te ch ni ca ld at a

Model Engine model

MB Approval

G 550 273 229.5

G 63 AMG 157 229.5

i Restriction for AMG vehicles: only engine oils SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 may be used.

i MB approval is indicated on the oil containers.

Filling capacities The following values refer to an oil change including the oil filter. The missing values for the following model were not available at the time of going to print: RG 63 AMG

Vehicle model Capacity including oil filter

G 550 2.4 US gal (9.0 l)

G 63 AMG

Additives ! Do not use any additives in the engine oil. This could damage the engine.

Engine oil viscosity

Viscosity describes the flow characteristics of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity,

this means that it is thick; a low viscosity means that it is thin. Select an engine oil with an SAE classification (viscosity) suitable for the prevailing outside temperatures. The table shows you which SAE classifications are to be used. The low- temperature characteristics of engine oils can deteriorate significantly, e.g. as a result of aging, soot and fuel deposits. It is therefore strongly recommended that you carry out regular oil changes using an approved engine oil with the appropriate SAE classification.

Refrigerant of the air-conditioning system ! Never use refrigerant R 12 (CFC) or mineral lubricants. Otherwise, you could damage the air-conditioning system.

The air-conditioning system is filled with R134a (HFC) refrigerant and a special PAG lubricant.

Brake fluid

G WARNING The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture from the air. This lowers the boiling point of the brake fluid. If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too low, vapor pockets may form in the brake system when the brakes are applied hard. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident. You should have the brake fluid renewed at the specified intervals.

Observe the important safety notes for service products (Y page 343). Only use brake fluid approved by Mercedes- Benz according to MB Approval 331.0. Information about approved brake fluid can be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.

Service products and filling capacities 347

Te ch ni ca ld at a

Z

i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.

Coolant

Important safety notes

G WARNING If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury. Let the engine cool down before you add antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly clean the antifreeze from components before starting the engine.

! Only add coolant that has been premixed with the desired antifreeze protection. You could otherwise damage the engine. Further information on coolants can be found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products, MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.

! Always use a suitable coolant mixture, even in countries where high temperatures prevail. Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not sufficiently protected from corrosion and overheating.

The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the following tasks: Rcorrosion protection Rantifreeze protection Rraising the boiling point If the coolant has antifreeze protection down to -35 (-37 ), the boiling point of the coolant in the pressurized system is approximately 266 (130 ).

The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should: Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine cooling system against freezing down to approximately -35 (-37 ). Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection down to -49 [-45 ]). Otherwise, heat will not be dissipated as effectively.

If the vehicle has lost coolant, add equal amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor in accordance with MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1. The coolant is checked with every maintenance interval at a qualified specialist workshop.

i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.

The engine cooling system is filled with coolant at the factory which contains antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor that ensures protection down to approximately -35 (-37 ). Your vehicle has a range of aluminum components. Aluminum components in the engine make it necessary to use antifreeze/ corrosion inhibitor that has been specifically formulated to protect the aluminum parts. Failure to use such anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant will result in a significantly shortened service life. The coolantmust be used throughout the year in order to maintain the necessary corrosion protection and to provide protection from overheating. In the Maintenance Booklet, you can find information on the intervals for renewal. The renewal interval is determined by the coolant type and the engine cooling system design. The renewal interval in the Maintenance Booklet is only valid if the

348 Service products and filling capacities Te ch ni ca ld at a

coolant is renewed or added to with Mercedes-Benz approved products. Therefore, only use MB 326.0 antifreeze/ corrosion inhibitor or anotherMercedes-Benz approved product of the same specification. Information on other products with the same specifications that are approved by Mercedes-Benz can be obtained at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. If the coolant level is too low, MB 325.0 antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor should be added. Have the engine cooling system checked for possible leaks.

Capacity

Model Capacity

G 550 Approx. 11.1 US qt (10.5 l)

G 63 AMG Approx. 14.6 US qt (13.8 l) Low-temperature circuit: approximately 3.1 US qt (2.9 l)

i Use MB 325.0 or MB 326.0 corrosion inhibitor/antifreeze.

Washer fluid

Important safety notes

G WARNING Windshield washer concentrate is highly flammable. If it comes into contact with hot engine components or the exhaust system it could ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury. Make sure that no windshield washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.

! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or

MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid could damage the plastic lenses of the headlamps.

! Do not add distilled or de-ionized water to the washer fluid container. Otherwise, the level sensor may be damaged.

! Only MB SummerFit and MB WinterFit washer fluid should be mixed together. The spray nozzles may otherwise become blocked.

At temperatures above freezing: X Fill the washer fluid reservoir with amixture of water and windshield washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.

X Add 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.

At temperatures below freezing: X Fill the washer fluid reservoir with amixture of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.

Adapt the mixing ratio to the outside temperature. X Down to 14 (10 ): mix 1 part MB WinterFit to 2 parts water.

X Down to 4 (20 ): mix 1 part MB WinterFit to 1 part water.

X Down to 20.2 (29 ): mix 2 parts MB WinterFit to 1 part water.

i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer fluid all year round.

Filling capacities

Model Capacity

All models (except for AMG vehicles)

7.4 US qt (7.0 l)

AMG vehicles 3.6 US qt (3.4 l)

Service products and filling capacities 349

Te ch ni ca ld at a

Z

Vehicle data

General notes Please note that for the specified vehicle data: Rthe heights specified may vary as a result of: - tires - load - condition of the suspension - optional equipment Rthe vehicle length specified includes the front license plate adapter.

Dimensions and weights

The missing values for the following model were not available at the time of going to print: RG 63 AMG

G 550 G 63 AMG

: Upper- edge clearance

75 in - 78.9 in

(1905mm - 2005 mm)

; Lower- edge clearance

26.8 in - 30.7 in

(680 mm - 780 mm)

= Range of movement

36.7 in (931 mm)

The missing values for the following model were not available at the time of going to print: RG 63 AMG

G 550

Vehicle length 183.5 in (4662 mm)

Vehicle width including exterior mirrors

80.9 in (2055 mm)

Maximum vehicle height 76.8 in (1951 mm)

Wheelbase 112.2 in (2850 mm)

Minimum ground clearance

8.1 in (205 mm)

Turning radius 44.6 ft (13.60 m)

Gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR)

7054.8 lb (3200 kg)

Gross axle weight rating (GAWR), front

3196.7 lb (1450 kg)

Gross axle weight rating (GAWR), rear

4188.8 lb (1900 kg)

i The GVWR is the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight. Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) is the vehicle weight including fuel, service products, spare wheel, accessories installed, load and, if applicable, trailer drawbar load. The GVWmust never exceed the GVWR.

i The GAWR is the maximum permissible axle weight.

Vehicle data for off-road driving

Fording depth ! The depth of water must not exceed the value specified in the table. Note that the

350 Vehicle data for off-road driving Te ch ni ca ld at a

possible fording depth is less in flowing water.

: Fording depth, 24 in (60 cm)

The table shows the fording depth when the vehicle is loaded and ready to drive.

Fording depth 24 in (60 cm)

For more information about off-road fording, see (Y page 162).

Approach/departure angle

G WARNING If you drive on a steep incline at an angle or turn when driving on an incline, the vehicle could slip sideways, tip and rollover. There is a risk of an accident. Always drive on a steep incline in the line of fall (straight up or down) and do not turn the vehicle.

For vehicles with steel springs, loaded and ready to drive means: a full tank, all fluids refilled and the driver is in the vehicle.

: ;

G 550 34 29

G 63 AMG 36 31

For further information about approach/ departure angles, see (Y page 167).

Maximum gradient-climbing capability On good road surfaces the maximum gradient-climbing capability of your vehicle is 100%, which corresponds to an approach/ departure angle of 45. Note that the climbing ability of your vehicle depends on the terrain conditions. For further information about the maximum gradient climbing ability, see (Y page 168).

Trailer tow hitch

Mounting dimensions

G WARNING Only have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted at a qualified specialist workshop.

! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted, changes to the engine cooling system may be necessary, depending on the vehicle type. If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted, observe the anchorage points on the chassis frame.

For trailer tow hitches installed at the factory, the overhang dimension is 990.5 mm.

Trailer tow hitch 351

Te ch ni ca ld at a

Z

: Anchorage points ; Overhang dimension

For trailer tow hitches installed at the factory, the overhang dimension including protective covering is 35.2 in (895 mm).

Trailer loads

G 550 G 63 AMG

Permissible trailer load, unbraked

1653 lbs (750 kg)

Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12% from a standstill)

7000 lbs (3175 kg)

Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer (the drawbar noseweight is not included in the towing weight)

4188 lbs (1900 kg)

Trailer drawbar noseweight

Number of people 150 lbs (68 kg) each

Seat occupa ncy

Trunk load

Maximu m drawbar nosewei ght

2 Front seats

220 lbs (100 kg)

562 lbs (255 kg)

3 2 front seats 1 rear seat

176 lbs (80 kg)

562 lbs (255 kg)

4 2 front seats 2 Rear seats

132 lbs (60 kg)

456 lbs (207 kg)

5 2

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the G-Class Mercedes-Benz works, you can view and download the Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Operator's Manual for Mercedes-Benz G-Class as well as other Mercedes-Benz manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Operator's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a Mercedes-Benz G-Class. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Mercedes-Benz G-Class 2014 Operator's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.